Rochester MN Unified Development Code (Draft)
Rochester MN Unified Development Code (Draft)
Site
T
PURPOSE
The general purpose of this UDC is to promote the public health, safety, and welfare by providing
appropriate and reasonable controls for the development and use of lands in Rochester, while also
protecting the rights of property owners. This UDC also is intended to:
A. Implement the policies, goals, and strategies adopted by the City of Rochester, including those
set forth in the Rochester Comprehensive Plan and other adopted plans;
B. Establish and apply zoning districts guided by the Rochester Comprehensive Plan that regulate
the location, height, bulk, and size of buildings; provide for a variety of housing types; and reduce
congestion;
C. Safeguard and enhance the appearance and quality of development in Rochester;
D. Facilitate the adequate provision of transportation, schools, parks, and other public
infrastructure requirements;
E. Reduce greenhouse gas emissions and prepare for the impacts of climate change on our
community; and
F. Sensitively fit the built environment into the natural environment with minimal disturbance to
Rochester’s natural ecosystem by requiring planning, design, and development that is
compatible with, preserves, and enhances sensitive natural areas such as steep slopes,
floodplains, watercourses, drainage ways, and ridge lines; and natural topographic features.
APPLICABILITY
General Applicability
This UDC applies within the municipal limits of the City of Rochester and in any areas outside
the established municipal limits where, through joint legislative agreement with the
appropriate governing body, the UDC shall be put into effect.
This UDC applies to all development in the City. No development may be approved if it would
result in a violation of City, County, state, or federal law. No City official or employee may
knowingly issue a development permit or license if such issuance would result in a violation
of City, County, state, or federal law.
The UDC is not intended to repeal, abrogate, annul, impair, or interfere with any existing
easements, covenants, deed restrictions, agreements, rules, regulations, ordinances, or
AUTHORITY
Minn. Stat. Ch. 462, authorizes the municipality to administer planning and zoning activities,
establish a Zoning Board of Appeals, enact official controls, and provide penalties for violations.
Minn. Stat. Chs. 103, 104, and 105 authorize minimum standards and criteria for the management
of “Shoreland” and “Floodplain” areas within the City of Rochester. Minn. Stat. §87A.08, subd. 1(a)
and MN Rules 7030 authorize standards for the regulation of Indoor Gun Ranges.
TRANSITION RULES
Repeal of Land Development Manual
This UDC supersedes all other general and permanent ordinances enacted prior to its enactment
unless specifically stated otherwise in this UDC. The previous Land Development Manual for the
City of Rochester, as was amended and supplemented, is hereby repealed.
Adoption of Existing Conditions of Approval
This UDC adopts and incorporates by reference the stipulations and conditions from
development plans, use permits, variances, stipulations, and conditions that currently apply to
any parcel prior to the date of adoption of this UDC.
Prior Development Approvals
Any development approved under regulations in effect prior to the effective date of this UDC
may be carried out under the terms and conditions of the approval and the development
standards in effect at the time of approval, provided the approval has not expired and the
development complies with any applicable standards of this UDC regarding ongoing
operations and maintenance.
If the prior approval expires, is revoked, or otherwise becomes invalid, any subsequent
development of the site shall be subject to the procedures and standards of this UDC.
EFFECTIVE DATE
This UDC shall become effective on [insert effective date of the UDC]. All references in this UDC to
the “effective date of this UDC” or to the “effective date” shall refer to that date unless otherwise
stated.
SEVERABILITY
If any section, subsection, subdivision, sentence, clause, phrase, or portion of this UDC or the
application of it to any person or place is held by a court of competent jurisdiction to be invalid under
Minnesota law, unconstitutional under the Minnesota or United States Constitutions, or inapplicable
in any way to the City, for any reason, such decision shall not affect the validity of the remaining
portions of this UDC or its application to other persons and places. The City Council hereby expressly
declares that it would have adopted this UDC and each section, subsection, subdivision, sentence,
f. Boundaries shown as following shorelines of any lake shall be construed to follow the
mean high waterline of the lake, and in the event of change in the mean high waterline,
shall be construed as moving with the actual mean high waterline.
g. Boundaries shown as following section lines, half section lines, or quarter section lines
shall be construed as following those lines.
h. Boundaries indicated as following the contours of certain elevations or soils of a
particular type shall be construed as following the actual height or soil contour as
determined by accepted surveying practice.
i. Boundaries indicted as separated from, and parallel or approximately parallel to, any of
the features listed in paragraphs one through eight above shall be construed to be
parallel to those features and at such distances there from as are shown on the map.
A property owner or applicant may appeal the decision of the Community Development
Director regarding a zoning district boundary under Subsection 1 above as described in
Section 60.500.030F.2, Appeals. For the purposes of that Section, a zoning district boundary
determination is considered a non-use interpretation.
BASE DISTRICTS
AG - Agricultural
Purpose
The AG district is intended to accommodate large lot rural residential and agricultural uses in
annexed undeveloped areas. It is characterized by open areas of land, large planted areas,
and detached residential uses surrounding more densely populated rural and urbanized
areas of the community.
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Additional Requirements
a. The maximum length of a multi-family building façade facing any public street shall be
limited to 80 feet.
b. Each façade longer than 50 feet in length facing any public street shall be divided into
modules consistent with Section 60.400.070F, Building Design.
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
approved conditional use, and shall not be considered nonconforming uses and
structures because they occupy areas larger than those permitted by Subsection 1)
above.
b. Access Requirements for Public, Institutional, and Civic Uses
Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic
generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
Dimensional Standards
(a) 65 percent or more of the ground floor façade area, as measured between
three and eight feet above sidewalk grade; and
(b) 30 percent or more of each floor level of the façade above the ground floor,
as measured between three and eight feet above each floor level.
2) Required ground floor window or glazed areas shall have a visible light
transmittance ratio of 0.6 or higher and shall not include reflective or heavily tinted
windows.
f. Sidewalks, Pedestrian Circulation, and Vehicular Connectivity
1) The internal vehicular, bicycle, and pedestrian circulation systems ("circulation
systems") of each development shall be designed to allow vehicular, bicycle, and
pedestrian cross-access between the circulation systems of the proposed
development and the circulation systems of existing or allowable future
development on adjoining lots. The Director may adjust or waive this requirement if
the Director determines that it is unlikely that the cross-access provisions will be
available on the adjoining lot within a reasonable period of time.
2) Sidewalks shall be provided on both sides of the street, and shall comply with the
following standards:
(a) On property fronting N. or S. Broadway, SW. 2nd. St, or SE. 4th
St./Collegeview Dr. SE, 12th St. SE, or 3rd Ave. SE, sidewalks shall be a
minimum of 10 feet in width, and a planting strip at least five feet in width
shall be located between the sidewalk and the street.
(b) On property fronting any street other those listed in Subsection (a) above,
sidewalks shall be a minimum of seven feet in width, and a planting strip at
least five feet in width shall be located between the sidewalk and the street.
(c) At least one walkway shall be provided from an adjacent sidewalk to each
building entrance.
(d) Where a sidewalk, trail, or other walkway crosses a street, driveway, drive
aisle, or parking lot, the crossing shall be clearly marked with a change in
paving material, color, or height, decorative bollards, or similar elements.
3) Where a lot or development site includes more than one primary structure, an
accessible pedestrian walkway at least five feet in width shall be provided between
at least one accessible pedestrian entrance in each primary structure.
g. Bicycle Parking
Bicycle parking shall be provided at a rate of one per five required automobile parking
spaces, up to 10 bicycle spaces, and then at a rate of one per 20 automobile parking
spaces, with a minimum of five bicycle parking spaces.
Dimensional Standards
BP – Business Park
Purpose
The BP district is intended to accommodate business park development with high levels of
landscaping, a general park-level and individual site-level maximum rate of trip generation,
restrictions on outside storage, signs, and lighting, and requirements for connectivity with the
intent that such development will be compatible with and connected to adjacent residential
development.
Dimensional Standards
LI – Light Industrial
Purpose
The LI district provides an area for a mixture of commercial and industrial uses that do not
generate significant adverse operational or traffic impacts, that are served by major
thoroughfares providing direct access or a local street system with direct access to major
thoroughfares, and with an adequate level of buffering, could be located in reasonable
proximity to residential areas.
Dimensional Standards
SI – Special Industrial
Purpose
The SI district is intended to accommodate uses that are potentially incompatible with other
districts because of the negative impacts they generate in terms of truck traffic, rail-related
activities, late-night operation, or other operational characteristics. It is intended for areas
where different levels of infrastructure and transportation improvements can be provided in
a cost effective and efficient manner that serve the needs of industrial, transportation, and
manufacturing uses.
Dimensional Standards
H - Holding
Purpose
The H district is intended to provide a temporary zoning classification for certain recently
annexed lands where the determination of the permanent zoning classification has not been
made by the City at the time of annexation. This district provides a period of time after
annexation when permanent development or reuse of land is not permitted and affords the
City the opportunity to establish the appropriate zoning district for the property.
Applicability
The Holding Zone district will be established on property if it is determined by the City that
the default designation of R-2 for the annexed property would be inappropriate because of
the designation of the property on the Rochester Future Land Use Map, changing conditions
applicable to the property or the general area that could result in modifications to the
designation of the property on the Rochester Future Land Use Map, or the developed
character of the area and the established land uses on the property suggest that a district
other than R-2 would be more appropriate for the property.
Standards
No building or structure shall be erected, enlarged, or moved and no change in the use of
land or existing buildings or structures shall be made for properties in the H district except
for expansions to existing uses in existing buildings.
OVERLAY DISTRICTS
General Applicability
These overlay districts described in this Section 60.200.040 supplement, but do not replace, the
underlying base zone districts listed in Section 60.200.030, Base Districts. In the case of a
conflict between the provisions of a base zone district and the provisions of an overlay district,
the provisions of the overlay zone shall apply. Where multiple overlay districts apply to a property,
development must comply with all overlay district provisions. In the case of a conflict, the stricter
overlay provision shall apply. On topics where an overlay district is silent, the base zone district
standards and any other applicable UDC requirements apply.
APO -- Airport Protection Overlay
Procedural History
This Section 60.200.040B carries forward the substance of Joint Airport Ordinance Number
4 adopted by the Rochester City Council and other jurisdictions, which repealed and
superseded Joint Ordinance Number 3 in its entirety. These ordinances regulated and
restricted the heights of structures and objects of natural growth; regulated the use of
property in the vicinity of Rochester International Airport by creating and defining the
boundaries of different regulatory zones and modifying earlier boundaries of those regulatory
zones; defined terms; and incorporated the Rochester International Airport zoning map by
reference. The Rochester International Airport zoning map is again incorporated by reference
as a part of this UDC and may be revised as shown in Section 60.500.040E Rezoning
(Official Zoning Map Amendment).
Purpose
The purpose of the APO district is to:
a. Ensure compliance with Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) rules and regulations;
b. Protect the public health, safety, and welfare; and
c. Provide for the free and unobstructed passage of all aircraft through all airspace above
communities served by airports.
Applicability
The following air space and safety zones are included in the APO district, and different
standards applying to each:
a. Primary Zone
1) All that land that lies directly under an imaginary primary surface longitudinally
centered on a runway and extending 200 feet beyond each end of runways 13, 31,
2, and 20.
2) The elevation of any point on the primary surface is the same as the elevation of
the nearest point on the runway centerline. The width of the primary surface is
1000 feet for runways 13, 31, 2, and 20.
b. Horizontal Zone
1) All that land that lies directly under an imaginary horizontal surface 150 feet above
the established airport elevation, or a height of 1,467 feet above mean sea level,
the perimeter of which is constructed by swinging arcs of specified radii from the
center of each end of the primary surface of each runway and connect the adjacent
arcs by lines tangent to those arcs.
2) The radius of each arc is 10,000 feet for runways 13, 31, 2, and 20.
c. Conical Zone
All that land that lies directly under an imaginary conical surface extending upward and
outward from the periphery of the horizontal surface at a slope of 20:1 for a horizontal
distance of 4,000 feet as measured outward from the periphery of the horizontal surface.
d. Precision Instrument Approach Zone
1) All that land that lies directly under an imaginary precision instrument approach
surface longitudinally centered on the extended centerline at each end of 13, 31,
2, and 20 a precision instrument runways.
2) The inner edge of the precision instrument approach surface is at the same width
and elevation as, and coincides with, the end of the primary surface.
3) The precision instrument approach surface inclines upward and outward at a slope
of 50:1 for a horizontal distance of 10,000 feet expanding uniformly to a width of
4,000 feet, then continues upward and outward for an additional horizontal
distance of 40,000 feet at a slope of 40:1, expanding uniformly to an ultimate
width of 16,000 feet.
e. Transitional Zone
1) All that land that lies directly under an imaginary surface extending upward and
outward at right angles to the runway centerline and centerline extended at a slope
of 7:1 from the sides of the primary surfaces and from the sides of the approach
surfaces until they intersect the horizontal surface or the conical surface.
2) Transitional surfaces for those portions of the precision instrument approach
surface that project through and beyond the limits of the conical surface, extend a
distance of 5,000 feet measured horizontally from the edge of the precision
instrument approach surface and at right angles to the extended precision
instrument runway centerline.
f. Safety Zone A
All land in that portion of the approach zones of a runway that extends outward from the
end of primary surface a distance equal to two thirds of the planned length of the
runway. The distance shall be:
1) 6,023 feet for runways 13 and 31.
2) 5,570 feet for runways 2 and 20.
g. Safety Zone B
All land in that portion of the approach zones of a runway that extends outward from
Safety Zone A, a distance equal to one-third of the planned length of the runway. The
distance shall be:
1) 3,533 feet for runways 13 and 31.
2) 2,833 feet for runways 2 and 20.
h. Safety Zone C
All land that is enclosed within the perimeter of the horizontal zone and that is not
included in Safety Zone A or Safety Zone B.
Airport Zoning Map
The Airport Zoning Map illustrates the boundaries of the airport zones listed in this
Subsection 2 above and is adopted as part of this UDC.
Boundary Limitations
The air space obstruction height zoning restrictions set forth in this Section 60.200.040B
shall apply for a distance not to exceed one and one half miles beyond the perimeter of the
airport boundary and in that portion of an airport hazard area under the approach zone for a
distance not exceeding two miles from the airport boundary.
Height Restrictions
Except as otherwise provided in this UDC, and except as necessary and incidental to airport
operations, no structure or tree shall be constructed, altered, maintained, or allowed to grow
in the APO district so as to project above any of the imaginary air space surfaces described
Subsection 2. Where an area is covered by more than one height limitation, the more
restrictive limitation shall apply.
Use Restrictions
a. Generally
1) No use shall be made of any land in any of the Safety Zones that:
(a) Creates or causes interference with the operations of radio or electronic
facilities on the airport or with radio or electronic communications between
the airport and aircraft; and/or
(b) Makes it difficult for pilots to distinguish between airport lights and other
lights, results in glare in the eyes of pilots using the airport, impairs visibility
in the vicinity of the airport, or otherwise endangers the landing, taking off, or
maneuvering of aircraft.
2) Any use not explicitly prohibited in this Section 60.200.040B.7 may, when
determined by the Commissioner of the Minnesota Department of Transportation,
be prohibited if the Commissioner determines that it constitutes a material danger
to the landing, taking off, or maneuvering of aircraft or to the safety of persons on
(a) Part or all of the lot received interim or final grading plan approval by both the
City engineer and the Community Development Director prior to October 1,
2006; or
(b) The lot is part of a final plat approved prior to October 1, 2006.
3) All areas of buildable lots shall be exempt from the special protection provided to
Groundwater Supported Slope Wetlands if the lot is included in a development for
which a replacement plan has been approved prior to October 1, 2006, addressing
the Groundwater Supported Slope Wetland.
Exemptions
a. Application
1) A landowner may apply for an exemption from the provisions of the WCA and this
DEO district if the property to be impacted or hydrologically altered meets the
wetland exemption criteria contained in Minn. R. pt. 8420.0420. Any Edge Support
Area associated with an exempted Groundwater Supported Slope Wetland shall
also be exempted.
2) A landowner intending to impact or hydrologically alter a wetland without
replacement, claiming exemption, shall apply to the Community Development
Director before beginning excavation, draining, or filling activities for determination
whether or not the activity is exempt.
b. Decision
1) Exemption decisions under Minn. R. pt. 8420.0420 shall be made by the
Community Development Director.
2) The Community Development Director may seek the advice of the technical
evaluation panel as specified in Minn. R. pt. 8420.0240(C).
c. Appeal
1) The Community Development Director’s decision is final unless appealed to the City
Council within 30 days after written notice of the Community Development
Director's determination is mailed to the applicant.
2) An exemption notice of decision shall be provided to the landowner upon the
Community Development Director's or City Council's determination that the activity
qualifies for exemption.
3) The authority granted by the notice of decision shall be stayed during the time an
appeal is pending before the state board of water and soil resources.
Exceptions
Requests for exceptions to provisions of this Section related to Edge Support Areas (where
the applicant contends that the Section should not be applied to the property in question, in
whole or in part) shall be heard by the City Council at the time of General Development Plan
review, or at the time of wetland delineation if a General Development Plan is not required.
Applicants may seek exceptions to restrictions on disturbance of Edge Support Areas on the
basis of public safety concerns, other overriding public interest, unreasonable hardship, or
constraints that deny a reasonable use of the property.
No Loss Decision
a. Application
A landowner unsure if proposed work will result in a loss of wetlands may apply for a no-
loss decision as specified in Minn. R. pt. 8420.0315.
b. Decision
1) No-loss decisions, under Minn. R. pts. 8420.0410 and 8420.0415, shall be made
by the Community Development Director.
2) The Community Development Director may seek the advice of the technical
evaluation panel on questions of wetland delineation and type.
c. Appeal
1) The Community Development Director’s decision is final unless appealed to the City
Council within 30 days after written notice of the Community Development
Director's decision is sent to those required to receive notice of the decision.
2) The landowner applying for a no-loss decision is responsible for submitting the
proof necessary to show qualification for this determination. The authority granted
by the decision shall be stayed during the time an appeal is pending before the
state Board of Water and Soil Resources.
Sequencing and Replacement Plan Decision
a. A landowner intending to impact a wetland who does not qualify for an exemption or no-
loss decision shall obtain approval of a replacement plan from the City Council. An
applicant may either submit the information required for sequencing analysis as part of a
replacement plan application or apply separately for a preliminary sequencing decision
from the local government unit before preparing a complete replacement plan.
b. The sequencing decision, where submitted separately from the replacement plan under
Minn. R. pt. 8420.0325 and sequencing flexibility under Minn. R. pt. 8420.0520, subpt.
7a, shall be made by the Community Development Director. Replacement plans intended
to mitigate wetland impacts within the City must involve the creation or restoration of
wetlands located within the county.
c. Replacement Plans
1) No person may impact a wetland, wholly or partially, without being eligible for an
exemption or no-loss, or first receiving approval of a wetland replacement plan as
specified in Minn. R. pt. 8420.0500.
2) A landowner proposing a wetland impact that requires replacement must apply to
the City and receive approval of a replacement plan before impacting the wetland.
b. Only wetland credits from wetland banks within the county may be used for wetland
replacement when wetland within the City is impacted.
Fees
The City Council shall, by resolution, adopt a schedule of fees applicable to wetland
delineation applications, no-loss applications, exemption applications, sequencing
applications, replacement plan applications, banking plan applications, and monitoring
reports submittals. The amount of the fees shall not exceed the reasonable value of the
functions undertaken by the LGU.
Appeals
a. Decisions made under this Section by the Community Development Director may be
appealed to the City Council. An appeal must be filed within 10 days after the date that
the decision is sent to those required to receive notice of the decision. Except for
decisions related to Edge Support Areas, decisions of the City Council may be appealed
to the state Board of Water and Soil Resources under Minn. R. pt. 8420.0905 after final
determination by the City Council.
b. A landowner or responsible party may appeal the terms and conditions of a restoration or
replacement order issued according to Minn. R. pt. 8420.0905 to the state Board of
Water and Soil Resources executive director within 30 days of receipt of the order.
Delegation
The City may, by joint powers agreement, delegate to the Soil and Water Conservation District
under Minn. Stats. §§471.59 and 103C.331, Subd. 19, the authority to administer all or any
part of this Section.
Designation
a. General Requirements
1) Each individual flood subdistrict represents a set of regulations superimposed upon
the existing zoning districts, superseding existing underlying regulations only to the
extent that developments must meet the additional standards of the FPO district as
well as those of the underlying district in order to be in compliance with this UDC.
2) The Flood Fringe (FF), Floodway (FW), and Flood Prone (FP) subdistricts are
identified upon the zoning map, and reference to the status of any property located
in one of the flood related districts is made by the district symbol (FF, FW, or FP)
being post fixed to a use district symbol (examples R-l/FF, B- 4/FW, M-2/FP).
Section 60.500.040E.2.d addresses zoning designation of property in the FW or FF
annexed to the city.
3) To aid in the identification and designation of properties in the flood related
districts, certain materials are attached and hereby adopted by reference and
declared to be part of this UDC including the Flood Insurance Study for Olmsted
County, Minnesota, and Incorporated Areas, and the Flood Insurance Rate Map for
Olmsted County and Incorporated Areas, all dated April 19, 2017 and prepared by
the Federal Emergency Management Agency, including the following panels:
27109C0141F, 27109C0142F, 27109C0143E, 27109C0144F, 27109C0153F,
27109C0154F, 27109C0155E, 27109C0158E, 27109C0161F, 27109C0162F,
27109C0163F, 27109C0164F, 27109C0166F, 27109C0168F, 27109C0169E,
27109C0282F, 27109C0301F, 27109C0302F, 27109C0304E, 27109C0306F,
27109C0307E, and 27109C0313E, or the most recent revisions of or replacement
for those panels.
b. Designation of the Floodway Subdistrict
1) The floodway subdistrict standards shall apply to all lands designated as floodway
on the Flood Insurance Rate Map adopted in Section 60.200.040E.2, Floodplain
Development Permit Required
Those activities listed in Section 60.500.060H Floodplain Development Permit must obtain a
permit pursuant to that Section before beginning any activity, development, or change to
land or uses of property in the FPO districts.
2) Designation. The Floodway subdistrict also includes those areas designated as
Zone A (that do not have a floodway designation) on the Flood Insurance Rate Map.
3) For lakes, wetlands, and other basins, the Floodway subdistrict includes those
areas that are at or below the ordinary high-water level as defined in Minn. Stat.
§103G.005, Subd. 14.
c. Designation of the Flood Fringe Subdistrict
1) The Flood Fringe subdistrict includes those areas within Zone AE and designated as
floodway fringe, or within Zone AO on the Flood Insurance Rate Map adopted in this
Section and were within the corporate boundaries of the City prior to November 3,
1980.
2) For lakes, wetlands, and other basins (that do not have a floodway designated), the
Flood Fringe subdistrict includes those areas designated as Zone AE on the Flood
Insurance Rate Map panels adopted in this Section that are below the 1 percent
annual chance (100-year) flood elevation but above the Ordinary High Water Level
as defined in Minn. Stat., §103G.005, Subd. 14.
d. Designation of the Flood Prone Subdistrict
The Flood Prone subdistrict includes those areas designated as floodway fringe on the
Flood Insurance Rate Map adopted in this Section, as being within Zone AE but being
located outside of the floodway, and were annexed on or after November 3, 1980, except
as determined by the provisions of Section 60.500.040E.2.e.
Warning and Disclaimer of Liability
a. The degree of flood protection intended to be provided by the UDC is considered
reasonable for regulatory purposes and is based on engineering and other specific
methods of study.
b. Larger floods may occur on rare occasions, or the flood height may be increased by man-
made or natural causes, such as ice jams or bridge openings restricted by debris.
c. The UDC does not imply that areas outside of designated floodplain districts or land uses
permitted within such districts will always be totally free from flooding or flood damages.
Nor shall the UDC create a liability on the part of or be a cause of action against the City
or any employee thereof for any flooding or flood damages that may result from reliance
on the UDC.
Reclamation
Nothing herein shall be so construed as to prohibit the lawful rehabilitation or reclamation of
any lands outside of the floodway, provided that no filling, draining, construction of levees, or
other improvements intended to eliminate or reduce the danger of the flood or erosion shall
be commenced until first reviewed and authorized by the Community Development Director
and the Commissioner, and, if revisions to floodplain maps or designations are proposed, by
the Federal Emergency Management Agency.
Right of Passage
No person may obstruct the passage of water and watercraft nor restrict the lawfully
permitted use by the public of the bed, banks, water, and floodway of any stream within the
City.
Floodplain Limits
Where a conflict exists between the floodplain limits illustrated on the official zoning map
and actual field conditions including the natural or pre-existing grades, the map flood
elevations shall be the governing factor in locating the regulatory floodplain limits.
to a depth and velocity such that the depth (in feet) multiplied by the velocity (in feet per
second) would exceed a product of four upon occurrence of the regional (1 percent
chance) flood.
c. Flood Prone and Floodway Uses
Permitted uses are the following uses that have a low flood damage potential and do not
obstruct flood flows. These uses are permitted within the Floodway and Flood Prone
subdistricts to the extent that they are not prohibited by the underlying zoning district or
any other ordinance and provided they do not require structures, fill, or storage of
materials or equipment. In addition, no use shall adversely affect the capacity of the
channel or floodways of any tributary to the main stream, or of any drainage ditch or
other drainage facility.
1) Agricultural uses such as general farming, pasture, grazing, outdoor plant
nurseries, horticulture, truck farming, forestry, sod farming, and wild crop
harvesting.
2) Industrial-commercial uses such as loading areas, parking areas, billboards, airport
landing strips.
3) Private and public recreational uses such as golf courses, tennis courts, driving
ranges, picnic grounds, boat launching ramps, swimming area, parks, wildlife and
nature preserves, fishing areas, recreational trails.
4) Residential uses such as lawns, gardens, parking areas, and recreation areas.
5) Channel Modifications requiring a DNR permit where there is no change in the flood
profile.
d. Flood Fringe Uses
Uses permitted in the Food Fringe subdistrict are the same as those permitted by the
underlying zoning district, subject to meeting the construction standards in this Section
60.200.040E.
e. Floodway Conditional Uses
The following uses involving structures (temporary or permanent), fill, or the storage of
materials or equipment, are permitted in the Floodway subdistrict only after a Conditional
Use permit is obtained.
1) Structures accessory to open space or conditional uses.
2) Placement of fill.
3) Extraction of sand, gravel, and other minerals.
4) Marinas, boat rentals, docks, and water control structures.
5) Railroads, streets, bridges, utility transmission lines and pipelines, provided that
the Department of Natural Resources’ Area Hydrologist is notified at least 10 days
prior to issuance of any permit.
1) Residential basement construction shall not be allowed below the Regulatory Flood
Protection Elevation.
2) Non-residential basements may be allowed below the Regulatory Flood Protection
Elevation provided the basement is structurally dry flood proofed in accordance
with Section 60.500.060G, Minor Land Subdivision Permit.
f. Additional Development Standards
The standards in this Subsection f shall apply to the uses indicated. These standards are
imposed in addition to any other applicable FPO standards.
1) Manufacturing and Industrial Uses
(a) Manufacturing and industrial buildings, structures and appurtenant works
shall be protected to the flood protection elevation.
(b) Measures shall be taken to minimize interference with normal plant
operations, especially for streams having prolonged flood durations.
(c) In considering permit applications, due consideration shall be given to needs
of an industry whose business requires that it be located in floodplain areas.
2) Fill
(a) Fill shall be properly compacted, and the slopes shall be properly protected
by the use of riprap, vegetative cover, or other acceptable method.
(b) Permanent sand and gravel operations and similar uses must be covered by
a long-term Site Development Plan as approved under other provisions of this
UDC. The cumulative placement of fill where at any one time in excess of
1,000 cubic yards of fill is located on the parcel shall be allowable only as a
conditional use, unless said fill is specifically intended to elevate a structure
in accordance with Section 60.200.040E.10 Flood Fringe Construction
Standards.
(c) When at any time more than 1,000 cubic yards of fill or other similar material
is located on a parcel for such activities as on-site storage, landscaping, sand
and gravel operations, landfills, roads, dredge spoil disposal or construction
of flood control works, an erosion/sedimentation control plan must be
submitted unless the community is enforcing a state approved shoreland
management ordinance. In the absence of a state approved shoreland
management ordinance, the plan must clearly specify methods to be used to
stabilize the fill on site for a flood event at a minimum of the 100 year or
regional flood event. The plan must be prepared and certified by a registered
professional engineer or other qualified individual acceptable to the
Community Development Director. The plan may incorporate alternative
procedures for removal of the material from the floodplain if adequate flood
warning time exists.
3) Garbage and Solid Waste Disposal
There shall be no disposal of garbage or solid waste materials within Flood Fringe
areas. No Conditional Use Permits for garbage and waste disposal sites shall be
issued for Flood Fringe subdistrict. There shall be no further encroachment upon
the floodplain at existing sites.
4) On-site Water Supply and Sewage Treatment Systems
Where public utilities are not provided:
(a) On‐site water supply systems must be designed to minimize or eliminate
infiltration of flood waters into the systems and are subject to the provisions
in Minn. R. Ch. 4725.4350, as amended; and
(b) New or replacement on‐site sewage treatment systems must be designed to
minimize or eliminate infiltration of flood waters into the systems and
discharges from the systems into flood waters, they must not be subject to
impairment or contamination during times of flooding, and are subject to the
provisions in Minn. R. Ch. 7080.2270, as amended.
Floodway Construction Standards
No structures (temporary or permanent); fill, including fill for roads and levees; deposits,
obstructions, storage of materials or equipment; or other uses allowed as Conditional Uses
that, acting alone or in combination with existing or future uses, cause any increase in the
stage of the one percent chance or regional flood or cause an increase in flood damages in
the reach or reaches affected, shall be permitted. Consideration of the effects of a proposed
use shall be based on a reasonable assumption that there will be an equal degree of
encroachment extending for a significant reach on both sides of the stream. In addition, all
floodway conditional uses shall be subject to the regulations in the following paragraphs.
a. Fill
1) Any fill deposited in the floodway shall be no more than the minimum amount
necessary to conduct a Conditional Use listed in Section 60.200.040E.9.e,
Floodway Conditional Uses.
2) Generally, fill shall be limited to that needed to grade or landscape for that use and
shall not in any way obstruct the flow of flood waters or cause any increase in flood
elevations.
3) Such fill or other material shall be protected against erosion by rip-rap, vegetative
cover or bulkheading. Dredge spoil sites and sand and gravel operations shall not
be allowed in the floodway unless a long-term Site Development Plan is submitted
that includes an erosion/sedimentation prevention element to the plan.
b. Structures
Accessory structures (temporary or permanent) approved by the Planning Commission
shall be subject to the following standards:
1) Not designed for human habitation;
2) Designed to have low flood damage potential;
3) Constructed and placed on the building site so as to offer the minimum resistance
to the flood or floodwaters;
4) Whenever possible, structures shall be constructed with the longitudinal axis
parallel to the direction of flood flow; and
5) So far as practicable, structures shall be placed approximately on the same flood
flow lines as those of adjoining structures.
c. Accessory Structures
1) Accessory structures shall be structurally dry flood proofed in accordance with the
FP-3 or FP-4 flood proofing classifications in the state Building Code. All flood
proofed accessory structures must meet the following additional standards as
appropriate:
(a) The structure must be adequately anchored to prevent flotation, collapse or
lateral movement of the structure and shall be designed to equalize
hydrostatic flood forces on exterior walls.
(b) Any mechanical and utility equipment in a structure must be elevated to or
above the Regulatory Flood Protection Elevation or properly flood proofed.
2) As an alternative, an accessory structure may be internally/wet floodproofed to the
FP-1 or FP-2 floodproofing classifications in the state Building Code provided the
accessory structure constitutes a minimal investment and that does not exceed
500 square feet for the outside dimension at ground level. Designs for meeting this
requirement must either be certified by a registered professional engineer or meet
or exceed the standards in Subsection 1). To meet this requirement, detached
garages must be used solely for parking of vehicles and limited storage.
(a) To allow for the equalization of hydrostatic pressure, there must be a
minimum of two “automatic” openings in the outside walls of the structure,
with a total net area of not less than one square inch for every square foot of
enclosed area subject to flooding; and
(b) There must be openings on at least two sides of the structure and the bottom
of all openings must be no higher than one foot above the lowest adjacent
grade to the structure. Using human intervention to open a garage door prior
to flooding will not comply with this requirement for automatic openings.
d. Utilities, Railroad Tracks, Streets, and Bridges
1) Public utility facilities, roads, railroad tracks, and bridges within the floodway district
shall be designed to minimize increases in flood elevations and shall be compatible
with local comprehensive floodplain development plans. Such facilities must
comply with Section 60.200.040E.11, Floodway Construction Standards.
2) Protection to the flood protection elevation shall be provided where failure or
interruption of these public facilities are essential to the orderly functioning of the
area.
3) Where failures or interruption of service would not endanger life or health, a lesser
degree of protection may be provided for minor or auxiliary roads, railroads, or
utilities.
e. Storage of Material and Equipment
1) The storage or processing of materials that are in time of flooding buoyant,
flammable, explosive or that could be injurious to human, animal, or plant life, or
that are likely to cause pollution of waters, as defined by Minn. Stat. §115.01, is
prohibited.
2) Materials that, in time of flooding, are buoyant, flammable, explosive, or could be
injurious to human, animal, or plant life shall be stored at or above the Regulatory
Flood Protection Elevation (RFPE), floodproofed, or protected by other measures as
approved by the Director of Community Development.
3) Storage of materials likely to cause pollution of the waters, such as sewage; sand;
rock; wrecked and discarded equipment; dredged spoil; municipal, agricultural or
industrial waste; and other wastes as further defined in Minn. Stat. §115.01, are
prohibited unless adequate safeguards approved by the Minnesota Pollution
Control Agency are provided. For projects not requiring approvals by the Minnesota
Pollution Control Agency, adequate safeguards must be approved by the Director of
Community Development prior to issuance of a permit.
f. Garbage and Solid Waste Disposal
No Conditional Use Permits for garbage and waste disposal sites shall be issued for
floodway areas. There shall be no further encroachment upon the floodway at existing
sites.
g. Structural Works for Flood Control
Structural works for flood control such as levees, dikes, floodwalls, and reservoirs shall
be allowed after Council approval, and compliance with the following:
1) Any proposed structural work in the beds of public waters, as defined in Ch.
103G.245, that will change the course, current, or cross-section of the waters shall
be subject to the provisions of Minnesota Rule, parts 6115.0150-6115.0280, and
other applicable statutes.
2) When necessary, a permit from the Army Corps of Engineers certifying compliance
with Section 404 of the Clean Waters Act shall be obtained, along with any other
necessary permits.
h. On-Site Water Supply and Sewage Treatment Systems
Where public utilities are not provided:
1) On‐site water supply systems must be designed to minimize or eliminate infiltration
of flood waters into the systems and are subject to the provisions in Minn. R. Ch.
4725.4350, as amended; and
engineer or architect shall certify that the flood-proofing methods are adequate to withstand
the flood depth, pressures, velocities, impact, and uplift forces. Where a nonconforming
structure is extended or substantially altered the certificate of zoning compliance shall
specifically state how the nonconforming use or structure differs from the flood protection
standards and criteria in this UDC.
Recordkeeping
The Community Development Director shall maintain a record of the lowest floor (including
basement) elevation of, and the floodproofing measures incorporated into, all new structures
and alterations or additions to existing structures in any of the flood districts within the FPO
district.
2) A body of water created by a private user where there was no previous shoreland
may, at the discretion of the governing body, be exempt from the shoreland
provisions.
3) The following reaches of stream are exempt from the SDO:
(a) South Fork Zumbro River from the centerline of the T.H. 52 bridge to the
centerline of the 37th Street NW bridge.
(b) Silver Creek corridor from the eastern boundary of Quarry Hill park to its
confluence with the South Fork Zumbro River.
(c) Bear Creek from the centerline of the T.H. 14 bridge downstream to its
confluence with the South Fork Zumbro River.
(d) Cascade Creek from the centerline of the T.H. 52 bridge downstream to its
confluence with the South Fork Zumbro River.
(e) Willow Creek from the centerline of 40th Street SW, downstream to the
western boundary of Section 24, T106N, R14W, Rochester Township.
(f) North Run of the North Fork Cascade Creek from the centerline of 7th Street
NW to its confluence with Cascade Creek.
Uses Allowed in the Shoreland District Overlay
All uses permitted in the base zoning district, as described in Table 300.02-1 Allowed Uses
Table, shall be allowed within the Shoreland District Overlay, subject to the following
exceptions:
a. Intensive vegetation clearing of forest land for conversion to another use is not permitted
in the Shoreland District Overlay.
b. Agricultural production is not permitted as a principal use in the Shoreland District
Overlay.
c. Residential development that contains more than four units shall require a Shoreland
Protection Permit as described in Section 60.500.050C.
d. Industrial uses require a Shoreland Protection Permit as described in Section
60.500.050C, in addition to any other approvals required by the base zoning district, as
shown in Table 300.02-1 Allowed Uses Table.
e. Accessory agricultural uses require a Shoreland Protection Permit, as described in
Section 60.500.050C.
Lot Area, Width, and Density Standards
After the effective date of this UDC, all new lots must meet the requirements of this Section
60.200.040F.4.
a. The use of private sewage disposal systems and private water supply to serve any new
development within the City is subject to the requirements of Section 60.400.030E.3,
Public Facilities, of the UDC.
b. Lands within the Shoreland District Overlay shall meet the base zone district lot area
requirements and the following lot width standards:
Dwelling Type Agricultural River Urban Urban
River/Tributary (On River/Tributary
Public Sewer) (Other1)
Single 150 feet 75 feet 100 feet
Duplex 225 feet 115 feet 150 feet
Triplex 300 feet 150 feet 200 feet
Quad 375 feet 190 feet 250 feet
c. Only lands above the Ordinary High Water Level (OHWL) can be used to meet lot
dimensional standards.
d. Lot width standards must be met at both the OHWL and at the building line.
e. Lots intended as controlled accesses to public waters or as recreation areas for use by
owners of non-riparian lots may be platted as outlots. Outlots do not need to meet the
applicable lot area requirements, but shall meet the minimum lot width standards.
Setbacks, Design, and Height of Structures
a. Setbacks
1) Structures outside of the Shoreland Impact Zone must be located a minimum of 50
feet from the OHWL.
2) When more than one setback applies to a site, structures and facilities must be
located to meet all setbacks.
3) Structure setbacks are dependent upon the type of sewage system, and shall be
set back from the OHWL by at least the following distances:
River Type Structure with No Sewer Structures with Sewer Sewage Treatment
Systems
Agricultural 100 feet 50 feet 75 feet
Urban 50 feet 50 feet 75 feet
Tributary 75 feet 50 feet 75 feet
(f) Fill or excavated material shall not be placed in a manner that creates an
unstable slope;
(g) Plans to place fill or excavated material on steep slopes shall be reviewed by
qualified professionals for continued slope stability and shall not create
finished slopes of 30 percent or steeper;
(h) Fill or excavated materials shall not be placed in bluff impact zones;
(i) Any alterations below the Ordinary High Water Level of public waters shall
first be authorized by the Minnesota Commissioner of Natural Resources
under Minn. Stat. §103.G.245;
(j) Alterations of topography shall only be allowed if they are accessory to
permitted or conditional uses and do not adversely affect adjacent or nearby
properties; and
(k) Placement of natural rock riprap, including associated grading of the
shoreline and placement of a filter blanket, is permitted if the finished slope
does not exceed three feet horizontal to one foot vertical, the landward extent
of the riprap is within 10 feet of the OHWL, and the height of the riprap above
the OHWL does not exceed three feet.
c. Connections to Public Waters
Excavations where the intended purpose is connection to a public water, such as boat
slips, canals, lagoons, and harbors, shall comply with Minnesota Rules, Chapter 6115 .
Permission for excavations may be given only after the Minnesota Commissioner of
Natural Resources has approved the proposed connection to public waters.
Placement and Design of Roads, Driveways, and Parking Areas
Public roads are regulated by Section 60.400.030, Subdivision Standards, of this UDC, and
parking areas are regulated by Section 60.400.080, Parking, Loading, and Stacking, of this
UDC. The following additional standards shall apply within the SDO – Shoreland District
Overlay. They are intended to supplement, not replace, the aforementioned standards.
a. Roads, driveways, and parking areas shall meet building setbacks and may not be
placed within Bluff Impact Zone and/or Shoreland Impact Zone, and shall in no case be
closer than 25 feet to the OHWL.
b. Public and private roads and parking areas shall be designed to minimize earthwork,
and to take advantage of natural vegetation and natural topography to achieve
maximum screening of view from public waters.
c. Roads, driveways, and parking areas shall meet erosion control standards as described
in Section 60.400.050G.2, Erosion Control, as well as the requirements of any other
applicable design standards, ordinances and permits.
Stormwater Management
a. Stormwater shall be managed in accordance with all applicable City Engineering
Standards, ordinances, and permits.
b. Within the Shoreland District Overlay boundary, impervious surface coverage of lots
shall not exceed 25 percent of the lot area.
c. No net increase from the pre-project conditions is permitted pursuant to section 6-4-
12(1)a, Stormwater Management Criteria for Permanent Facilities and BMPs, of the
Rochester Code of Ordinances.
d. No net increase in flood rate or velocity from the pre-project conditions is permitted.
e. When constructed facilities are used for stormwater management, documentation shall
be provided by a qualified individual that they are designed and installed consistent with
the City Engineering Standards.
f. Newly constructed stormwater outfalls to public waters shall provide for filtering or
settling of suspended solids and skimming of surface debris before discharge and shall
be consistent with Minnesota Rules, part 6115.0231.
approval and the City will issue written confirmation of that fact at the request of the property
owner.
A “I” in a cell of the Allowed Uses Table indicates that the use is permitted as an interim
primary use subject to any Use-specific Standards referenced in the right-hand column of
that row of the table. Interim uses require approval by City Council, any approval must state a
period of time during which the use may operate.
A “A” in a cell of the Allowed Uses Table indicates that the use is permitted as an accessory
use only in support of a permitted use on the site, and subject to the Use-Specific Standards
cross-referenced in the right-hand column of that row of the table.
A “T” in a cell of the Allowed Uses Table indicates that the use is permitted as a temporary
use, subject to the Use-Specific Standards cross-referenced in the right-hand column of that
row of the table.
A “*” next to a use in the Allowed Uses Table indicates that a Use-Specific Standard cross-
referenced in the right-hand column of the table applies to the use in the zone district where
the “*” appears. Details about the Use-Specific Standards are in Section 60.300.030.
A blank cell in the Allowed Use Table indicates that the use is not allowed in that zoning
district.
Unlisted Uses and Structures
When a proposed primary, accessory, or temporary land use is not explicitly listed in the Allowed
Use Table, the use is not permitted in Rochester, unless the Community Development Director
determines that it is included in the definition of a listed use or is so similar to a listed use that it
shall be treated as the same use. The Director shall make that determination based on a
comparison of the size, scale, operating characteristics, multi-modal traffic impacts, storm
drainage impacts, utility impacts, and neighborhood impacts of the proposed use with other uses
listed in the Allowed Use Table. The Director’s interpretation shall be made available to the public
and shall be binding on future decisions of the City until the Director makes a different
interpretation or this UDC is amended to treat the use differently.
Relation to Local, State, or Federal Laws
Pursuant to authority by Minnesota Statues, Section 462.3593. Subdivision 9, the City opts-
out of the requirement of Minnesota Statues 462.3593 that defines and regulates
Temporary Family Health Care Dwellings.
All uses required by any local, state, or federal government to have an approval, license, or
permit to operate are required to have that local, state, or federal approval, license, or permit
in effect at all times, and failure to do so is a violation of this UDC.
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
B4
Residential Uses
Household Living
Dwelling, Single-
S S S S
Family Detached
Dwelling, Twin-
- S S S S S
Home
Dwelling, Attached S S S S S S S S S S S S
Dwelling, Duplex,
S S S S S S S
Same Lot
Dwelling, Triplex S S S S S V S S
Dwelling, Fourplex S S S S S V S S
Dwelling, Section
S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
Multifamily 60.300.030B.3
Dwelling, Live/Work S S S S S S S S S S S
Dwelling, Cottage Section
S* S* S* S* S* S S S S S
Development 60.300.030B.2
Manufactured Section
P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P*
Home Park 60.300.030B.4
Group Living
Congregate Section
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
Housing 60.300.030B.1
Dormitory Section
P P P
60.300.030B.1
Medical Stay
S S S S S S S S S S S S S
Dwelling Unit
Nursing Home Section
P* P* P P* P* P S S S S S S S S S S
60.300.030B.5
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Offender B4
Section
Transitional C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C*
60.300.030B.6
Housing
Residential Care S/ S/ S/ S/ S/ Section
S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
Facility P* P* P* P* P* 60.300.030B.7
Public, Institutional, and Civic Uses
Art Gallery,
Museum, and P P P P S S S S S S S S S S S S S
Library
Cemetery Section
P* P* P* P* P* P*
60.300.030C.1
College or
P P P P P P P P P P P
University
Community Center Section
P* P* P* P* P* P* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
60.300.030C.2
Community Garden Section
S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
60.300.030C.3
Correctional Facility C C C C C
Day Care Facility S/ S/ S/ S/ S/ S/ Section
S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* P* P* P*
P P* P* P* P* P* 60.300.030C.4
Emergency Service Section
P* P* P* P* P* P* P* P* S* S* S* P* P* P* P* P* P* S* S* S*
60.300.030C.5
Funeral Home Section
P P P S* S* S S S S S S
60.300.030C.6
Medical Facility Section
P* P* P* P* P* S* S S S S S S S S S S
60.300.030C.7
Place of Worship Section
S S S S S S S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
60.300.030C.8
Public Park S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S P
School Section
S* S* S* S* S* S* P* P* P* P* P* P* P*
60.300.030C.9
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Social Services
P P* P* P* P* S* S S S S S S S S S S S B4 Section
60.300.030C.10
Specialized
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
Education
Commercial Uses
Agricultural and Animal Uses
Agriculture Section
S P* P* * S S
Production 60.300.030D.2
Agriculture Retail S S P S S
Veterinary and Section
S* S S S S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
Animal Services 60.300.030D.26
Entertainment and Recreation
Adult Entertainment Section
S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
60.300.030D.1
Auditorium or Civic
P P P P P P P P P P P P P P P P P
Center
Campgrounds or Section
P* P*
RV Park 60.300.030D.8
Indoor
Section
Entertainment or P* P* S* S* S S S S S S S S S S S
60.300.030D.11
Recreation
Indoor Gun Range Section
C* C* C*
60.300.030D.12
Outdoor
Section
Entertainment or P* P* S* S* P* P S*
60.300.030D.17
Recreation
Food, Beverage, and Lodging
Bar or Tavern Section
P S S S* S S S S S* S S P P*
60.300.030D.5
Bed and Breakfast Section
P* P* P* P* S S S S S
60.300.030D.6
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Fast Food
P* P* S* S S S S S S S B4 S S S
Section
Restaurant 60.300.030D.9
Hotel or Motel S S S S S S S S S S P
Neighborhood Section
S S S S* S* S S S S S S S S S
Food and Service 60.300.030D.15
Standard Section
P* S S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S*
Restaurant 60.300.030D.21
Office, Business, and Professional Services
Art Studio and Section
V S S S S S S S S S S S S
Workshop 60.300.030D.4
Business or Section
S* S* S* S* S* S S* S* S S S S S S S S
Personal Service 60.300.030D.7
Financial Institution S S S S S S S S S S S S S
Office Section
P* S* S* S S S S S S S S S S S
60.300.030D.16
Research and Section
P S S S S S P* S P S S S
Testing 60.300.030D.20
Retail Sales
Retail, Section
S V S S* S* S S S S S S S S S
Neighborhood 60.300.030D.22
Retail, Small Section
P* P* S* S* S S S S S S S S S S
60.300.030D.23
Retail, Medium Section
S* S S S S S S S S
60.300.030D.24
Retail, Large Section
P S* P* S* S* S* S* S* P S*
60.300.030D.25
Vehicles and Transportation
Air Transportation Section
C* C* P* P*
60.300.030D.3
Automotive Center P P S S S S S
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Automotive Repair
P S B4 P S S
Services, Major
Fueling Station Section
* P* S* S* A* S S* S*
60.300.030D.10
Motor Freight and Section
P S* P P S* S*
Warehousing 60.300.030D.13
Motor Vehicle
Section
Sales, Leasing or S S* S* S* S
60.300.030D.14
Storage
Parking Garage Section
A* A* A* S* C* C* C* C* C* C* A* A* A*
60.300.030D.18
Parking Lot Section
A A* A* A* A* A* A* A* S S S C* C* C* I I I S S S
60.300.030D.19
Public
Transportation S P P P S P P S S S
Dispatch Facility
Railroad
S
Transportation
Industrial Uses
Manufacturing, Processing, and Commercial Services
Artisan
S S S S P S S S S S S
Manufacturing
Heavy Commercial
S S P P S S
Services
Heavy Industry Section
S*
60.300.030E.1
Light Industry P S S S
Recycling Transfer
S S S P S S
Facility
Repair and Section
P* S* S* S* S* S* S* S* S S S
Maintenance Shop 60.300.030E.4
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Utility, Major
C* B4
C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C* C*
Section
60.300.030F.3
Utility, Minor A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A
Wind Energy
Conversion System Section
P* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* P* P* P*
(WECS), Ground- or 60.300.030F.3
Building- Mounted
Accessory Uses and Structures Section
60.300.030G.1
Accessory Dwelling Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
Unit 60.300.030G.5
Animal Husbandry Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.6
Drive-in Facility Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.7
Electric Vehicle
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A
Charging Station
Fuel Tank Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.8
Garage Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.9
Greenhouse Section
A A* A* A* A* A* A A A A A A A A
60.300.030G.10
Home Occupation Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.11
Outdoor Eating Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
Area 60.300.030G.12
Recreational Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
Vehicle Parking 60.300.030G.13
Recycling Drop Box Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.14
Non-
Residential and
Mixed Use Residen-
Agricultural
tial
New zoning
MX-N
MX-G
MX-D
MX-C
MX-S
MX-T
R-2x
districts
MX-I
R-1
R-2
R-3
R4, CDC Res R-4
AG
BP
SI
LI
Current zoning Use-Specific
CDC Business
TOD Corridor
CDC Medial
TOD Village
districts and Standards
CDC Fringe
TOD Node
R1, R-Sa
subdistricts
R-2, R1x
B2, B5
MRD
R-2x
New
M-3
M-1
M-2
R-3
B-1
AG
Related Service
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* B4 Section
Facility 60.300.030G.15
Residence for
Section
Caretaker or A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.16
Security Guard
Residential
Section
Management or A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A*
60.300.030G.17
Sales Office
Storage Container Section
A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* A* - - A* A* A*
60.300.030G.18
Swimming Pool or Section
A A* A* A* A* A* A A A A A A A A A A A A A A
Tennis Court 60.300.030G.19
Urban Agriculture Section
A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A
60.300.030G.20
Temporary Uses
Carnival or Festival Section
T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T*
60.300.030H.1
Contractor's Office Section
T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T*
and Yard 60.300.030H.2
Food Truck Section
T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T*
60.300.030H.3
Garage Sale Section
T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T*
60.300.030H.4
Seasonal Sales Section
T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T* T*
60.300.030H.5
USE-SPECIFIC STANDARDS
Applicability
The Use-Specific Standards listed in this Section 60.300.030 apply to those uses listed on the
same line of the Allowed Uses Table, regardless of whether the uses are shown as Staff,
Planning Commission, or City Council approvals, and regardless of whether they are Primary,
Vacant, Accessory, or Temporary uses.
Residential Uses
Congregate Housing and Dormitory
Developments shall meet the standards applicable to permitted Multifamily Dwelling, based
on the computation that three rooming or sleeping units equal one dwelling unit.
Dwelling, Cottage
a. Maximum project size is two acres.
b. No cottage development may be located within one-quarter mile of another cottage
development, measured at the closest points on the property boundaries.
c. The maximum density shall be no more than 16,000 square feet of gross floor area in
cottage units per acre of project site area.
d. A shared private common space containing at least 10 percent of the project area shall
be provided.
e. Individual cottage lots or portions of the project may not be subdivided for sale.
f. Zone district lot and setback requirements shall apply to the project site as a whole, but
not to individual co-housing dwelling sites.
g. Each project site shall maintain a vegetated buffer, meeting the standards in Section
60.400.060D, Bufferyards applicable to multifamily dwellings, along each side and rear
lot line, and no portion of any primary or accessory structure may be located in that
buffer area.
h. The applicant shall submit a Site Development Plan identifying individual cottage
development sites, streets, parking areas, stormwater management facilities, common
areas and facilities, and any other features required to be identified by this UDC.
Dwelling, Multifamily
a. Where a multifamily structure shares a lot line with any Household Living use other than
another multifamily structure, the multifamily structure is subject to Neighborhood
Protection Standards, as described Section 60.400.020F.
b. See Section 60.400.070E.8, Usable Recreation Area, for requirements on recreational
areas in Multifamily Dwellings.
Manufactured Home Park
a. Compliance with Other City Regulations
Compliance with the Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 5-18 is required.
b. General Requirements
1) Owner/applicants must comply with the licensing requirements for manufactured
home parks under Chapter 4630 of the Rules of the Department of Health in the
Minnesota Statutes.
2) Each manufactured home sited on a lot in a manufactured home park shall
conform to all Minnesota Statutes including but not limited to Chapter 327 and
shall bear an installation seal as defined in Minn. Stat. Ch. 327.31, Subd. 12.
c. Dimensional Standards
The following table states the applicable dimensional standards for manufactured home
parks in all districts.
Lot Dimensions (Minimum)
Lot Area 2,000 sq. ft. / manufactured home space
Lot Width 250 ft. / manufactured home space
Usable Open Space 200 sq. ft. / manufactured home space
Building Setbacks (Minimum in feet)
A Front 15
B Interior Side 5
Street Side 10
C Rear 10
Building/Structure Height (Maximum in feet)
D Primary Structure 26
d. Development Standards
1) Manufactured homes that are not installed on a permanent foundation shall be
skirted with materials similar in color, texture, and appearance to the siding of the
manufactured home.
2) Anchorages and tie-downs constructed to comply with Articles 14-1 and 14-3 of
ROA 1994 (Uniform Administrative Code and Uniform Housing Code) shall be
provided on each manufactured home space or lot to prevent overturning or uplift
of the manufactured home.
3) Carports, patios, decks, and accessory buildings may be located in side and rear
setback areas of individual manufactured home sites. Such accessory buildings
may not be located in any setbacks, usable open space, or landscape buffers
required for the manufactured home community.
4) Storage sheds, accessory buildings, and carports shall be constructed of weather-
resistant materials.
5) All yard areas and other open spaces not otherwise paved or occupied by
structures shall be landscaped and maintained.
6) In cases where the owner of a manufactured home community intends to change
the use resulting in expiration or termination of resident occupancy, the owner shall
mail each resident written notice of his intent at least 18 months prior to the
change of use.
Nursing Home
In the R-1, R-2, R-2x, R-3, and R-4 Districts, Nursing Home uses shall not have vehicle access
points from or channel a majority of the traffic generated by the use onto a Local residential
street.
Offender Transitional Housing
a. Offender Transitional Housing in Residential Districts
Offender Transitional Housing may be established in an Agricultural and Residential
District if separated from other Offender Transitional Housing as shown in the table:
District Separation Required
R-1 1,000 feet or greater
R-2 and R-2x 600 feet or greater
R-3 400 feet or greater
R-4 No minimum separation
c. Soil Quality
Food products grown in soil native to the site may be sold if the applicant can provide
documentation to the Community Development Director that the following standards are
satisfied:
1) A composite sample of the native soil, consisting of no less than five individual
samples, has been tested for lead content and the lead content in the soil is
determined to be at or below the residential screening levels for soil exposure,
direct-contact for lead established by the Minnesota Pollution Control Agency; and
either:
(a) Proof through maps, deeds, prior permits, or a combination of those sources
that the site has only been used for residential or agricultural activities in the
past; or
(b) A composite sample of the native soil, consisting of no less than five
individual samples, has been tested for metal content using the US EPA
3050B, 3051, or a comparable method and that the metals arsenic,
cadmium, mercury, molybdenum, nickel, selenium, and zinc are determined
to be at or below the residential screening levels for soil exposure, direct-
contact established by the Minnesota Pollution Control Agency.
2) If metal content in soil exceeds established thresholds, food products may only be
grown in raised beds filled with clean topsoil.
3) As an alternative to meeting the above standards, food products may be grown in
clean soil brought to the site without completing a soil test of the soil native to the
site.
Day Care Facility
a. Licensing and Approval
1) Day Care Facilities shall be licensed under the State of Minnesota Public Welfare
Licensing Act and proof of such licensing shall be required prior to Zoning
Certificate approval.
2) In all Agricultural and Residential District, a day care facility serving 14 or fewer
dependents is permitted with Staff approval subject to meeting the requirements
for Single-Family Detached Dwellings. Where single-family dwellings are not
permitted, the applicable requirements shall be those of the R-2 district.
3) A Day Care Facility serving between 15 and 20 dependents is permitted with Staff
approval in the R-3 and R-4 districts, subject to the same requirements as
Multifamily Dwellings. In the R-1 and R-2 Districts, such development must be
approved by the Planning Commission.
4) Day care facilities serving more than 20 dependents require Planning Commission
approval as described in Section 60.500.050A, Conditional Use Permit, in
Agricultural and Residential districts.
b. Locational Requirements
The portions of the lot or parcel on which the day care center is situated must be located
300 feet or more from any Heavy Industry use. The day care center may be an internal
part of, attached to, or freestanding from the structure housing the primary use on the lot
or parcel.
Emergency Service
The site must provide direct access to a collector, arterial, or expressway.
Funeral Home
a. Location Requirements in the R-3 District
The use must be located at the intersection of a collector street and a higher order
street.
b. Location Requirements in the R-4 District
The site must provide direct access to a collector, arterial, or expressway.
c. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Funeral Homes may only operate during the times specified in the table below. If a
district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
R-3 7AM -- 11PM
Medical Facility
a. Access Requirements in the R-1, R-2, R-2x, R-3, and R-4 Districts
Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic
generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
b. Location Requirements in the MX-N District
The site must provide direct access to a collector, arterial, or expressway.
Place of Worship
Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic generated
by the use onto a Local residential street.
School
Schools that provide educational services to Kindergarten through 5th Grade can be located
on any street. All other Schools shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a
majority of the traffic generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
Social Services
a. In Agricultural and Residential districts, the use must be located at the intersection of a
collector street and a higher order street.
b. For social services providing overnight shelter, the facility shall be located along a
regularly serviced transit route, at the discretion of the Community Development Director.
Commercial Uses
Adult Entertainment
a. Compliance with the Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 5-11 is required.
b. The use must be located at the intersection of a collector street and a higher order
street.
c. All adult entertainment uses shall be located not less than 750 feet from any Agricultural
and Residential District boundary, place of worship, school, or youth facility.
d. No adult entertainment establishment shall locate within 750 feet of another adult
entertainment use.
e. For the purposes of this use the distance shall be a horizontal measurement from the
nearest district boundary or lot line of a place of worship, school, youth facility, or another
adult entertainment use to the nearest point on the lot line of the lot where the adult
entertainment use is proposed.
Agriculture Production
In all districts except the AG district:
a. Agriculture production in existence upon the [effective date of original provisions] shall
be considered a permitted use and allowed to continue in operation including the raising
of poultry and livestock and also existing animal feedlots, provided that the feedlot is
otherwise in compliance with any Minnesota Pollution Control Agency requirements. A
new animal feedlot may not be created after [effective date of original provisions].
b. The animal density shall not be greater than one animal unit per one acre of pasture; and
any structure used for the housing of livestock or poultry shall be located a minimum of
50 feet from any property line.
c. Changes to the operation that have the effect of expanding or intensifying the operation
shall require City Council approval if, in the opinion of the Community Development
Director, the farm is within 400 feet of any residential use and the changes are
detrimental to living conditions by reason of creating safety hazards or the emittance of
noise, odor, or other nuisance; the operations constitute an industrial type use involving
the compounding, processing and packaging of products for wholesale or retail use
involving more than five outside employees.
Air Transportation
a. General Requirements in All Districts
1) All required state and federal approvals including but not limited to the Federal
Aviation Administration for design and operation of the facility shall be obtained
and maintained in effect at all times when the facility is in operation.
e. No Bed and Breakfast facility shall be permitted on a lot that is less than 10,000 square
feet in size.
f. One off-street parking space plus one parking space for each guest room shall be
provided, in the R-2x district only one-half of a parking space shall be provided for each
guest room and shall meet the provisions of Section 60.400.080E Minimum and
Maximum Vehicle Parking Required.
g. The dwelling proposed for a Bed and Breakfast must consist of at least 1,500 square
feet of habitable floor area.
h. Guest stays are limited to no more than 14 consecutive days.
i. A distance separation of at least 500 feet must be maintained between bed and
breakfast uses in the R-2 district. No distance separation is required in the R-2x, R-3, and
R-4 districts.
Business or Personal Service
a. Access Requirements in the R-2x, R-3, R-4, and MX-N Districts
Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic
generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
b. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Business and Personal Service uses may only operate during the times specified in the
table below. If a district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
R-2x 7AM -- 9PM
R-3 7AM -- 9PM
R-4 7AM -- 10PM
MX-N 6AM -- 10PM
MX-S 6AM -- 10PM
Campground or RV Park
a. The density of proposed developments shall not exceed 20 sites per acre.
b. Spaces for trailers shall be at least 25 feet wide, and a 30 foot separation between any
designated site and a residential zoning district boundary shall be maintained.
c. Recreational space equal to 10 percent of the site area shall be provided, with no single
area smaller than 400 square feet in size.
Fast Food Restaurant
a. Location Requirements in the R-4 and MX-N Districts
The use must be located at the intersection of a collector street and a higher order
street.
c. The design and construction of the Indoor Gun Range shall completely confine all
ammunition rounds within the building and in a controlled manner.
d. The design and construction of the Indoor Gun Range shall be performed by a
professional engineer registered in the state of Minnesota.
e. No ammunition shall be used in the Indoor Gun Range that exceeds the certified design
and construction specifications of the Gun Range.
f. Each Indoor Gun Range shall have a clear and concise safety plan.
g. The applicant shall provide and maintain proof of liability insurance that shall require the
insurer to notify the Community Development Director in writing of a cancellation of the
policy, a change in the limit of the policy, and/or a change in policy ownership. The policy
shall be executed and provided to the Community Development Director prior to the
issuance of the certificate of occupancy and shall be available for inspection by the
Community Development Director.
h. Signs shall be posted in the entry of the structure and within the Gun Range space
specifying that minors shall be accompanied by an adult at all times. This includes
firearm safety classes that must be supervised by an adult instructor.
i. Applicant shall operate and manage the Indoor Gun Range in conformance with all
federal, state, and local laws and regulations related to the use, sale, rental, and
transportation of firearms.
j. The most current edition of the National Rifle Association's Range Source Book: A Guide
to Planning and Construction shall serve as best practices for shooting range
performance standards.
k. Required Certificate of Occupancy Documentation
Prior to occupying the building, requesting a temporary certificate of occupancy, or a final
certificate of occupancy the applicant shall provide a certified inspection from the
engineer that demonstrates compliance all provisions in this section including but not
limited to those related to building construction, containment design and construction,
caliber of firearms for which indoor gun range is certified, noise requirements, and
executed proof insurance.
l. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Indoor Gun Range uses may only operate during the times specified in the table below. If
a district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
MX-G 7AM -- 10PM
LI 7AM -- 10PM
SI 7AM -- 10PM
SI 6AM -- 11PM
Parking Garage
a. Compliance with Development Standards
In addition to the parking standards in Section 60.400.070F.5, Iconic Building
Alternatives, parking lots shall comply with the following requirements as applicable.
b. General Requirements
1) Façade openings that face any public right-of-way or publicly accessible open space
shall be vertically and horizontally aligned and all floors fronting on such façades
shall be level.
2) Parking structures shall be designed to conceal the view of all parked cars below
hood level, and to conceal internal light sources, from adjacent public rights-of-way
and publicly accessibly open space.
3) The ground floor of each parking structure façade facing a public or private street
shall be designed with a minimum floor to ceiling height of 13 feet, and with no
driving aisle located within 20 feet of the street facing façade (except for required
vehicle entryways) to allow those ground floor frontages to be used or converted to
non-parking uses permitted in the zone district in the future.
c. Additional Standards for the MX-T District
No primary use parking garage unrelated to a park and ride location shall be located
within the MX-T district, except in the MX-T Village subdistrict. In park and ride locations
designated by the City:
1) The street-facing façade of the parking garage shall have a minimum floor-to-ceiling
height of 13 feet for a depth of at least 30 feet from the street to allow for
conversion to a non-parking use in the future.
2) The façade of a parking structure facing a street shall comply with the design
standards in Section 60.400.070F.5, Iconic Building Alternatives.
Parking Lot
a. Compliance with Development Standards
In addition to the parking standards in Section 60.400.070F.5, Iconic Building
Alternatives, parking lots shall comply with the following requirements as applicable.
b. General Requirements for Primary Use Parking Lots
1) In the MX-S district, the only type of parking lot permitted is a public parking lot.
2) In the MX-N district, the only type of parking lot permitted is a public parking lot that
is approved by Planning Commission. The street frontage of a parking lot in the MX-
N district shall not exceed 60 feet and shall be screened from public view by a solid
wall three feet in height constructed of durable maintenance free material or a
dense evergreen hedge three feet in height.
Retail, Neighborhood
a. Access Requirements in the MX-N District
Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic
generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
b. Outdoor Displays
Outdoor displays related to the retail use are permitted for a period of not more than 14
consecutive days on portions of the lot that are not needed to meet minimum parking
standards, do not occupy required landscaped areas, do not occupy required front
setbacks, and do not obstruct sidewalks or walkways.
c. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Neighborhood Retail uses may only operate during the times specified in the table below.
If a district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
MX-N 6AM – 10PM
MX-S 6AM – 10PM
Retail, Small
a. Access and Location Requirements
1) Requirements in the R-2x and R-3 District
(a) Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the
traffic generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
(b) The site must provide direct access to a collector, arterial, or expressway.
2) Requirements in the R-4 District
The use must be located at the intersection of a collector street and a higher order
street.
b. Outdoor Displays
Outdoor displays related to the retail use are permitted for a period of not more than 14
consecutive days on portions of the lot that are not needed to meet minimum parking
standards, do not occupy required landscaped areas, do not occupy required front
setbacks, and do not obstruct sidewalks or walkways.
c. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Small Retail uses may only operate during the times specified in the table below. If a
district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
R-2x 6AM – 7PM
R-3 6AM – 7PM
R-4 6AM -- 10PM
MX-N 6AM -- 11PM
Retail, Medium
a. Outdoor Displays
Outdoor displays related to the retail use are permitted for a period of not more than 14
consecutive days on portions of the lot that are not needed to meet minimum parking
standards, do not occupy required landscaped areas, do not occupy required front
setbacks, and do not obstruct sidewalks or walkways.
b. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Retail Trade uses may only operate during the times specified in the table below. If a
district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
MX-S 6AM -- 10PM
MX-C 6AM -- 10PM
Retail, Large
a. Outdoor Displays
Outdoor displays related to the retail use are permitted for a period of not more than 14
consecutive days on portions of the lot that are not needed to meet minimum parking
standards, do not occupy required landscaped areas, do not occupy required front
setbacks, and do not obstruct sidewalks or walkways.
b. Building Entrances
Large retail buildings shall have clearly defined, highly visible customer entrances
featuring no less than three of the following elements:
1) Canopies or porticos;
2) Overhangs;
3) Recesses/projections;
4) Arcades;
5) Raised corniced parapets over the door;
6) Peaked roof forms;
7) Arches;
8) Outdoor patios;
9) Display windows;
10) Architectural detail such as tile work and moldings integrated into the building
structure and design; or
11) Integral planters that incorporate landscaped areas and places for sitting.
c. Building Articulation
1) Large retail buildings shall incorporate two or more of the following design
elements on each façade visible from a street:
(a) Changes in wall plane, such as projections or recesses, having a wall offset of
at least one foot depth, and located a minimum of every 40 feet. Each
required offset shall have a minimum width of 10 feet;
(b) Distinct changes in texture and color of wall surfaces;
Quarry
a. Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic
generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
b. Uses shall not take access to any local or collector street where access to the site from
the primary street system (arterials, expressways, and freeways) by way of the collector
or local results in traffic passing through a residential area.
c. Storage of materials, vehicles, and other equipment associated with the operation of a
business shall only be permitted in the side or rear yards, outside of any required
bufferyard area, and controlled by bumper stops or other means so as not to cross over
the lot line.
Repair and Maintenance Shop
a. All operations and storage must be conducted within an enclosed structure.
b. Repair and Maintenance Shops uses may only operate during the times specified in the
table below. If a district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
MX-N 6AM – 10PM
MX-S 6AM – 10PM
Wholesale Facility
a. Loading Requirements
Sufficient off-street loading space to handle anticipated vehicles shall be provided, along
with the sufficient room on-site to allow maneuvering of vehicles so as to preclude the
need to use the public right-of-way for backing movements.
b. Access Requirements in the MX-S, MX-C, MX-G, LI, SI, and BP Districts
Uses shall not have vehicle access points from or channel a majority of the traffic
generated by the use onto a Local residential street.
c. Hours of Operation Restrictions
Wholesale Facility uses may only operate during the times specified in the table below. If
a district is not listed, then no hours of operation restrictions apply.
District Permissible Hours of Operation
MX-G 6AM – 10PM
(a) Only one installation per pole on a first come, first served basis is permitted.
(i) The wireless equipment is not permitted to protrude more than five feet
above the streetlight luminaire itself.
(ii) The mounting height of the luminaire on the streetlight pole shall be no
more than 35 feet.
(iii) The mast arm length of a replacement pole shall match the existing
streetlight pole being replaced.
(iv) The color and surface treatment of the replacement pole shall match the
surrounding area poles. Color criteria for poles shall be as follows:
In the MX-T and MX-D districts, 30 feet height – black finish
All districts except the MX-T and MX-D, 30 feet height – galvanized or gray
finish
All districts except MX-T and MX-D, 20 feet height – stainless steel finish (no
paint)
Shoppes on Maine Area, 14 feet and 25 feet height – dark green
(v) No Company signs are permitted to be placed on a streetlight pole,
including a replacement pole, except to the extent required by local,
state, or federal law or regulations.
(vi) All pole attached wireless equipment must be a minimum 10 feet from
the sidewalk elevation.
(vii) All ground based wireless equipment, including, but not limited to,
equipment cabinets or power pedestals, shall be placed at the back of
the right-of-way whenever possible.
(viii) All pole-mounted equipment shall match the color of the replacement
pole.
(ix) For each individual pole type or style used to support the wireless
equipment, one spare replacement pole shall be provided by Licensee to
the City at the end of the project so that the pole can be replaced
promptly in case of a knockdown.
(x) All plans shall be signed and sealed by a Professional Civil and Electrical
Engineer.
(xi) All other details in the City Street Light Design Standards shall apply.
(xii) The replacement pole and the wireless equipment attached to the pole
shall not increase the diameter of the existing pole that is replaced by
more than 60 percent, not to exceed eight inches total, or increase the
height of the existing pole by more than 10 percent, not to exceed four
feet.
3) The facility owner shall notify the City when removal of the facility occurs.
g. Interference
Every CWTS shall meet the regulations of the Federal Communications Commission, or
any successor of that agency, regarding physical and electromagnetic interference.
h. Health Issues
Every CWTS shall meet health and safety standards for electromagnetic field emissions
as established by the Federal Communications Commission or any successor of that
agency, and any other state or federal agency.
i. Co-location
1) Co-locations are encouraged.
2) Co-location on a concealed CWTS shall maintain the concealed nature of the
facility. Otherwise, such co-locations are not subject to the concealment
requirements in Section 60.300.030F.1.a.
3) The installation or attachment of an antenna or other wireless communications
equipment using small cell technology to stand-alone streetlight poles shall be
subject to the criteria set forth below.
j. Pole Requirements
1) In all cases, the existing pole shall be replaced with a new combination streetlight
pole that can accommodate the equipment proposed to be attached and the
streetlight luminaire (the “replacement pole”).
2) Only one installation per pole on a first come, first served basis is permitted.
3) The wireless equipment is not permitted to protrude more than five feet above the
streetlight luminaire itself.
4) The mounting height of the luminaire on the streetlight pole shall be no more than
35 feet.
5) The mast arm length of a replacement pole shall match the existing streetlight pole
being replaced.
6) The color and surface treatment of the replacement pole shall match the
surrounding area poles. Color criteria for poles shall be as follows:
(a) In the MX-T and MX-D districts, 30 feet height – black finish.
(b) All districts except the MX-T and MX-D, 30 feet height – galvanized or gray
finish.
(c) All districts except MX-T and MX-D, 20 feet height – stainless steel finish (no
paint).
(d) Shoppes on Maine Area, 14 feet and 25 feet height – dark green.
(b) Equipment and screening materials shall not block pedestrian pathways and
sidewalks.
Solar Collector, Ground- or Building-Mounted
a. General Standards for All Solar Collectors
1) All exterior electrical lines shall be buried below the surface of the ground when
possible.
2) All systems shall comply with all City and state building and electrical codes.
3) The property owner shall notify the electrical utility where the solar system is
connected to the electrical utility system.
4) If the solar collector system ceases to perform its originally intended function for
more than 12 consecutive months, the property owner shall remove the collector,
mount and associated equipment and facilities by no later than 90 days after the
end of the 12-month period.
b. Accessory Ground-Mounted Solar Collectors
Accessory ground-mounted solar collectors shall:
1) Be located in a side or rear yard only;
2) Be set back at least six feet from the side and rear property line;
3) Not be located within an easement;
4) Be located so as to minimize glare visible from abutting properties;
5) Not exceed 15 feet in height with panels oriented in a vertical position; and
6) Be included in determining the maximum coverage of structures on the lot.
c. Accessory Building-Mounted Solar Collectors
Accessory building-mounted solar shall:
1) Not extend more than 18 inches above the maximum height permitted in the
zoning district in which it is located;
2) If mounted to a portion of the roof ending at, or extending over, the front façade of
the building, shall be mounted so that the edge of the device is set back at least
one foot from the edge of the roof closest to the front lot line; and
3) If mounted to the wall of a building, may extend into or over no more than 33
percent of the depth of a minimum yard or setback that is required along a side lot
line but shall not extend closer than four feet to a side lot line.
d. Principal Ground-Mounted Solar Collectors
Principal ground-mounted solar collectors shall:
1) Be set back at least 25 feet from any property line abutting a residential zoning
district, and at least 15 feet from any property line if adjacent to Mixed Use or Non-
Residential zoning district.
2) Not exceed 25 feet in height when oriented at maximum tilt;
3) Be located so as to minimize glare visible from an abutting property; and
4) Be considered in determining the maximum coverage of structures on the lot.
Utility, Major
Utility uses required in connection with a Major Utility use do not require additional
approvals.
Wind Energy Conversion System (WECS), Ground or Building Mounted
a. Height Limitation
1) Ground-Mounted WECS shall not exceed the height permitted in the applicable
zoning district.
2) Building-Mounted WECS may not exceed the height permitted in the applicable
zoning district by more than five feet.
b. Setbacks
1) A ground-mounted WECS located on a single lot shall be set back from each
property line at least 1.1 times the total height of the WECS.
2) A ground-mounted WECS located on a project site that contains two or more
abutting properties shall be set back from each project site boundary shown in the
application at least 1.1 times the total height of the WECS.
3) Each ground-mounted Small Utility WECS shall be set back from each on-site
dwelling unit at least 1.1 times the total height of the WECS.
4) A WECS that is placed on a primary or accessory structure and does not exceed the
maximum height in the applicable zoning district shall meet the minimum setback
for the primary or accessory structure in the zoning district where it is located.
5) If a WECS attached to a primary or accessory structure receives approval for
additional height through the Section 60.500.070C Variance process, the WECS
shall be set back from each property line at least 1.1 times the total final height of
the WECS.
6) The blades of a WECS placed on a primary building shall not extend beyond the
property line in any operational position.
7) Substations, facility buildings, and other accessory structures that are part of the
WECS shall comply with the required primary building setbacks for the zoning
district in which the project is located.
c. Separation Distance
1) Each ground-mounted WECS with blades that spin on a horizontal axis and with a
height of more than 100 feet shall not be located within 600 feet of any state
wildlife management areas, other Minnesota Department of Natural Resources
lands, Types 3-5 wetlands, and flood control reservoirs.
2) No components of a WECS shall be located within or encroach within 10 feet from
any power line.
d. Number of Systems in Agricultural and Residential Districts
No more than one ground-mounted WECS is permissible per development site in the R-1,
R-2, and R-2x districts.
Accessory Uses and Structures
All accessory uses shown in the Allowed Uses Table shall comply with the following standards
unless an exception is provided elsewhere in this UDC.
General
a. No accessory use or structure shall be established or constructed unless a Zoning
Certificate has been issued that establishes compliance with all applicable provisions of
this UDC.
b. Inadequate Dwelling Facilities: No garage, tent, trailer, recreational vehicle, accessory
building, basement or cellar shall at any time be used as a dwelling, except as provided
for within the ordinance under the accessory use provisions of this ordinance.
Limitation on Establishment
No accessory use or structure shall be constructed or established on any lot prior to the time
of the substantial completion of construction of the primary use or structure to which it is
accessory.
Accessory Structures in Agricultural and Residential Districts
The following general regulations apply to detached garages, accessory buildings, and
accessory structures in all Agricultural and Residential districts.
a. Location
1) Detached garages, accessory buildings, and structures accessory to a residential
use may be located in a buildable lot area or in a side or rear yard area, but not
closer than 18 inches of any side or rear lot line, and not in any area where the
building or structure is prohibited by Subsection b below.
2) Exceptions
The following are excepted from Subsection a above:
(a) No accessory structure may be located within five feet of an alley; and
(b) No accessory building constructed after [original effective date of this
provision] that provides street-accessed parking for vehicles or recreational
vehicles shall be located closer to any side lot line than one-half of the side
setback required for the primary structure on the lot.
b. Lot Development Standards
1) Location Requirements
Unless otherwise permitted, garages or accessory structures that are attached to
and an integral part of the primary structure or building shall be located in the
buildable area.
2) Setback Requirements
Garages or accessory structures that are attached to and an integral part of the
primary structure or building may encroach 20 percent into the minimum rear yard
depth.
3) Coverage Requirements
When located in the rear yard, accessory structures shall occupy no more than 35
percent of the rear yard area.
4) Floor Area and Separation Requirements
(a) The sum of the individual gross floor area of each primary and accessory
building on a lot shall not exceed the maximum floor area ratio, if any, for the
applicable zoning district, unless otherwise provided by an exception in this
UDC.
(b) A roof may not extend beyond the wall more than six inches where located
within 18 inches of a side or rear lot line.
(c) Separation of accessory structures from primary structures shall be as
required by the Building Code.
Accessory Structures in Non-Residential Districts
a. Accessory buildings and structures associated with a non-residential use shall meet all
setback requirements for the primary building on the lot and shall not interfere with
provision of required landscaping on the lot.
b. No accessory building in a Non-Residential district shall exceed the height of the primary
building unless provided for in this Section.
c. The combined lot coverage of accessory buildings or structures and the primary building
or structure located on the same lot or site shall not exceed the permitted lot coverage
for the district. Structures under 200 square feet in floor area are exempt from this
requirement.
Accessory Dwelling Unit
a. General
1) There shall be no more than one accessory dwelling unit on a lot.
2) If the accessory dwelling unit is located in a district that only allows a single
principal dwelling unit on the lot, either the principal dwelling unit or the accessory
dwelling unit must be the primary permanent residence of the owner of the lot.
3) An accessory dwelling unit must not contain more than 1,000 square feet of gross
floor area.
4) No portion of a lot on which an accessory dwelling unit is located may be
subdivided from or legally described differently than the lot containing the primary
residential unit, and no portion of a structure containing an accessory dwelling unit
may have ownership different from the ownership of the primary dwelling unit.
5) Recreational vehicles and storage containers may not be used as accessory
dwelling units.
b. Additional Standards for Attached Accessory Dwelling Units
1) An attached dwelling unit created after <the effective date of this amendment>
shall maintain the architectural design, style, appearance, and character of the
principal dwelling by incorporating design elements of the principal residence such
as similar façade materials, façade colors, window style/treatment, and roof design
and pitch, and shall not have a primary entrance to the accessory dwelling unit
located on the front façade of the primary structure.
2) An attached accessory dwelling unit must meet the same setbacks as the primary
structure on the lot.
c. Additional Standards for Detached Accessory Dwelling Units
1) Detached accessory dwelling units shall only be located in the rear yard.
2) The detached accessory structure shall be located no closer than 6 feet to the
primary structure, or the minimum separation distance as required by Building
Code.
3) The detached accessory dwelling unit must meet the same side setbacks as the
primary structure, and may be no closer than 10 feet to an alley or the rear lot line.
4) The architectural style of the accessory dwelling unit, including but not limited to
massing, roof shape, and exterior appearance shall be compatible with that of the
primary dwelling on the lot.
5) The accessory dwelling unit shall be connected to the closest adjacent right-of-way
by a paved pedestrian pathway of at least three feet in width.
Animal Husbandry
Horses, llamas, and animals that typically weigh more than 100 pounds when mature or that
are typically raised for sale or profit are only permitted in the AG district.
Drive-In Facility
a. That portion of the site area used for vehicle circulation and parking shall be hard-
surfaced to control dust and shall be setback at least 30 feet from any other property
line.
b. Waste receptacles shall be provided at all exits where readily disposable goods or
materials are offered for sale and pick-up through the drive-through.
c. Devices such as speakers shall be designed so that the noise level at the property line
does not exceed the maximum decibel level permitted in the zoning district applicable to
the adjacent property or the existing ambient noise level as measured at the property
line, whichever is greater.
d. The development shall be designed so that no ground level light sources are visible from
any public right-of-way or adjacent residential properties.
e. Incidental commercial facilities, such as refreshment stands, are permitted subject to the
condition they are operated primarily for the patrons of the facility and no outdoor
advertising of business or products is maintained.
f. MX-T and MX-S District Requirements
Drive-in facilities in the MX-T and MX-S Districts shall not:
1) Be located or designed so that vehicles using the drive-in facility pass between any
public or private street and any portion of any façade of the primary building facing
that street; and
2) Be accessed directly from, or be located on a lot(s) with a curb cut onto, N. or S.
Broadway, SW. 2nd St., or SE 4th St./Collegeview Rd.
Fuel Tank
a. An accessory fuel tank may be permitted in any zoning district for the purpose of heating
on site structures.
b. Such fuel tanks shall be located in the buildable area of the lot or the required rear yard,
subject also to the fire protection regulations, and shall be screened from adjacent
properties with low hedges, evergreens, or other plant materials in association with a
fence.
Garage
a. General
1) Unless stated otherwise in this UDC, detached garages for residential uses shall be
excluded from the floor area ratio.
2) Detached garages for residential uses shall be included in the calculations to
determine lot coverage by buildings, structures, and paved surfaces.
3) The location and size of detached garages for residential uses shall not interfere
with installation of all required landscaping on the lot.
b. Attached Garages
Garages attached to a dwelling unit may encroach into the front yard if the required
minimum side yard setback and a minimum front yard setback of 15 feet for all single-
family detached dwellings is maintained. For other dwelling types, the front yard setback
shall be 15 feet if the doors providing vehicle access face the street; and 12 feet for
other walls of the garage.
Greenhouse
In Agricultural and Residential districts, greenhouses are limited to a maximum height of 15
feet, shall be located at least 10 feet from any lot line, and may not cover more than 25
percent of the property.
Home Occupation
All Home Occupations require Staff approval and may only be approved if the following
standards are met.
a. The Home Occupation may not involve the use of an accessory building or structure on
the lot, except for uses using recreational facilities such as swimming pools or tennis
courts.
b. The Home Occupation shall not occupy more than 25 percent of the livable area of the
dwelling unit or 1,000 square feet, whichever is less.
c. The Home Occupation shall not involve internal or external alterations or construction
features not normally found in dwellings and shall not include a separate entrance.
d. Other than a member of the family residing in the dwelling unit, only one outside
employee may be engaged in the Home Occupation.
e. No Home Occupation may involve the boarding of animals or keeping of fowl or farm
animals, except as otherwise provided by any provision of the Rochester Code of
Ordinances.
f. No Home Occupation may use a mechanical equipment or process that creates noise,
vibration, glare, fumes, odors, or electrical interference detectable off the premises,
including those that create visual or audible interference on any radio or television
receiver located off the premises.
g. No exterior storage of equipment or materials in connection with the Home Occupation
and no display of products, goods, or services that is visible from outside the dwelling
unit are permitted.
h. Only articles made or originating on the premises shall be sold, unless the articles are
incidental to a permitted commercial service.
i. Traffic that may be generated shall not be of such magnitude as to have a significant
detrimental effect on the capacity of streets in the area.
j. Only one vehicle used in connection with the Home Occupation shall be stored or
stopped on the premises, and such vehicle shall not be a dump truck, wrecker, or fuel oil
delivery truck, or other truck with a gross vehicle weight of over 10,000 pounds.
k. Any permit approving a Home Occupation is valid for only the person, the business, and
the location named in the application, and may not be transferred to another person,
business, or location.
l. In the R-1 and R-2 districts, one small, unlighted professional sign, not exceeding two
square feet of display area, and attached to the front of the dwelling, is permitted.
m. In the R-3 and R-4 districts, one sign not exceeding four square feet shall be permitted,
except on a lot that has public road frontage along a collector or higher level street or on
a lot that directly abuts a Non-Residential zoning district, one sign not exceeding 12
square feet is permitted.
n. Each individual home occupation sign within a Multifamily Dwelling shall be no greater
than two square feet in size, and there shall be no more than a cumulative total of 12
square feet of signage permitted for the Multifamily Dwelling.
Outdoor Eating Area
Outdoor eating areas located on a public right-of-way shall comply with the following
standards:
a. No sale or service shall be permitted in any portion of a street designated for vehicular
travel or circulation.
b. Structures and equipment shall not be permanently installed in the public right-of-way.
c. Sidewalks shall be swept and washed daily by the permit holder.
d. Trash disposal and electricity must be provided from within the establishment.
e. A minimum of five feet of sidewalk width must remain unobstructed for passage by
pedestrians.
f. A permit is required for all uses located on public property or rights-of-way pursuant to
the Rochester Code of Ordinances, Chapter 9-8.
Recreational Vehicle Parking
The parking and storage of recreational vehicle and recreational equipment on a lot is
permitted subject to the following restrictions.
a. In the R-1, R-2, and R-2x districts only one RV may be stored on a lot.
b. Parking and storage are permitted at all times within an enclosed building or within the
rear yard.
c. Recreational vehicles under 18 feet in length and seven feet in height, or recreational
equipment under 18 feet in length, may be parked on an established driveway in a
required front or side yard meeting the provisions of Section 60.400.020E, General
Dimensional Standards.
d. Recreational vehicles and equipment over 18 feet in length, or seven feet in height may
be parked on an established driveway, provided they are set back a minimum of 20 feet
from the back of the curb, where present, or the paved area of the street.
e. Recreational vehicles or equipment that require licensing must have a valid current
license in order to be stored outside upon a property within a residential zoning district.
f. Recreational vehicles may not be used as permanent accessory structures within any
residential zoning district or as an accessory dwelling unit.
Recycling Drop Box
a. A recycling drop box may be located anywhere on a lot except in a required traffic
visibility area or a required bufferyard.
b. Each recycling drop box shall be setback from all property lines a distance equal to the
height of structure.
Related Service Facility
a. The gross floor area of all retail and service facilities within a Multifamily Dwelling shall
not be greater than 25 percent of the gross floor area of all the dwelling units in that
structure or 4,000 square feet, whichever is less.
b. The facility shall be operated only for the residents, employees, or guests of the primary
use and their guests. When provided in the R-4 District, such facilities are exempt from
this requirement and may be open to the public on a fee or other basis.
Residence for Caretaker or Security Guard
a. A Residence for Caretaker of Watchmen is permitted for any commercial or industrial use
for the purpose of security.
b. The residence may be either an integral part of the primary building or detached from it.
Residential Management or Sales Office
a. In any multifamily or manufactured housing development, one dwelling unit may be
devoted to use as an office for management of the development or as a headquarters for
sales, leasing, or management of other dwelling units in the development.
b. One freestanding sign not to exceed six square feet in size shall be permitted for
identification purposes.
c. Off-street parking equal to that required for office uses shall be provided.
Storage Container
a. General
1) No storage container shall be located on a lot before a Site Development Plan
review has been completed and a Zoning Certificate has been issued, unless the
storage container is already shown on an approved Site Development Plan.
2) No storage container may be used for temporary or permanent human occupancy.
d. Temporary Placement
1) Storage Containers may not be located at an individual property for longer than:
(a) 14 days if the property is located in a residential zone district or on a property
with a residential primary use in a Mixed Use district;
(b) 90 days if the property is located in a special purpose zone district or on a
property with a Non-Residential primary use in a Mixed Use district; or
(c) The time period between the issuance of the first building permit for
construction of new primary building or a major addition to an existing
primary building and the issuance of the last certificate of occupancy or use
for the new or expanded primary building.
2) Storage containers placed as temporary uses may not block fire lanes, no-parking
zones or restrict emergency vehicles, delivery, or other vehicle circulation.
3) The placement of the container shall not block the visibility for vehicles or
pedestrians entering or exiting the site.
4) No solid or hazardous waste or hazardous material is permitted in or around the
storage containers.
5) No materials may be stacked or stored on top of the storage container.
Swimming Pool and Tennis Court
No swimming pool or tennis court shall be allowed in any Agricultural and Residential District
unless it complies with the following requirements.
a. The pool or court shall not be operated as a business or private club, except when
allowed as a permitted home.
b. The pool or court shall not be located in any required front or required side yard and shall
not be closer than 10 feet to any property line of the property where it is located.
c. Pump and filter installations for pools shall not be closer than 20 feet to any property
line.
d. For an in-ground or surface swimming pool, the pool or the property where the pool is
located shall be enclosed by a fence of a type that effectively controls the entrance by
children to the pool area. For an in-ground pool, a mechanically controlled cover can be
used in lieu of fencing requirements.
e. For an above ground swimming pool, the pool shall be equipped with an automatically
retractable type ladder, a retractable ladder, a removable ladder or shall be fenced in as
stated in this Section. The ladder must be removed or retracted when the pool is not
being attended.
f. Enclosed pools and courts shall be considered as structures for purposes of regulations
limiting lot coverage.
Urban Agriculture
Food Truck
Compliance with the Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 5-21 is required.
Garage Sale
Garage sales are limited to no more than three sales per calendar year at any one property,
and each sale may not exceed three consecutive calendar days.
Seasonal Sales
a. Sale areas shall be set back a minimum of 20 feet from any right-of-way.
b. Seasonal sales are only permitted for a period of 45 days or less.
DIMENSIONAL STANDARDS
Purpose
This Section 60.400.020 is intended to provide dimensional standards and uniform methods of
measurements for interpretation and enforcement of the lot and building standards in this UDC.
Applicability
All development shall comply with this Section 60.400.020, unless another provision of this UDC
modifies these standards. Modifications of these dimensional standards may be found in Section
60.200.040, Overlay Districts, Section 60.400.120, Incentives, Section 60.400.020F,
Neighborhood Protection Standards or in other Sections of this UDC.
Multiple Non-Residential Buildings on a Lot
The following requirements apply when more than one building is proposed on a single lot, and
none of those buildings include a residential primary use.
The floor area shall not exceed the highest maximum floor area ratio applicable in the zoning
district where the development is located.
Where two or more buildings are developed on a single lot, the most restrictive appearance
and bufferyard standards shall be applicable to the entire development unless the
development is designed such that each building has a separately defined area on the lot
where different appearance and bufferyard standards can be reasonably applied.
Adequate access to each building or structure for Emergency Vehicles and apparatus shall
be provided.
The site design of the development shall take into account the potential for future
subdivision of the site so that adequate access by way of easement or lot pattern may be
provided to each building in the future.
Application of Setbacks
General Requirements
a. The principal building or principal use on a lot may not be located in a required setback
or in areas designated for private or common space on an approved Site Development
Plan.
b. On lots where the existing right-of-way width of an adjacent street is not consistent with
the planned right-of-way width as shown on an adopted Official Street Map or on the
Long Range Transportation Plan, the required front setback shall be measured from the
right-of-way line of such street as designated on the Official Street Map or Long Range
Transportation Plan or official map.
c. On lots where all adjacent streets have not yet been platted but are shown in an
approved General Development Plan, the required front setback shall be measured from
the future right-of-way lines shown in the General Development Plan.
d. For earth sheltered and earth bermed buildings, yards shall be measured from the
exterior surface of the building regardless of whether it is above or below grade.
e. The minimum front setback shall be provided on a lot or site between the front lot line
and a front yard line established at a distance equal to the required front yard or
setback.
f. On a corner lot:
1) The owner shall designate one street frontage shall as the front lot line, and all
other street frontages shall be designated as side street lot line(s), except as noted
in Subsection 2) below.
2) If the lot is subject to lot width standards, and one or both street frontages do not
meet those requirements, the street frontage that comes closest to meeting lot
width standards shall be designated as the front lot line.
g. On a flag lot or a lot with no frontage, the Community Development Director shall
designate a front lot line by reference to the following design features:
1) The location of the structure’s primary entrances.
2) The orientation of the primary windows required by the Building Code or the
structure.
h. The minimum rear yard or setback shall be provided on a lot or site between the rear lot
line and a rear yard line established at a distance equal to the required rear yard or
setback.
i. On a triangular-shaped lot, the rear yard line is established by points located on the
intersecting lot lines (or that would intersect if extended to form a true triangle) that are
equidistant from the apex (or imaginary apex if a non-intersecting lot line were extended
to intersect) and that, when connected, create a line equal in width to the minimum width
at the building line.
j. The minimum side yard or setback is provided on a lot or site, between all side lot lines
and a side yard line established at a distance equal to the required side yard or setback
and extending from the front yard line to the rear yard line.
k. On corner lots where potential front and side lot lines create a continuous curve, a radial
line intersecting the midpoint of the curve shall be deemed the boundary between the
yards.
l. In no instance shall a setback greater than that established for the district be required.
Front Lot Lines on Private Roadways
Where a development uses private roadways to provide access to individual buildings within
the development, the front lot line shall be:
a. In the case of an access roadway, a line parallel to the edge of the roadway at a distance
from the edge of the roadway equal to the greater of:
1) Seven feet (to accommodate snow storage);
2) One foot for every five feet of roadway surface width; or
3) For any portion of the façade occupied by a garage or carport accessed from the
private street, at least 20 feet;
b. In the case of a limited access roadway, a line established at the edge of the roadway
surface;
c. In the case of a common driveway, the lot line if one is established or the centerline of
the driveway; or
d. In the case where a building is bounded on two or more sides by an access roadway or
limited access roadway, one side shall be considered a front yard and the remaining side
shall be considered a side street yard.
Front Yards on Cul-de-Sacs
On lots fronting a cul-de-sac or curvilinear street, the front yard setback shall be:
a. A straight line that is located as close as possible to the curved front lot line, but at no
point is closer to the front lot line than a distance that is 80 percent of the required front
yard; or
b. A line that is parallel to the front lot line at the required setback distance.
Through Lots
On through lots, the lot line closest to the primary windows and entrances shall be
considered the front lot line. The opposite frontage shall be treated as a side street lot line.
Existing Small Lots
On any residential lot of record in existence as of January 1, 1992 that does not meet the
minimum lot size or dimensional standards for the zoning district in which it is located, the
depth of the minimum rear and side yard may be reduced by the same ratio that the actual
lot size bears to the minimum required lot size in the district where the lot is located, but the
reduction shall not exceed one-half of the minimum required rear or side yard depth, as
applicable.
Application of Setbacks on Alleys
When a side yard or rear yard on a lot abuts an alley, one-half of the width of the alley may be
counted towards meeting the side or rear yard requirement, but shall not result in a building
or structure being erected closer to the alley than half the distance of the minimum required
yard or, in the case of a rear yard, closer than three feet from the right-of-way line.
General Dimensional Standards
The following tables establish the dimensional standards for Agricultural and Residential, Mixed
Use, and Non-Residential districts. All development shall comply with the standards in Table
400.02-1 Agricultural and Residential Zoning Districts, Table 400.02-2 Mixed Use Zoning
Districts, and Table 400.02-3 Non-Residential Zoning Districts unless otherwise stated in this
UDC or another adopted City regulation. The dimensional standards in Tables in Table 400.02-1
Agricultural and Residential Zoning Districts, Table 400.02-2 Mixed Use Zoning Districts, and
Business
Corridor
Medical
Village
MX-N MX-S MX-C MX-G MX-I
Fringe
Node
Lot Dimensions (Minimum)
Lot Area None None None None None None None
Lot Width None None None None None None None
Building Setbacks (Minimum/Maximum, in feet)
Front 0 / 15 0 / 15 None 15 15 None None
Street Side
7 7 None 7 7 2 None
[2]
Interior Side 5 None None None 10 5 None
Sum of
10 None None None None 10 0 5 None
Interior Sides
Rear 5 None 7 None 8 5 0 5 None
Building/Structure Height (Maximum in feet)
Primary
24 36 48 60 70 60 70 85 None
Structure
Accessory
15 [3] 15 [3] 15 [3] 25 25 30 None
Structure
Other Standards
Maximum
Building None None None None None 300 300 300 None
Length
Maximum
Floor Area 0.5 1.5 0.5 0.7 1 3 4 4 4 1.5 6
Ratio
Minimum
Landscape 25% 15% 20% 15% 20% 5% 5% 5% 5% 8% 0%
Area
NOTES
[1] Section 60.200.030L.3, Additional District Standards contains additional limits on minimum building height, maximum building
setbacks, and requirements for the creation of pedestrian-oriented spaces in the front setback area.
[2] On any lot where a street side setback abuts a side lot line in any district other than and R-1 or R-2 district, the street side
setback within 25 of the abutting side lot line, a setback at least equal to one-half the width to the front yard setback on the abutting
Business
Corridor
Medical
Village
MX-N MX-S MX-C MX-G MX-I
Fringe
Node
lot shall be provided. On any lot where a street side setback abuts a side lot line of a lot in the R-1 or R-2 district, a setback at least
equal in width to the front yard required in the adjacent R-1 or R-2 district shall be provided.
[3] 24 feet for Accessory Dwelling Units.
.
Non-Residential Zoning Districts
b. Subsection (a) shall not apply if the maximum height of a primary structure in the zoning
district where the Regulated Lot is located is no greater than the maximum height of a
primary structure in the zoning district where the Protected Lot is located.
Outdoor Lighting Stepdown
On each portion of a Regulated Lot that is located within 100 feet of a common lot line with a
Protected Lot
a. The maximum height of each light pole and each outdoor lighting fixture shall be 15 feet.
b. The exterior lighting standard shall conform to the lighting standard of the Protected Lot.
Bufferyards
Along any common lot line with a Protected Lot, each Regulated Lot shall install a bufferyard
meeting the standards of a Level 3 bufferyard in Table 400.06-4, Bufferyard Levels, or
buffering of equal or greater effectiveness in mitigating the impacts of noise, lighting, glare,
odor, and vehicle activity, as determined by the Community Development Director.
Parking and Drive-throughs
On a Regulated Lot containing 10,000 square feet of gross lot area or more, no surface
parking area or drive-through lane shall be located within 50 feet of any common lot line with
a Protected Lot.
Exceptions to the Dimensional Standards
SUBDIVISION STANDARDS
Purpose
This Section 60.400.030 establishes standards to guide the design and review of proposed
developments involving the layout of new lots and streets and the installation of new public
facilities, or revisions to existing platted lot lines. The requirements of this Section 60.400.030
identify approvals that will be required to authorize any subdivision activity that is defined as a
subdivision by statute or City ordinance.
Applicability
This Section 60.400.030 shall apply to all subdivisions and land divisions located wholly or
partially within the City unless exempted by another UDC provision.
In case of a conflict between these provisions and applicable provisions of state law, the
provisions of this UDC shall be modified to the smallest degree necessary to comply with
state law.
Subdivision Name
The proposed name of a subdivision shall be approved by Staff and shall not use a word that
is the same as, similar to, or pronounced the same as a word in the name of any other
subdivision in the City except for the words “court,” “addition,” “place,” “heights,” “hills,” and
similar words, unless the land platted is contiguous to and platted by the same applicant that
platted the existing subdivision bearing the name, or the applicant has obtained the written
consent of the party who platted the subdivision bearing that name, or Staff requires the use
of the same name for purposes of clear identification. To bear the same name as an existing
subdivision, the new subdivision must be contiguous.
Subdivision names and numbering shall be meet the requirements in Rochester Code of
Ordinances Chapter 9-1.
Vertical Subdivision
Purpose
The vertical subdivision is intended to allow a lot to be split into new lots that are defined by
complex multi-dimensional volumes.
Applicability
An applicant may request approval of a Vertical Subdivision Final Plat.
Approval Criteria
In the consideration of a Vertical Subdivision, City Council must consider the demand for
adequate public facilities generated by subsequent phases of the development and must
require a development agreement as to the design and construction of adequate on-site or
off-site public or private facility improvements required to serve the subsequent phases.
Complex Vertical Subdivision
a. Prior to the submittal of a Vertical Subdivision, the developer must have first obtained
approval of a Site Development Plan; a Conditional Use Permit; or an Incentive
Development in accordance with the applicable procedures in Chapter 60.500,
Procedures and Administration.
b. All Vertical Subdivision shall be reviewed for compliance with the City Building and Safety
Department and City Fire Department prior to acceptance as a complete submittal.
c. All Vertical Subdivisions filed with the Community Development Director shall be subject
to the Final Plat procedure and subject to all other applicable requirements in this UDC.
d. All applications for a Vertical Subdivision shall be approved by City Council.
Adequate Public Facilities
Purpose
This Section 60.400.030D establishes standards for required infrastructure improvements
associated with any subdivision or resubdivision. To be adequate, facilities must be
appropriate in type, availability, and capacity.
Required Facilities
a. In a proposed subdivision, the required public facilities include, but are not limited to,
parkland, boulevard trees, streets, sidewalks, public sanitary sewer and water
extensions, storm water management facilities, soil erosion and sedimentation control,
and monumentation. Other items that are necessary or material to the project, such as
school sites, may be identified during the development approval process.
b. An applicant may seek to stage or phase development to link the timing of development
with the adequacy of public facilities. However, City Council shall consider the demand
for adequate public facilities generated by subsequent phases of the development and
must require a development agreement as to the design and construction of on-site or
off-site public or private facility improvements to serve those subsequent phases.
c. No development may be approved unless the public facilities in existence or to be
constructed pursuant to an executed development agreement are adequate to handle
the demand on those public facilities generated by the development.
Public Facilities
a. Public facilities and utilities shall be installed according to the standards adopted by the
City or the agency providing the facility or utility. The use of private on-site sewage
treatment systems or private water supply to serve any new development or the use of
new or replacement on-site sewage treatment systems or private water supply to serve
existing development shall not be permitted unless:
1) City Council has determined that public utilities will not be reasonably available and
private utilities will not impair the ability to extend services in the future; and
2) The responsible Olmsted County Staff as identified in the Olmsted County
Environmental Services Administrative Ordinance finds that proposed geologic and
soil conditions and lot sizes are adequate to support the proposed use of private
utilities.
b. There shall be adequate area to relocate any drain field in the case of a system failure for
any lot authorized for on-site sewage treatment.
c. City Engineer approval shall be required for all planned work involving the use of public
facilities or public right-of-way.
d. City Engineer and City Forester approval shall be required for all requests to connect
private facilities to public facilities.
Funding of Required Improvements
Required improvements reasonably related to the development shall be installed at the sole
expense of the applicant. Assessment of costs to subsequent users or public participation
may in certain instances be applicable to a proposed project. The City Engineer or the Parks
and Recreation Director shall recommend to City Council when such policies may be
applicable.
Guarantees for Improvements
a. Bonds or surety deposits shall be required in the amount necessary to cover the cost of
installation, unless waived in the development agreement prior to commencing activity
involving the installation of public improvements.
b. Any unexpended portion of a surety deposit shall be returned to the applicant upon
satisfactory completion of the public improvements.
c. The Community Development Director and Parks and Recreation Director may require
the applicant to ensure the timely installation of required boulevard trees by executing a
Boulevard Tree Green Facilities Agreement.
d. The Community Development Director and Parks and Recreation Director may waive the
requirement for a cash escrow, surety bond, or letter of credit related to the Boulevard
Tree Green Facilities Agreement where a private covenant providing for boulevard tree
planting and meeting the standards of Section 60.400.030I, Boulevard Trees has been
recorded and where provision is made for assessments in accordance with Section
60.400.030D.
Timing of Grading and Clearance
Land clearance prior to development of a parcel is prohibited. The owner of an undeveloped
tract may remove not more than 10 percent of the trees or other vegetation on a site for the
purpose of providing access for site survey and evaluation. This Section precludes
unauthorized land clearance and timber removal and is not intended to interfere with the
normal management of landscaping. Except as provided in this Section, no grading, removal
of trees or other vegetation, land filling, construction of improvements, or other material
change shall commence on the subject property without written approval of the City Engineer
until the applicant has:
a. Received the approval of the Construction Plans and all necessary permits from the
Community Development Director and City Engineer;
b. Entered into a development agreement with the City or otherwise arranged for
completion of all required improvements; or
c. Received approval of a Grading Permit pursuant to Section 60.500.060H.4.f
d. Grading Permit.
Maintenance
a. Maintenance of newly installed public facilities shall remain with the applicant for a
period of two years from final inspection or as otherwise defined in an owner contract or
development agreement, except that, for boulevard trees, the period shall be one year.
b. Following the expiration of the required maintenance period, the City shall assume
responsibility for maintenance and upkeep of public facilities.
Dedications Required
a. Development plans, construction plans, land subdivisions, and Site Development Plans
shall identify needed right-of-way or easement locations necessary for the provision of
utilities, drainage, and vehicular or pedestrian circulation within the development and
connecting to adjacent development that meet specified levels of service called for in
adopted City plans and regulations.
b. Easements and/or deeds shall be granted, and rights-of-way dedicated to the public by
the applicant as part of the development approval process or through separate
instrument, which shall be in a form approved by the City Attorney.
Cost Sharing
The City Engineer shall advise City Council regarding costs and right-of-way widths for major
streets. The applicant shall provide rights-of-way in accordance with the adopted Long Range
Transportation Plan, Official Zoning Map, and other applicable standards.
Modification of Construction Plans
All installations of improvements and all construction shall conform to the approved
construction plans. If the applicant chooses to make minor modifications in design and/or
specifications during construction, such changes shall be made at the applicant's own risk,
but only with the written approval of the City Engineer. It shall be the responsibility of the
applicant to notify the City Engineer in advance of any changes to be made from the
approved drawings. If actual construction work deviates from that shown on the approved
construction plans and such deviation was not approved in advance by the City Engineer, the
applicant may be required to correct the installed improvements to conform to the approved
construction plans. In addition, the City may take such other actions deemed necessary
including, but not limited to, revocation of permits already issued and/or withholding of
future approvals and permits.
Record Drawings
Record drawings shall be consistent with the engineer’s standards adopted by Public Works
in conjunction with the development of subdivisions.
Inspection and Acceptance of Improvements
a. All improvements required by these regulations shall be inspected by the City Engineer,
except as agreed to pursuant to an owner contract or development improvement
agreement. Improvements made under the jurisdiction of other City-approved public
agencies, shall be inspected by engineers or inspectors of such agencies. Where
inspections are made by other agencies, the applicant shall provide the City Engineer
with written reports of each final inspection.
b. It shall be the responsibility of the applicant to notify the City Engineer of the
commencement of construction of improvements 24 hours prior before construction
begins. Inspections shall be required at each of the following stages of construction or as
otherwise determined through and owner contract or development improvement
agreement:
1) Site grading/erosion control completion;
2) Underground utility installation;
3) Subgrade preparation prior to aggregate base installation;
4) Aggregate base compaction;
Side lot lines of lots abutting a public or private right-of-way should, to the maximum extent
practical, run at right angles to the right-of-way line, or in the case of a cul-de- sac or
curvilinear street rights-of-way radial to the curve.
Through Lots
Through lots shall be avoided, except where dictated by topographical conditions or where
necessitated by a lot layout that restricts access to abutting collector, arterial, expressway, or
freeway streets.
Adequate Frontage Required
a. Frontage requirements for access purposes need to comply with the requirements of
Section 60.400.040D and may, at the discretion of the City, be met through provision of
direct access or the use of joint access agreements.
b. A limited number of flag lots and lots with no frontage may be authorized to enable the
more efficient use of irregularly shaped parcels of land, or where the integrated nature of
multiple buildings on a site dictates the need for such lots.
c. In the case of lots with no frontage, access for vehicles, utilities, and emergency vehicles
shall be insured through the use of common area agreements or private easements
available for use by all governmental and quasi-governmental vehicles.
Individual Requirements for Each Type of Lot
a. Full Frontage Lots
1) Lot frontage must be the same as the required minimum lot width for the district
where the lot the is located, as stated in Section 60.400.020, Dimensional
Standards unless an exception in this UDC applies.
2) Full frontage lots shall provide adequate spacing of access points for the type(s) of
street(s) on which they have frontage.
b. Cul-de-Sac Lots
Cul-de-sac lots shall:
1) Be at least 50 percent of the minimum required width in the district where they are
located, but not less than 25 feet; and
2) Meet the minimum required lot width at the building line (if one is specified).
c. Flag Lots
1) Flag lots and other irregularly shaped lots are discouraged in new and existing
subdivisions.
2) When there is no reasonable alternative, flag lots may be approved if the following
standards are met.
(a) The length of the flagpole portion of the lot shall not exceed 300 feet and
shall comply with all other standards and measurements of this UDC.
(b) A maximum of one lot or five percent of the lots in a development, whichever
is greater, may be flag lots. There is no limitation on the number or
percentage of lots in a development in the case of redevelopment or infill
development of lots developed initially in reliance upon individual sewage
treatment and having a lot size of 0.75 acres or greater.
(c) In the case of flag lots developed by subdivision in reliance upon individual
sewage treatment, all lots must be covered by a utility connection agreement
providing for municipal services.
Roadway and Subdivision Design Standards
The requirements of this Section 60.400.030H shall be used in conjunction with the City’s
adopted engineering standards for public works in conjunction with the development of
subdivisions to guide the design of roadway improvements within the City.
Streets shall be graded to the full width of the right-of-way in accordance with grades
submitted to and approved by the City Engineer.
All street grading and gravel base construction shall comply with approved plans.
Where necessary, street grading shall be completed prior to the installation of applicable
underground utilities, and gravel base construction undertaken after the installation of the
utilities.
Following the City Engineer’s approval of street grading and utility installation, streets shall
be surfaced and provided with adequate stormwater facilities consistent with the engineering
standards adopted by the City applicable to the development of subdivisions.
Boulevard Trees
All development subject to this Section 60.400.030 shall comply with all applicable standards in
Section 60.400.060A, Boulevard Trees.
Private Roadways
Private roadways or streets developed as part of a subdivision shall be of adequate width to
serve anticipated traffic and proposed parking conditions and shall be designed for the safe
operation of vehicles on the roadway.
The applicant for any subdivision including private streets shall be required to:
a. Notify property owners through deed restrictions and covenants which streets in the
development are private streets. The City will not accept the dedication of any private
street until it is brought into conformance with City street standards at the expense of
property owners.
b. Ensure in writing the maintenance and repair of all private streets by an entity other than
the City, through the use of documents approved as to form and content by the City.
c. Install, at its own expense, traffic signs and street signs that comply with applicable City
requirements at all intersections along each private street and shall ensure in writing the
maintenance and repair of those signs through the use of documents approved as to
form and content by the City.
The applicant or subsequent owners of the roadway are responsible for installation and
maintenance, including replacement of the roadway name signs.
The width of a private roadway shall comply with the City’s adopted Private Roadway
Standards and Fire Access Minimum Standards.
Private roadways shall comply with the minimum Connectivity Index standards as described
in Section 60.400.040C.4.
Street Classification
Approval
Classification of an existing or proposed street not already identified on the Long Range
Transportation Plan, for the purpose of determining the appropriate design of a roadway or
development, or for the purpose of determining the appropriateness of a location for a
proposed use, shall be done by the Community Development Director in consultation with
the City Engineer.
Classification Factors
a. In determining the classification of a street, factors to be considered include the
following existing or proposed features:
1) Facility geometrics, including the number and width of traffic lanes, turning lanes,
and parking lanes;
2) Access conditions, including any restrictions on access, the spacing of private
accesses, and average lot frontages;
3) Traffic characteristics, including design volume, percentage of trucks, design
speed, percentage of turning movements, origin-destination characteristics of the
traffic, and peak hour characteristics of traffic; and
4) Adjacent land uses.
b. Using this information in conjunction with the Long Range Transportation Plan Map and
the narrative descriptions for each roadway classification provided in the Long Range
Transportation Plan Document, the Community Development Director shall determine
which of the Long Range Transportation Plan designations apply to the street under
consideration.
Quadrant Street System
The numerical quadrant system is hereby adopted as the primary basis for identifying all public
roadways within the City, including without limitation public roadways created by plat, deed,
easement, or user. Names may be used when the roadway alignment does not permit the use of
numbers. In that case, the Community Development Director or their authorized representative
must approve the names in accordance with Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 20-16.
4) Have a cover of six inches or more of topsoil suitable for the seeding and cultivation
of grass.
f. Dedication of Non-Buildable Land
1) If land is proposed to be dedicated and is considered non-buildable (i.e., steep
slopes, wetlands, drainage ways, high rock, high water table, limited or no access)
the applicant may dedicate the property to the City to meet all or a portion of the
required parkland dedication.
2) The Director of Park and Recreation will review the dedication and give a
recommendation as to whether the City should accept the dedication. If the City
chooses to accept the dedication of the non-buildable land, credit against required
parkland dedication will be awarded at a rate of 20 percent of the buildable land
equivalent.
3) The following example lays out the dedication scenario: development required land
dedication is 10 acres. Currently five acres has slopes of four percent or less. Two
acres can be made to meet the four percent slopes or less. The remaining three
acres of dedication may be met through the use of non-buildable land. However, to
meet the three-acre requirement the owner would need to dedicate 15 acres of
non-buildable property (15 acres X 20% = 3 acres of equivalent buildable acres).
g. Forbidden Activities
Following the dedication of lands, no person shall remove trees, vegetation, or topsoil
from the dedicated land, nor shall the dedicated lands be used for the purpose of
stockpiling of earth or construction material, or disposal of construction debris, without
the written consent of the Director of Park and Recreation.
Marketability of Title
a. General Requirements
1) Prior to dedication, the applicant shall deliver to the City for examination an up-to-
date abstract of title or registered property certificate for examination, or a title
opinion by a person licensed to practice law in Minnesota.
2) If the examination of title by the City, or the title opinion, indicates that title is not
marketable, no subdivision of the land shall occur until the applicant shall take
those steps needed to permit marketable title, subject to the exceptions set forth in
Section 60.400.030M.4.b, to be conveyed to the City by dedication upon the lands’
subdivision or by a subsequent separate conveyance.
b. Exceptions
The title to lands proposed to be subdivided shall not be deemed unmarketable by virtue
of the fact that a mortgage or other equitable interest in the lands is held by a person
other than the applicant; or that the lands are subject to the lien of a special assessment
provided that the applicant removes any such equitable interest or mortgage prior to or
simultaneously with the later transfer of title to the City.
reason of natural features or existing development, and do not create safety hazards or
increased maintenance costs.
1) Residential local streets shall intersect with higher order streets using designs and
alignment that discourage through traffic.
2) Local streets shall intersect with a higher order street to prevent local street traffic
from exceeding 1,000 average daily trips.
3) Local collector streets shall intersect with two streets of equal or higher
classification.
4) Alleys shall intersect with local collector or local streets.
5) Frontage roads shall be designed so that stacking areas of sufficient depth are
provided at primary intersections. When located along collectors, such primary
intersections should be at least 300 feet apart, while on higher order streets the
separation shall be as recommended by the City Engineer.
6) The City may require a street to be of a collector level design where the anticipated
average daily trips will exceed 3,000 trips and serves to collect and distribute traffic
to the major street system identified on the Long Range Transportation Plan.
7) Intervals between access points can be reduced as recommended by the governing
Road Authority. When access to an arterial or expressway is permitted, the
adjoining property shall, the City may require that the property provide a public
street or other access public access to adjoining lands.
8) Reserve strips (i.e., a narrow parcel between a road and another lot) and cul-de-sac
streets that interfere with street connections needed to serve existing or planned
development are prohibited.
setbacks applicable to the district where the cul-de-sac is located shall apply to the lots
abutting the easement or right-of-way.
g. Alleys
1) Alleys may be used to reduce the need for individual site access to collectors,
arterials, and expressways, or to reduce the need for individual driveway access
points onto local streets.
2) Blocks platted with alleys shall be platted to allow alley access to required vehicle
parking areas, and shall not permit vehicle access to parking areas through front or
side lot lines.
3) Where alleys are platted, they shall be a minimum of 18 feet in width, unless a
minimum width of 20 feet is required for fire equipment access.
Connectivity Index
a. General Requirement
The roadway connectivity shall meet a minimum ratio as decided by the number of lots
on a development, excluding outlots. Additional pedestrian links shall be provided to
increase the overall connectivity index to the minimum, should the development fail to
meet the minimum using roadway connections. Proposed subdivisions must meet the
access requirements as required by the Fire Code, Complete Streets Policy, and all
Ordinances pertaining to access management and roadway placement.
b. Minimum Required Connectivity Ratio
1) Developments with 10 lots or fewer shall be required to meet a connectivity ratio of
1.0 or greater.
2) Developments with more than 10, but fewer than 50 lots shall be required to meet
a ratio of 1.2 or greater.
3) Developments with greater than 50, but fewer than 100 lots shall be required to
meet a ratio of 1.4 or greater.
4) Developments with more than 100 lots shall be required to meet a ratio of 1.5 or
greater.
c. Connectivity Index Calculation
1) Arterial streets shall not be included in the calculation except when it is necessary
to travel along the arterial street to reach any two nodes in the subdivision.
2) Existing intersections outside of the development area shall not be counted as a
node. However, streets extending into the development from these intersections
shall be counted as links.
3) Stub streets that will eventually be connected from the subdivision to a future
abutting subdivision or arterial or collector street shall not be counted as a node.
The segment of the stub street shall be counted as a link.
4) Alleys shall not be counted as a link, and locations where an alley intersects with a
street shall not be counted as a node.
5) Any location where a street creates a T-intersection with a street of any
classification shall be considered a node.
d. Allowed Adjustments
1) A subdivision may have a roadway connectivity index of less than the required
minimum where specific features or constraints of the land being subdivided
makes strict compliance impossible or impractical. Such features include the
following:
(a) Natural features such as bodies of water, severe elevation changes (12
percent slope or greater), Decorah Edge, hydric soils, or presence of
wetlands.
(b) Important cultural or archeological features such as historic landmarks or
burial grounds.
(c) Adjacent subdivisions that do not provide stub streets or other opportunities
to connect to the proposed subdivision.
(d) Situations where intersections, access management, and driveway
separation requirements prevent the ability to provide additional connections
to a public road.
2) If the applicant is unable to meet the required minimum ratio, then the applicant
shall attach to the General Development Plan application an explanation of how the
connectivity of the proposed development is hindered by the presence of any of the
features listed above or similar features. The Community Development Director
shall recommend the application for approval or approval with conditions if it
determines that the connectivity of the proposed subdivision cannot meet the
minimum index requirements due to the site constraints.
3) The Community Development Director may recommend denial if it determines that
the proposed development’s connectivity can be reasonably improved despite the
presence of constraining features.
4) If requested by the City, cross-access and maintenance agreements associated
with the interconnections shall be provided prior to or simultaneously with approval
of the associated subdivision or development application.
Cross-Access between Adjacent Mixed Use and Non-Residential Uses
All subdivisions or reconfigurations of contiguous platted lots for mixed use or non-residential
development shall comply with the following standards.
a. To the maximum extent practicable, each lot layout shall be designed to allow for cross-
access to adjacent property to encourage shared parking and access points on public or
private streets. This may be established by one or more of the following:
1) Connecting streets and drives;
2) Coordinating parking structure and parking lot entrances;
3) Common service/delivery areas;
4) Legally shared parking structures and parking lots;
(ii) 30 feet in width if a trail easement between the rear or side lot lines of a
parcel;
(b) Connect to the street system in a safe and convenient manner;
(c) Be well-signed with destination and directional signing;
(d) Be located and designed to minimize motor vehicle crossings to the
maximum extent practicable. Significantly minimized.
c. Use of Sidewalks, Bikeways, and Multi-Use Trails
1) Sidewalks, Bikeways, and Multi-Use trails shall comply with the City’s adopted
Public Works Design Requirements.
2) Vehicle parking, garbage containers, merchandise storage or display, utility boxes
and poles, signs, trees, and other obstructions shall not encroach into the required
minimum width of any required sidewalk, bikeway, and/or multi-use trail.
3) Sidewalks, bikeways, and multi-use trails required by this Section 60.400.040C.6
shall be maintained in usable condition throughout the year.
d. Credits
1) Credits for parkland dedication may be granted for land that is voluntarily dedicated
for multi-use trails or other trails if the Park and Recreation Director determines
that the use of that trail will reduce demand on the City’s park system.
2) Credits shall not be given for land that is dedicated for trails adjacent to roadways.
Consistency with Driveway Spacing Standards
Land subdivisions and General Development Plans shall be designed to facilitate compliance
with the site level driveway spacing standards in Section 60.400.040D and each of the
following access design standards.
a. Proposed subdivisions fronting on freeways or expressways shall be designed so as to
have access available via a lower-level street.
b. Where feasible, subdivisions shall be designed so that access to a development is not
solely dependent on a roadway or driveway that intersects with an expressway as
designated on the Long Range Transportation Plan.
c. Where lots in a proposed subdivision front on an arterial street as designated on the
Long Range Transportation Plan, options for designing access that meets the standards
of this Section 60.400.040C include the potential use of cross access easements and
the use of lower-level streets to provide secondary access.
d. Vehicular ingress and egress restrictions along the frontage of arterial or higher-level
streets may be imposed by requiring subdivision plats to dedicate to the proper Road
Authority access control authority.
3) Limiting access will create an exceptional and undue hardship on the applicant and
that the permit issued will allow a reasonable use of the property; and
4) The applicant has mitigated the negative impacts of proposed substandard access
to the maximum extent practicable.
Temporary Access
An applicant shall not be denied a Zoning Certificate where the access requirements of this
UDC cannot be met because adjoining segments of planned street are not yet constructed, in
which case the Community Development Director may approve temporary access to another
street, which right to access shall expire when the access required by this UDC becomes
available for use.
Driveway Design Standards
A driveway permit for any Non-Residential or Multifamily use may be approved if the City
Engineer determines that the permit will allow reasonable access to the property and that all
of the following standards have been met to the maximum extent practicable:
a. Adequate corner clearance from any adjacent street intersections has been provided to
preserve the functional integrity of the intersection, and spacing from adjacent driveways
is sufficient to safely minimize conflicts between traffic entering and exiting adjacent
driveways;
b. Adequate stopping sight distance and intersection sight distance is provided;
c. Auxiliary lanes are provided as needed to:
1) Minimize speed differentials with mainline highway traffic;
2) Prevent the encroachment of turning vehicles on mainline traffic; and
3) Prevent the queuing of inbound traffic from impacting mainline traffic.
d. Sufficient vehicular stacking distance between the curb line and the first point of conflict
for traffic on the site is provided to prevent the spill back of traffic onto public streets.
This distance shall be adequate to absorb the maximum peak period inbound traffic
during the normal weekday;
e. Appropriate conflict reduction measures have been provided to safely manage inbound
and outbound left turning traffic. Median design features and driveway channelization
shall be used as appropriate to accomplish conflict reduction;
f. Access locations have been properly offset from driveways or street intersections located
across the roadway in order to limit conflicts within the mainline or median of the street;
g. The design of the access satisfies standard geometric guidelines for turning radii,
driveway slope and angle of entry, design speed, and width. The drainage design of the
access should not interfere with the drainage system in the public right-of-way;
h. The access provides for the safe crossing of pedestrians, bicyclists, and persons with
disabilities;
i. The installation of necessary traffic control devices for the safe and proper operation of
the access complies with the requirements of the Manual of Uniform Traffic Control
Devices (MUTCD) and, in the case of traffic signals, are located so as to allow for proper
signal coordination and adequate left turn storage needs at the access and nearby
intersections; and
j. The access will not create conflicts with abutting roadway traffic.
Conditions of Approval
If necessary to ensure compliance with the approval criteria in Subsection 7 above, the City
Engineer may require:
a. That unobstructed and unencumbered access be provided from the approved access
point to adjacent properties. Where such a requirement is made a condition of approval,
the property owner shall record an easement with the deed allowing cross access to and
from other designated properties to be served by the joint use driveway or access;
b. That an access point that does not comply with one or more of the objectives in this
Section 60.400.040C be designated as temporary access, and that when an alternative
means of access is available that better meets the objectives of this Section
60.400.040C is available, the temporary access be eliminated, altered, or limited to
certain turning movement; and/or
c. That the applicant be required to participate in the cost of design, installation, operation,
and maintenance of the access construction and any associated traffic operation
equipment required for the functioning of the access point.
Pedestrian Design and Accessibility
The following standards apply to all new development and redevelopment in all districts
except Household Living uses in structures with less than 8,000 square feet of gross floor
area.
a. Access and Walkways
1) Walkways shall be provided to connect each primary pedestrian entrance of a
primary building to at least one public sidewalk along a property frontage, and shall
be designed to provide convenient access to any bus or transit stops located within
1,000 feet of the lot boundary.
2) Walkways shall be located and aligned to connect areas or points of pedestrian
origin and destination directly and continuously and shall not be located and
aligned solely based on the outline of a parking lot configuration unless such a
configuration allows for direct pedestrian access.
3) A sidewalk shall be provided immediately adjacent to the exterior wall of a new
building greater than 100 feet in length when the wall is located next to a street or
parking lot. This standard does not apply if the edge of the building is within 20 feet
of a public sidewalk and the building entrance is connected to the public sidewalk
by an on-site pedestrian walkway, or if the edge of the building is bordered by a
perimeter of landscaping that does not exceed 30 feet in width and an on-site
pedestrian walkway is constructed at the outer edge of the landscaped area.
4) Pedestrian walkways shall be designed to maximize pedestrian security,
incorporating features such as lighting to illuminate crossings and/or create
backlighting to make the pedestrian silhouette clearly visible from primary building
entrances and/or public streets, and shall provide clear sight lines between two
feet and six feet above grade from primary building entrances to public street
frontages.
5) Walkways shall have a paved surface width of not less than five feet. The material
and layout shall be continuous as the pedestrian walkway crosses driving lanes or
aisles, with a break in continuity of the driveway paving and not in the pedestrian
walkway paving.
6) Curb cuts and ramps shall be located at convenient and safe locations for persons
with disabilities, bicyclists, and people pushing strollers or carts. The location of
curb cuts and ramps shall avoid crossing or directing traffic through loading areas,
drive-in lanes, and solid waste storage and collection areas, to the maximum extent
practicable.
b. Pedestrian Entrances
Properties in the MX-T and MX-D districts shall comply with the standards in Section
60.200.030L.3.d, Building Entrances. All other properties subject to this Section
60.400.040D.9 shall comply with the standards in this Section 60.400.040D.11.b.
1) One primary pedestrian entrance shall be provided for every façade facing a street.
2) To the maximum extent practicable, an entrance shall be provided every 30 feet on
the ground floor.
3) To the maximum extent practicable and excluding building façades for ground floor
residential uses, corner lots shall provide a primary entrance at the corner.
4) All ground level residential units along all street-facing sides of the building will be
provided direct access entries from the building exterior. The Community
Development Director may waive this requirement for some or all of the units, upon
determination that an alternative design will provide a better pedestrian orientated
space.
5) The pedestrian entrance shall contain at least three of the following architectural
details:
(a) Pilasters or façade modules;
(b) Mural;
(c) Prominent building address, building name, and lighting;
(d) Raised corniced entryway parapet; or
(e) Buttress and arched entry.
6) The features installed to comply with Subsection 5 above may also be used to
comply with the requirements of Section 60.400.070F.1.e, Roof-Mounted
Equipment Screening
7) Roof-mounted mechanical equipment shall be:
(a) Integrated into the design of the structure so that the equipment is not visible
from ground level on any street-facing property boundary; or
(b) Screened by a parapet wall or similar feature that is an integral part of the
building’s architectural design, with a parapet wall height sufficient to screen
the mechanical equipment from all sides when viewed from ground-level on
each street-facing property boundary.
8) To reduce visual impacts on abutting properties, the color of roof-mounted
equipment shall be the same color as the roof or the same color as an adjacent
wall.
9) Commercial Wireless Telecommunication Service equipment, Building-Mounted
Solar Collectors, and other alternative energy systems are exempt from any portion
of these screening requirements that would impair their functions.
10) Horizontal Articulation.
Applicability
This Section 60.400.050D applies to all subdivision and Site Development Plan approvals unless
the Community Development Director determines that review of the Site Development Plan is not
necessary because the application complies with avoidance and mitigation measures already
applicable to the property due to prior development approvals.
Relationship to Other Standards
The standards in this Section 60.400.050 apply in addition to other applicable standards,
including but not limited to those listed in Subsections C.1 through C.3 below. In case of a
conflict between standards applicable to the same land or activity subject to this Section
60.400.050, the stricter regulation shall govern unless otherwise required by state or federal
law.
State or Federal Laws or Regulations
The standards in this Section 60.400.050 apply in addition to any applicable standards in
state or federal law and applicable regulations adopted pursuant to those laws.
Overlay Districts
The standards in this Section 60.400.050F apply in addition to any applicable standards in
Section 60.200.040D, DEO - Decorah Edge Overlay. Section 60.200.040E, FPO – Floodplain
Overlay, and Section 60.200.040F, SDO – Shoreland District Overlay.
Adopted Engineering Standards
The standards in this Section 60.400.050F apply in addition to any applicable engineering
standards including stormwater discharge requirements in Rochester Code of Ordinances
Chapter 6-3, Wetland Conservation, and 6-4, Stormwater Discharges.
General Requirement for all Sensitive Lands
Development of lands that are subject to periodic inundation, subsidence of the earth’s surface,
high water table, or have difficult topography, unstable soils, wetlands, lateral groundwater flow
occurring within the depth of construction activities, or other natural or human-created hazards
to life or property shall be avoided.
Wetlands
In addition to complying with Subsection D above:
No land-disturbing activity, mowing, or temporary or permanent structure shall be allowed
within 25 feet of a delineated wetland.
A wetland buffer area extending 25 feet from a delineated wetland is required on all
delineated wetlands.
Draining of a delineated wetland is prohibited.
Stormwater drainage into a wetland shall not be increased over, or substantially reduced
below, its pre-development rate or volume.
Stormwater
Protection of Wetlands
Stormwater runoff from a construction site directed to a wetland shall be substantially free of
silt and debris and shall be discharged at a rate that will not disturb vegetation or increase
turbidity.
Runoff Reduction Requirements
a. Increases in the rate or volume of runoff from 10-year and 100-year frequency storms
due to development, redevelopment, or change of use activity on the site shall be
detained within the development and released at a rate no greater than existed prior to
the development unless otherwise permitted by the City Engineer.
b. Greater runoffs may be permitted by the City Engineer if downstream stormwater
management facilities are adequate for the conveyance or if the development is adjacent
to a receiving body of water such as a lake or river and proposed runoff is consistent with
the Stormwater Management Plan.
c. On-site management of stormwater shall be accomplished through the use of bioswales,
raingardens, and other best management practices identified by the City to the maximum
extent practicable.
Overland Drainage
The use of overland drainage and retention to control stormwater runoff is allowed if
approved by the City Engineer, consistent with the Stormwater Management Plan, benefits
groundwater recharge, and reduces long-term maintenance costs.
Channel Restrictions Prohibited
a. No fences or structures shall be constructed across an open drainage channel or
easement that could reduce or restrict the flow of water, unless part of an approved
retention or detention facility or a revocable permit has been approved to allow the fence
or structure. If a revocable permit is required, conditions attached to that permit may
require mitigation of impacts related to the crossing.
b. All stormwater management facilities shall be designed and constructed in conformance
with the City’s Stormwater Management Plan and other public works design criteria.
c. The City may require any water course or stormwater management facility to be located
within a dedicated drainage easement that provides sufficient width for maintenance.
Erosion Control, Grading, and Drainage
Compliance with Adopted Plans and Local Agencies Required
Drainage and grading plans shall be designed to comply with the standards of the Rochester
Stormwater Management Plan and adopted drainage or stormwater policies and this Section
60.400.050. The City Engineer also may request review and comment by the Olmsted County
Soil and Water Conservation District on the adequacy of the plans and their
recommendations may be used by the City Engineer in the final determination of permit
issuance by the Community Development Department.
Erosion Control
a. Grading Permit
Grading Permits shall address how soil erosion and sedimentation will be minimized
during construction and following final completion of a development. The areas to be
addressed include erodible slopes, streambanks and shorelines, drainageways, borrow
and stockpile areas, and drainage structures such as culverts, drop structures, and
stormwater detention and retention improvements.
b. Erosion Control Standards
The plans for erosion and sedimentation control shall conform with the City’s Stormwater
Management Plan, City engineering standards, the Minnesota Pollution Control Agency’s
Construction Stormwater Permit, and the following standards.
1) The smallest practical area of land shall be exposed at any given time during
development.
2) The duration of exposure shall be kept to as short a time as possible.
3) If practical, temporary vegetation, mulching, or other cover should be used to
protect areas exposed during development.
4) Final plant covering or permanent surface treatment shall be installed as soon as
possible after completion of final grading.
5) Prevent erosion of and sedimentation onto adjacent properties during and after
completion of grading activities.
6) Compliance with applicable state and federal requirements shall be noted on the
plans.
c. Stockpiling of Fill in Right-of-Way Prohibited
Material excavated from or to be used as fill on any lot under development shall not be
stockpiled or deposited on any improved public right-of-way.
Grading Plans and Requirements
a. When Required
An approved grading plan shall be required:
1) As part of an application for a Final Plat;
2) As part of an application for a Zoning Certificate or conditional use that involves a
development that was not included in a previously approved grading plan and will
disturb over 10,000 square feet of area; and
3) When any land disturbing activity involving the excavation or fill of earth material
not associated with the excavation for footing/foundation or the use of land on a
site exceeds an accumulative total of 50 cubic yards of material and/or is left
exposed for more than 45 days.
1) No boulevard shall be paved by the property owner or applicant outside of the area
established for the sidewalk required for the property and driveway approach,
unless found to be consistent by the Public Works Director with a long-term plan for
pavement improvements.
2) Where the City permits paving within the boulevard by separate permit, each tree
location shall have a minimum of 60 square feet of non-paved permeable surface
surrounding each tree.
3) All boulevards must be vegetated with turf grass or other approved landscaping
outside of the allowed pavement for sidewalk and driveway approach.
4) Development requiring planting of boulevard trees shall be required to apply the
standards and specifications for turf restoration and boulevard treatment as
established by the Public Works Director.
c. Planting Standards
Planting of boulevard trees shall comply with the following standards to the maximum
extent practicable.
1) Tree spacing shall average 50 feet for residential properties and 35 feet for
commercial properties. Dimensions are used for measurements between trees
located within the boulevard.
2) A minimum separation of seven feet shall be provided from edge of driveways as
measured at the property line.
3) A minimum separation of 12 feet shall be provided from above-ground utility
equipment.
4) A minimum separation of 20 feet shall be provided from roadway street lighting,
however, new light technology (i.e., LED) may allow reduction of dimensions in the
future.
5) A minimum separation of 25 feet from the intersection of sidewalks (normally
measured from the property line).
6) Planting on slopes steeper than 60 degrees requires additional review by the Parks
and Recreation Director and may be denied or subject to conditions to mitigate
potential impacts on tree health or nearby areas.
Road Authority
This Section 60.400.060A does not apply where the Road Authority determines that
boulevard trees will not be permitted.
Payment-in-lieu of Boulevard Tree Planting
a. Applicability
A payment-in-lieu of the standards in this Section 60.400.060A may be available if the
Director of Park and Recreation determines that installation of boulevard trees as
required by this Section 60.400.060A.4 is not desirable because the trees would
interfere with sign visibility or with infrastructure.
b. Sign Visibility
The boulevard tree standards may be modified to preserve the visibility of signs as
approved by the Parks and Recreation Director. If the Parks and Recreation Director
determines that compliance with this Section 60.400.060A is not feasible in order to
preserve the visibility of signs, then they may require a payment-in-lieu to the City.
c. Sequencing
A payment-in-lieu will not be approved unless the City finds that the applicant has
demonstrated that the trees or planting spaces cannot be provided as specified in
Section 60.400.060D and none of the modifications of boulevard tree planting and
installation requirements listed in Subsections 1) through 6) below are practicable on the
property. If the Parks and Recreation Director determines that more than one of the
modifications listed below are practicable on the property, the modification appearing
first in the list shall be required (e.g., if both modifications 1) and 3) are practicable, the
applicant shall be required to comply with modification 1) in lieu of submitting a
payment-in-lieu).
1) Use of alternate canopy tree species;
2) The grouping of trees that may also include alternate tree species (this principle
includes a reduction in the separation distance between trees acceptable to the
Park and Recreation Director);
3) Substituting understory for canopy trees;
4) Trimming of trees to provide business visibility;
5) Altering sign location, design, height, or sign type; and
6) Compliance with the “payment-in-lieu” requirements.
d. Payment
Payment shall be made prior to the recording of the Final Plat of the subdivision or
issuance of a Zoning Certificate/building permit pursuant to a Development Plan or
Conditional Use Permit approved by the City, or as determined by the development
agreement. The calculation of the amount of the cash payment required shall be
computed based solely on the number of boulevard trees reduced by the applicant for
the purpose of sign visibility or infrastructure constrictions multiplied by the annual fee
established by City Council.
e. Funds Established
All payments collected pursuant to this Section 60.400.060A.4 shall be placed in a
neighborhood tree fund and shall be expended within one year of completing
construction. The funds may only be disbursed for the establishment of boulevard trees
on public rights of way. A fee for boulevard trees and installation shall be established on
an annual basis by the City Council.
f. Responsible Agency
After consultation with the Parks and Recreation Director, the Community Development
Director shall determine whether a payment-in-lieu will be accepted by the City. The
payment shall be submitted to the Parks and Recreation Director.
General Landscaping
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.400.060B is to improve Rochester’s vegetated environment
and to foster aesthetically pleasing development that will protect and improve Rochester’s
biodiversity and ecosystems.
Landscape Plan Required
Any application for a Zoning Certificate or Conditional Use Permit involving the installation of
required plantings shall be accompanied by a landscape plan that includes all required
information.
Ownership of Landscape Area
Landscape area ownership may take one of the following three forms.
a. Private Ownership of Landscape Area
Private landscape area is land located on the same zoning lot as the principal use under
the control of the owners of the principal structure or use on the lot.
b. Common Landscape Area
Common landscape area is land within a development not individually owned or
dedicated for public use that is designed and intended for the common use or enjoyment
of the occupants of the development.
c. Public Landscape Area
Public landscaped area is a form of common landscaped area that has been dedicated
in fee to the local governing body or one of its agencies. While maintained for the use
and enjoyment of the general public, the area is designed primarily for the residents of
the particular development where it has been used to meet the landscape area
requirement.
Access Requirements
When landscaped area is provided through either common or public means, assurances
shall be provided that the area will be accessible to all residents of the development. Such
access may be provided either through adjacency of the private lots or buildings to the
common space, the use of walkways or accessways leading to the common or public areas,
or public rights-of-way that have frontage on the common or public open space for a distance
of at least 40 feet.
a. Unenclosed terraces, fire escapes, planting boxes, or air conditioning units, provided no
such items projects more than six feet into or over the landscaped area;
b. Unenclosed balconies; and
c. Eaves, gutters, or downspouts.
Landscaping in Public Rights-of-Way
Landscape materials may be planted within the public right-of-way if permission is obtained
from the Road Authority. Landscape area may be partially within a public right-of-way
following approval of a revocable permit and as provided for in Section 60.500.070A Minor
Modification.
Preservation of Common and Public Landscape Areas
Landscape areas shall be maintained so that use and enjoyment as open space is not
diminished or destroyed. Common or public landscape area may be owned, preserved, and
maintained by any of the following mechanisms:
a. Ownership by the property owner subject to an agreement with the City obligating the
property owner or an entity acceptable to the City to preserve and maintain the area;
b. Through the use of condominium agreements in which all landscaped areas are
identified as “common elements.”
c. Dedication of open space to the City or an appropriate public agency, if either entity is
willing to accept the dedication.
d. Common ownership of the open space by a homeowner’s association that assumes full
responsibility for its maintenance.
e. Dedication of development rights of open space may be made to an appropriate public
agency with ownership and maintenance responsibility remaining with the applicant or
homeowner’s association.
f. Deed-restricted private ownership that shall prevent development and/or subsequent
subdivision of the open-space land and provide for maintenance responsibility.
g. Land designated as the required landscape area for a development shall not be sold,
subdivided, or developed unless adequate landscape area remains for the original
development to meet ordinance requirements. Landscape area for one development may
not be used to comply with the requirements for another development.
Front and Street Side Yard Planting Requirements
The base planting requirements in this Section 60.400.060B.11 are intended to enhance
diversification of front and street side yard landscaping, to include plantings beyond grass.
a. Applicability
1) These requirements shall apply to all non-residential uses, and residential uses
with four or more units, for front yards and, where applicable, street side yards.
2) These requirements do not apply in the MX-D and MX-T districts.
Zoning District Minimum Front and Street Side Yard Planting Requirement
1 understory tree; or
R-2x and R3 3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
2 canopy trees; or
2 understory trees, and
R4 3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
MX-N, MX-S, MX-C, and MX-G every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
3 canopy trees; or
4 understory trees; and
BP, LI, and SI 3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
Notes
[1] Shrubs must meet the 3-foot minimum height requirement within two years of planting.
c. Site constraints
Where lot size, topography, easements, or other constraints preclude complying with the
requirements of this Section, the Community Development Director may authorize
alternate plantings or planting locations.
Types of Plants Allowed
a. All plant materials must meet specifications of the American Association of Nurseryman
(AAN) for the number and grade.
b. The Community Development Director may permit other types of plant materials, such as
native grasses and forbs, if they are hardy to the Rochester area and not subject to blight
or disease.
c. Unless specifically indicated otherwise in this UDC, all plant materials shall meet
minimum size standards in Table 400.06-2 Minimum Plant Size.
Table 400.06-2 Minimum Plant Size
e. Where financial guarantees are required for such improvements under other
governmental authority, such as FHA Approval Requirements, and these conditions of
approval meet or exceed the ordinance requirements, no additional guarantee is
required.
Visibility Triangle
In any zone district that requires a front or side street building setback, there shall be no
landscaping (other than tree trunks) that extends into the vertical space between three feet
and nine feet above curb grade. Vertical measurement shall be made from the top of the
curb on the street adjacent to the nearest street of the triangle or, if no curb exists, from the
edge of the nearest traveled way. Horizontal measurement shall be 30 feet along the
property line from the intersection of two streets, or by joining points measured 10 feet back
along a driveway and lot line from the point of intersection of the driveway and lot line.
Planting in Easements
a. Vegetation located on utility easements shall be placed so that it does not interfere with
the free movement of service vehicles, or placement and operation of utility facilities.
b. Ground cover, grass, and native grasses, or hedges under three feet in heights may be
installed in or permitted to remain in the public utility easement.
c. Plantings in utility easements shall be placed at the risk of the property owner, and shall
not interfere with reasonable access to the utility facility. Utility Companies will not
replace plantings or landscaping removed or damaged during work within the easement
area.
Bufferyards
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.400.060D is to buffer existing development from adjacent
new development of different types, scales, or intensities by providing visual barriers
between those land uses as well as providing more privacy and protecting adjacent existing
uses from potential wind, dust, noise, traffic, glare, visual disorder, and harmful or noxious
effects of the new development.
Applicability
New development, redevelopment, and changes of use in all zoning districts shall provide
property edge buffering along shared property lines with abutting properties as indicated in
Table 400.06-3, Required Bufferyard Type, regardless of whether the new development is
larger or smaller or more or less intensive than the existing abutting use.
Bufferyard Requirements
a. Table 400.06-4, Bufferyard Levels, describes two different bufferyard options in terms of
their function, opacity, width, and planting requirements. Where a particular bufferyard
level is required in Table 400.06-3, Required Bufferyard Level, the requirement may be
met with the combination of minimum buffer width and minimum screening
b. Bufferyards may contain sidewalks, bikeways, multi-use trails, seating areas, stormwater
facilities, or landscape features provided that the requirements in Table 400.06-4,
Bufferyard Levels, are met.
c. Where the bufferyard between a land use and vacant land turns out to be greater than
the bufferyard that is required between the first use and the subsequently developed
use, the existing use may expand its use into the original buffer area so long as the
requirements of this Section 60.400.060D are met.
Fences, Walls, and Hedges
All fences and walls except those installed to protect slopes from subsidence or erosion shall
comply with the following standards. Fences and walls installed to protect slopes shall comply
with the Building Code.
No fence, wall, or hedge may extend beyond or across a property line unless in joint
agreement with the abutting property owner.
No fence, wall, or hedge shall be placed closer than 18 inches to any public sidewalk or
within five feet of any alley right-of-way.
In all zoning districts, fences and walls located between the front of the primary building and
the front lot line shall not exceed 36 inches in height.
In all zoning districts, fences and walls located between the front of the primary building and
the front lot line shall not be completely opaque, and shall not be constructed of chain link.
Fences and walls that are not located between the front of the primary building and the front
lot line shall not exceed six feet in height above the elevation of the surface of the ground at
any point except:
a. In instances where public safety or security necessitate, the Community Development
Director may authorize fences and walls to have a maximum height not to exceed 10 feet
above the elevation of the surface of the ground at any point; or
b. When the grade of buildings on adjacent lots is greater than that of buildings on the
applicant’s lot, the fence may exceed the height limitations, but shall not exceed the
grade of the adjacent building by more than five feet.
No fence, wall, or hedge shall be placed closer than 10 feet to the intersection of a driveway
with any right-of-way used for vehicular or pedestrian traffic including alleys.
In any district that requires a front or side street building setback, there shall be no sight-
obscuring or partly obscuring wall or fence higher than three feet above curb grade in any
Visibility Triangle. Vertical measurement shall be made from the top of the curb on the street
adjacent to the nearest street of the triangle or, if no curb exists, from the edge of the
nearest traveled way.
Where a fence is installed on any property in a Mixed Use or Non-Residential zoning district
along a property line with a lot containing a Household Living use in a Residential zoning
district, the “finished” side of the fence (generally the side where structural supports and
bracing are not visible) shall face the abutting Household Living use.
All fences, walls, and hedges shall meet all applicable clearance requirements of the
National Electric Safety Code.
Alternative Equivalent Compliance
Modifications of the required landscaping, bufferyard, and fencing requirements in this
Section 60.400.060 may be approved by the Community Development Director when
alternatives are justified by site or development conditions. Including but not limited to:
a. Natural conditions, such as watercourses, natural rock formations, or topography;
b. Unique lot size or configuration, particularly for infill and redevelopment projects;
c. The location of existing utility or other easements;
d. Potential risks to public safety; and/or
e. Preservation or natural vegetation.
Alternatives from the requirements in this Section 60.400.060 may be approved by the
Community Development Director if the Director determines that the proposed alternatives:
a. Are consistent with the purposes of this Section 60.400.060;
b. Do not include invasive vegetation included in an adopted city, county, or state list of
prohibited or invasive species;
c. Provide equal or superior buffering of adjacent properties from anticipated visual, noise,
traffic, or activity impacts of the proposed development; and
d. Provide equal or superior visual appearance of the property when viewed from public
rights-of-way and adjacent public Parks or open spaces.
b. Applicability
1) These requirements shall apply to all non-residential uses, and residential uses
with four or more units, for front yards and, where applicable, street side yards.
2) These requirements do not apply in the MX-D and MX-T districts.
3) Minimum planting as described in Table 400.06-1 shall be located between the
front building line and the front lot line, and the street-facing side building line and
side lot line, where applicable.
Table 400.06-1 Minimum Planting Requirements
Zoning District Minimum Front and Street Side Yard Planting Requirement
1 understory tree; or
R-2x and R3 3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
2 canopy trees; or
2 understory trees, and
R4 3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
MX-N, MX-S, MX-C, and MX-G every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
3 canopy trees; or
4 understory trees; and
BP, LI, and SI 3 deciduous or evergreen shrubs of minimum 3-foot-height for
every 30 linear feet of lot frontage, planted at least 3 feet part on
center [1]
Notes
[1] Shrubs must meet the 3-foot minimum height requirement within two years of planting.
c. An outer drive aisle shall be used to divert vehicular traffic away from the area in front of
stores and tenant spaces to the maximum extent practicable.
d. Trash and recycling containers shall be provided near high pedestrian traffic areas.
Public Transit Stops
Developments over one acre in size or Site Development Plans for individual buildings
containing more than 40,000 square feet of gross floor area on an existing bus route shall
be designed to accommodate a public transit stop. The transit stop must be located:
a. In proximity to a primary building entrance along a walkway adjacent to the building; or
b. Within 300 feet of a primary building entrance in an abutting parking area connected via
a walkway to the building entrance.
Pedestrian Focal Points and Canopy Trees
Developments over one acre in size or 360Site Development Plans for individual buildings
containing more than 40,000 square feet of gross floor area shall include:
a. Pedestrian focal points with enhanced pedestrian paving such as decorative scored
concrete, stained concrete, exposed aggregate, integral colored, or textured concrete
shall be provided;
b. Canopy trees incorporated along pedestrian walkways at the rate of one canopy tree per
20 lineal feet of walkway. This requirement is in addition to the applicable requirements
in Section 60.400.060, Landscaping, Bufferyards, and Fences, except that any canopy
tree installed in a required bufferyard shall count towards the minimum planting
requirement in that bufferyard; and
c. Above-ground pedestrian amenities that do not require footings may be installed at the
risk of the property owner, provided they do not interfere with reasonable access to the
utility facility, upon obtaining a revocable permit.
Usable Recreation Area
Each development containing Multifamily Dwelling uses, or containing a Residential Care
Facility use that would be subject to these standards if it was occupied by a Multifamily
Dwelling use, shall comply with the following standards.
a. General Requirements
1) The usable recreation area provided shall be designed primarily for the use of the
residents of the development providing the usable recreation land.
2) Usable recreation area may be developed for either active or passive recreation
purposes, subject to the standards in this Section 60.400.070E.8.
3) Any application for construction or expansion of a Multifamily Dwelling use shall
identify the boundaries of the areas and the types of improvements to be provided
in the designated recreation areas.
4) Land designated as the required usable recreation area for a development shall not
be sold, subdivided, or otherwise developed unless adequate recreation area
remains to comply with the requirements of this UDC.
5) Usable recreation area required to comply with the requirements of this UDC for
one development may not be used to comply with the requirements for another
development.
6) The required square footage of usable recreation area shall equal the floor area of
the Multifamily Dwelling multiplied by the applicable percentage in Table 400.07-1
Minimum Usable Recreation Area Required.
Table 400.07-1 Minimum Usable Recreation Area Required
Number of Units Minimum Area Required
18% of gross floor area of Multifamily Dwelling use, or 240
Four Units or Less
square feet, whichever is greater
10% of gross floor area of Multifamily Dwelling use, or 240
Five Units or More
square feet, whichever is greater
(ii) Terrace areas that are open to the sky and accessible to all residents in a
development.
(iii) Separate, accessory recreational buildings at ground level may be
counted as usable recreation area provided that the total impervious
surfaces of such structures do not exceed 10 percent of the total
required landscape area for the development.
(d) Up to one-half of the required recreation area provided at ground level or in
an adjacent public space may consist of water surfaces such as ponds, lakes,
or streams.
(e) Bikeways or Multi-Use Paths located in the interior of a block, surfaced in a
dust-free manner, may be counted towards the usable recreation
requirement if the Bikeway or Multi-Use Path is at least 10 feet in width and
is part of an integrated system leading to principal destinations such as a
park, school, or major recreation area.
2) Dimensions
Ground level landscaped areas and adjacent public open space areas intended to
meet the usable recreation area requirement shall meet the following dimensional
requirements.
(a) If the required recreation area is less than 10,000 square feet, all of it shall
be located in a contiguous portion of the site or lot and no dimension shall be
less than 30 feet, except that inner block play areas for small children that
are improved with play equipment shall have a minimum dimension of 20
feet and a minimum size of 1,000 square feet. If the required area is less
than 900 square feet, the minimum dimension may be reduced to 15 feet.
(b) For every 20,000 square feet of required usable recreation area, at least one
area of not less than 10,000 square feet with a minimum dimension of 50
feet shall be provided.
3) Slope
Ground level landscaped areas and adjacent public spaces intended to meet the
usable recreation requirement shall meet the following requirements:
(a) At least one-half of the required recreation area shall have a finished slope of
less than 10 percent; and
(b) The remainder of the area may have a slope of up to 25 percent if designated
and improved for passive recreational use.
4) Location and Access
(a) On developments containing five acres or more, usable recreation areas
should be centrally located or distributed throughout the development to be
readily accessible to the largest number of residents.
3) In zoning districts other than the MX-T and MX-D districts, glazed windows and
doors shall occupy at least 30 percent of each street facing façade area between
three and eight feet above grade.
4) In the MX-T and MX-D districts, glazed windows and doors on the ground floor shall
occupy at least 65 percent of each street facing façade area between three and
eight feet above grade, and shall occupy at least 30 percent of each street facing
façade area above the ground floor.
e. Roof-Mounted Equipment Screening
Roof-mounted mechanical equipment shall be:
(a) Integrated into the design of the structure so that the equipment is not visible
from ground level on any street-facing property boundary; or
(b) Screened by a parapet wall or similar feature that is an integral part of the
building’s architectural design, with a parapet wall height sufficient to screen
the mechanical equipment from all sides when viewed from ground-level on
each street-facing property boundary.
2) To reduce visual impacts on abutting properties, the color of roof-mounted
equipment shall be the same color as the roof or the same color as an adjacent
wall.
3) Commercial Wireless Telecommunication Service equipment, Building-Mounted
Solar Collectors, and other alternative energy systems are exempt from any portion
of these screening requirements that would impair their functions.
f. Horizontal Articulation
Primary buildings shall be designed to avoid blank wall planes by dividing street-facing
façades into a series of smaller horizontal components that comply with the following
standards.
1) In all districts except the MX-T and MX-D districts, each street-facing façade,
regardless of exterior wall plane setback, shall incorporate two or more of the
following elements for every 60 horizontal feet:
(a) Projections, recessions, or reveals such as, but not limited to, columns,
pilasters, cornices, and bays, and having a change of wall plane that is a
minimum of six inches in depth;
(b) Change in texture and/or masonry patterns; and/or
(c) Awnings or canopies extending at least four feet beyond the building face
with a minimum vertical clearance of nine feet above the sidewalk. Glowing
awnings (backlit, light showing through the material) are not permitted.
2) In the MX-T and MX-D districts, each street facing façade of each primary building
shall comply with the following standards.
(a) Access for Ground Level Units
All ground level residential units along all street-facing sides of the building
must provide direct access entries from the building exterior. The Community
Development Director may waive this requirement for some or all of the units,
upon determination that an alternative design will provide a better pedestrian
orientated space along the frontage of the development.
(b) Building Façades Less Than 150 Feet Long
Each street facing façade with a horizontal length between 60 and 89 feet
shall incorporate at least one of the following elements; street-facing façades
with a horizontal length between 90 and 119 feet shall incorporate at least
two of the following elements; and street-facing building façades with a
horizontal length over 120 feet must incorporate at least three of the
following elements for every 60 horizontal feet:
(i) A change in a street facing parapet height of at least two vertical feet,
extending at least 20 horizontal feet of parapet length;
(ii) Horizontally oriented recesses at least eight inches into, or projections or
cornices extending at least eight inches outward from, the building
façade plane, at least eight inches tall, and extending at least 30
horizontal feet along the building façade (this element may be installed
along the entire building façade, but if so installed shall only count as one
of the required elements on any street-facing building façade longer than
60 feet);
ground floor tenants may share a single pedestrian entrance facing that public right-of-
way.
c. Each required pedestrian entrance shall open directly to the outside and have direct
access to the adjacent sidewalk without requiring pedestrians to pass through a garage,
parking lot, or a non-pedestrian area located between the pedestrian entrance and the
street.
Additional Requirements in the Destination Medical Center Area
Each primary or accessory building within the Destination Medical Center development plan,
as defined by Minn. Stat. 469.43, shall comply with the DMC Design Guidelines applicable
Design Guidelines to the most maximum extent practicable, as determined by the
Community Development Director.
Additional Requirements in the MX-D, MX-T, and MX-I Districts
Each primary building in the MX-D or MX-I districts over 60 feet in height shall comply with
the following standards:
a. Minimum Floor-to-Floor Height
The minimum floor-to-ceiling height of the ground floor of any principal use shall be 13
feet, and on upper floors shall be 12 feet.
b. Vertical Articulation
Each primary building that is more than ten stories in height shall be designed to include
a clearly identifiable base, body, and top of the building.
1) Base
(a) The base of a primary building shall not be more than three stories or 40 feet
in height, whichever is less.
(b) The base shall incorporate one or more of the following design techniques:
(i) Incorporation of low planters and walls;
(ii) Use of base architectural veneer banding or a wainscot treatment defined
by different materials, textures, or colors; and/or
(iii) Integrated covered walkways, trellises, or architectural awnings that
provide deep shadow at ground level.
2) Body
The body of a primary building shall include all floors of the building between the
base of the building and the top of the building. Each façade of the building body
shall comply with all of the following:
(a) Incorporate at least a 20 percent reduction in floor area from the base of the
building;
(b) Be set back at least 10 feet from the edge of each street-facing base of the
building; and
(c) If the body of the building includes towers (i.e., two or more building
floorplates rising from the base) each of the floorplates shall be separated
from each other by at least 40 horizontal feet.
3) Top
The top of the building shall include all portions of each building façade above the
ceiling plate of the highest occupied floor of the building and may at the
applicants’ option also include the façade of the highest occupied floor of the
building. On each façade of the building top, no roofline shall exceed 50 feet in
horizontal length without a visual variation that incorporates:
(a) Projections, recessions, and/or dormers that alter the vertical or horizontal
plan of the roof by at least two feet;
(b) Change in roof height of at least two feet; and/or
(c) Distinct parapet designs and cornice treatments.
c. Additional Studies
1) For new developments over 100 feet in height, the City may require additional
studies of wind, sunlight, and/or shadow impacts on surrounding properties and
rights-of-way, bicycle, and/or pedestrian facilities, at the applicant’s expense, if the
Community Development Director determines that the proposed height, bulk,
length, location, or shape of the proposed development may create adverse wind,
sunlight/shadow, or public safety impacts.
2) Based on the results of a required study, the Community Development Director may
require that building design features be added, deleted, or changed to minimize or
mitigate those impacts to the maximum extent practicable, provided that no
required change shall have the effect of reducing the gross floor area of the
building below the maximum permitted on that lot.
Iconic Building Alternatives
On development sites larger than five acres, or for a primary structure containing a Public,
Institutional, or Civic use, the Community Development Director may waive or adjust the
building design standards in Subsections 1, 2, and 3 to approve an alternative design for a
single primary structure if the Director determines that the following criteria are met.
a. The primary structure is in a highly visible location, or will be highly visible due to its
height or massing, or will contain a Public, Institutional, or Civic primary use; and
b. The alternative design will create equal or better visual interest, or will enhance the
image of the City or the neighborhood where it is located as well or better than, a building
design that complied with all applicable standards in Subsections 1, 2, and 3 above; and
c. Any adverse impacts on surrounding properties created by the waiver or adjustment of
standards in Subsections 1, 2, and 3 above have been mitigated to the maximum extent
practicable.
Applicability
General Applicability
Any building, improvement, or use of land approved or erected after January 1, 1992, shall
comply with the requirements of this Section 60.400.080 unless specifically stated
otherwise in this UDC.
Exceptions
The requirements of this Section 60.400.080 do not apply to:
a. The adaptive reuse of a building in any Mixed Use district that does not involve any
expansion of the building’s existing square footage. Any square footage additions
resulting in increased building square footage are subject to the parking requirement of
this Section 60.400.080.
b. A Fast Food Restaurant, Neighborhood Food and Service, Standard Restaurant, Business
or Personal Service, Neighborhood Retail, or Small Retail use containing no more than
2,000 square feet of floor area, occupying a ground floor building space fronting a public
sidewalk, and providing direct pedestrian access from the public sidewalk.
c. Development in the Medical Center Standards District.
Compliance with Other City Ordinances
Residential uses shall comply with the parking requirements in Section 11-10 of the Rochester
Code of Ordinances.
Calculation of Parking and Loading Requirements
Area Measurements
All square footage-based parking and loading requirements shall be computed based on the
gross floor area of the applicable use or structure, as applicable. Parking Garages within a
building containing other primary uses shall not be included in that computation.
Parking and Loading for Multiple Uses
a. Lots containing more than one use shall provide parking and loading in an amount equal
to the total of the requirements for all uses.
b. The total number of spaces may be reduced in accordance with Section 60.400.080F.
Parking and Loading for Unlisted Uses
For uses not expressly listed in Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking
Required, the Community Development Director is authorized to:
a. Apply the minimum vehicle parking requirement in Table 400.08-1 for the listed use that
is deemed most similar to the proposed use (based on operating characteristics, the
most similar related occupancy classification, or other factors determined by the
Community Development Director);
Residential Uses
Household Living
Dwelling, Single-Family
1 per DU 1 per DU
Detached
Dwelling, Twin-Home 1 per DU 1 per DU
Dwelling, Attached 1 per DU 1.5 per DU 1 per DU 1.5 per DU
Dwelling, Duplex, Same Lot 1 per DU 1 per DU
Dwelling, Triplex 1 per DU 1 per DU
Dwelling, Fourplex 1 per DU 1 per DU
Dwelling, Multifamily 1 per 1 BR unit; 1 per
2 BR unit; 1.5 per 3
0.5 per DU 1.5 per DU 0.5 per DU
BR unit; 2 per 4 BR
unit or more
Dwelling, Live/Work 0.75 per DU
Dwelling, Cottage
1 per DU 2 per DU 1 per DU 1.5 per DU
Development
Manufactured Home Park 1 per DU 2 per DU 1 per DU
Group Living
Congregate Housing 1 per 2 beds 1 per bed 1 per 3 beds 1 per 2 beds
Dormitory 1 per 2 beds 1 per 3 beds 1.5 per bed
Medical Stay Dwelling Unit 1 per DU 2 per DU
Nursing Home 1 per 3 beds 1 per 2 beds 1 per 4 beds 1 per 2 beds
Offender Transitional
1 per 3 beds 1 per 4 beds
Housing
Residential Care Facility 1 per 3 beds 1 per 2 beds 1 per 4 beds 1 per 3 beds
Landfill
Quarry
Sand or Gravel Excavation
Accessory Uses and Structures
Animal Husbandry 1 per 700 sq. ft.
Drive-in Facility See Section
60.400.080L.3
Residential Management or 1 per 400 sq. ft. in
Sales Office 1 per 500 sq. ft.
MX-T
Temporary Uses
Carnival or Festival Determine on case- Determine on case-
by-case basis at time by-case basis at time
of temporary use of temporary use
permit permit
Contractor’s Office and Yard 1 per 500 sq. ft. 1 per 700 sq. ft.
Shared Parking
Where two or more uses listed in Table 300.02-1 Allowed Uses Table share a Parking Lot or
Garage, the total off-street parking requirement for those uses shown in Table 400.08-1,
Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking Required, may be reduced by the factors shown in
Table 400.08-2 Shared Parking Reduction below. If only two primary uses of land are sharing
the parking, the total off-street parking required shall be the sum of the two parking
requirements for the two uses divided by the factors for that combination of uses shown in
Table 400.08-2 Shared Parking Reduction. If more than two uses share a parking lot or
structure, the required parking shall be calculated by applying Table 400.08-2 Shared
Parking Reduction below to the two uses with the largest parking requirements and then
adding the required parking as shown in Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle
Parking Required, for the additional uses.
Table 400.08-2 Shared Parking Reduction
Add the requirements in Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking Required, and divide by the factors shown
below.
Food, Beverage,
Public,
Multifamily Indoor Other
Property Use Institutional, or Retail
Dwellings Entertainment, Commercial
Civic
or Lodging
Public, Institutional, or
1.1 1.0
Civic
must provide off-street parking may count the adjacent metered on street spaces as all
or part of the required off-street parking spaces.
b. In a Garage
The number of off-street accessory parking spaces for any non-residential use may be
reduced by 10 percent if the new non-residential use is on a lot that lies within 500 feet
of a publicly owned Parking Garage, as measured from the nearest point on the property
line of the lot where the Parking Garage is located to the nearest point on the property
line of the lot where the non-residential use requiring off-street parking is located.
Transit-Related Reductions
a. Transit Proximity
The number of required off-street parking spaces for residential uses may be reduced by
10 percent if the lot where the new residential development is located is within 660 feet
of a signed bus stop or bus shelter serving a weekday bus route.
b. Transit Improvement
The number of required off-street parking spaces for non-residential uses may be
reduced by ten percent if the new development provides an adequately designed,
sheltered transit stop within the development, in a location that will promote transit use
in the City, as determined by the Public Works Director. This reduction shall not be
awarded for that are detached from the principal structure on the site and located in the
public right-of-way.
Shared Car Reduction
A reduction in the number of required Residential off-street parking spaces may be granted if
a shared or community vehicle is available for use by residents of a new residential
development. Where one or more passenger vehicles are available on-site with an
established procedure for private use by residents, the minimum parking requirement for a
Residential use may be reduced by an additional 20 percent provided there are no more
than 75 residential dwelling units per shared vehicle.
Ground Floor Retail Development Reduction
New mixed use developments that include a ground-floor Retail Sales type use or a Fast
Food Restaurant, Neighborhood Food and Service, or Standard Restaurant use may reduce
their parking requirement by 10 percent. The use must front a public street and have
pedestrian access from the street.
Travel Demand Management Plan
a. Purpose
A Travel Demand Management (TDM) Plan allows flexibility for uses that have widely
varying parking and loading demand characteristics that make it difficult to specify a
single off-street parking or loading standard.
b. Applicability
Applicants may submit a TDM Plan for any new development in any district. The City may
require a TDM Plan for new developments with over 25,000 square feet gross floor area
or as otherwise stated in this Section 60.400.070F.4.c.
c. Standards
The TDM Plan shall estimate parking demand for the proposed use based on the
recommendations of the Institute of Traffic Engineers (ITE), Urban Land Institute, the
International Council of Shopping Centers, the American Planning Association, or other
acceptable sources of parking demand data for uses and/or combinations of uses of
comparable activities, scale, bulk, area, and location.
d. Procedure
The Planning Commission shall review each TDM Plan and may adjust the minimum and
maximum parking standards in Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking
Required, as adjusted by any other provisions of this UDC, based on information
contained in the TDM Plan, subject to the limitation in Subsection 1.b above.
Maximum Parking Adjustments
The provision of parking spaces beyond the maximum specified in Table 400.08-1, Minimum
and Maximum Vehicle Parking Required, may be allowed where public parking is proposed
as a replacement for existing public parking removed as part of a redevelopment plan or
where the City has by agreement secured spaces for public parking in a parking structure
built as part of a new private development.
Uses in existence as of January 1, 1992 having more off-street parking spaces than the
maximum number specified in Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking
Required, are permitted to continue to legally use all available parking spaces and shall not
be considered non-conforming because of the excess number of parking spaces.
Visitor Parking
In all zoning districts except the R-2x, MX-T, and MX-D districts, new developments containing
any combination of Single-Family Detached and Attached and/or Multifamily Dwellings, shall
provide visitor parking in addition to the required off-street parking for each dwelling unit
based on the requirements in Table 400.08-3 Visitor Parking Requirements. Required visitor
parking may be provided on-street, off- street, in any type of permitted shared Parking Lot or
Garage, or in parking bays designed as part of the original development.
All proposed subdivisions shall be reviewed for consistency with these requirements during
the subdivision approval, and all other developments shall be reviewed during Site
Development Plan approval.
Access
a. A Parking Lot or Garage shall be designed to ensure safe and easy ingress, egress, and
movement through the interior of the lot.
b. Vehicular entrance drives shall be located and designed to minimize interference with
pedestrians.
c. Vehicle entrance drives to a Parking Lot or Garage shall not exceed 20 feet of street
frontage.
Location
a. For Single-Family Detached and Same Lot Duplex Dwelling uses in all districts, off-street
parking areas shall be located in a garage or on a driveway. Parking spaces that are
located between the building façade and the front lot line, and that are not located in a
permitted driveway parking area, are prohibited.
b. For all other uses in an Agricultural and Residential and Mixed Use district, off-street
parking areas shall not be located between the front building façade and the adjacent
street frontage.
c. Required off-street parking and loading shall be located on the same lot as the principal
use except that:
1) Up to 25 percent of required parking for a residential use in the MX-I, MX-T, or MX-D
districts may be provided within 500 feet of the site containing the non-residential
use.
2) Up to 50 percent of required off-street parking for any non-residential use in any
district other than the MX-D district may be provided within 600 feet of the site
containing the non-residential use.
3) Parking locations for the MX-D district shall comply with Section 60.400.080J.5,
Location Requirements in the MX-D District.
4) As a condition of approval of off-site parking pursuant to Subsections 1 or 2 above,
the applicant shall provide to the City evidence of the availability of the off-street
parking for the exclusive use of the applicant’s residential or non-residential land
use.
d. To the maximum extent practicable, accessory parking shall be located at the rear of the
principal building with access from an alley or if constructed as part of the principal
building behind the front façade of the principal building.
e. If is not feasible to locate the Parking Lot or Garage to the rear of the principal building,
the parking may be located to one side of the principal building. A Parking Lot or Garage
located to one side of a principal building shall be no more than 60 feet in width (not
including any required landscape buffer areas) measured from the side wall of the
principal building.
f. If the principal building and Parking Lot or Garage is situated on a corner lot, the parking
must be located to allow the principal building to be built to both the front and side-street
property lines. A portion of the Parking Lot or Garage may front along the side-street lot
line when situated behind the rear wall (or parallel extension thereof) of the principal
building on the lot and subject to any other identified design features, setback, buffering,
screening, and landscaping.
g. Notwithstanding any MX-T district requirements, a new or expanded Parking Lot or
Garage shall not abut any of the seven “active/pedestrian streets” shown on the Map
below. A parking Lot or Garage is not considered to be abutting a street frontage if it is
separated from the street property line by a principal building that is at least 15 feet in
depth, one story above the sidewalk grade, and at least as wide as the parking facility on
the lot.
Stormwater Drainage
a. Parking Lots shall be constructed such that all surface water is directed into a landscape
bump out, island, or endcap.
b. For all new Parking Lots containing 12 or more spaces, the following best management
practices shall be used to improve stormwater infiltration and water quality:
1) Permeable pavement materials shall be installed. If such materials are the only
practice employed from this list, then they shall cover at least 25 percent of the
total Parking Lot area;
2) Treatments such as culvert outfalls, bioretention basins, or vegetated swales shall
be installed; or
3) Other combinations of best management practices for stormwater infiltration and
water quality subject to approval by the Community Development Director and
Public Works Director.
c. Water drainage from a Parking Lot shall not flow across a sidewalk.
Lighting
a. The following requirements apply to Parking Lots, Parking Garages, and accessory
parking facilities in the zoning districts and for the uses listed below. All references to
land uses or categories of land uses refer to those shown in Table 300.02-1 Allowed
Uses Table.
1) Multifamily Dwellings in all districts;
2) All Group Living uses except for Residential Care Facilities in structures that would
be exempt from these standards if they were occupied by a Household Living use,
as shown in Table 300.02-1;
3) Public, Institutional, and Civic uses in all districts except the SI district;
4) Commercial and Industrial uses in all districts except the SI district; and
5) Mixed use developments (i.e., those containing a mix of primary residential and
non-residential uses) in all districts except the SI district
b. Any exterior lighting provided for a Parking Lot or Garage shall use full-cutoff luminaires.
If pole mounted, the maximum height of the luminaire shall be 18 feet with a maximum
permitted illumination of one foot-candle at the property line.
c. The light source of the luminaires used for interior lighting in a Parking Lot or Garage
shall be completely shielded from view by persons standing anywhere within the adjacent
street right-of-way.
Electric Vehicle Charging
Parking areas with more than 50 parking spaces shall provide a minimum of one parking
space dedicated to electric vehicles for every 25 parking spaces provided on site. The
provision of three of fewer electric vehicle parking spaces shall not count toward the
maximum allowed number of parking spaces. The provision of four or more electric vehicle
parking spaces shall count toward the maximum allowed number of parking spaces. The
electric vehicle parking space shall be:
a. Located on the same lot as the principal use;
b. Signed in a clear and conspicuous manner indicating exclusive availability to electric
vehicles; and
c. Outfitted with a standard “Level 2” electric vehicle charging station.
Parking Garage Design Requirements
The following additional design standards apply to Parking Garages in all districts.
a. Height and Depth Requirements
In order to allow for possible future conversion to non-parking uses, street facing ground
floor frontages of Parking Garages shall have a minimum height of 12 feet and shall be
designed so that a minimum horizontal distance of 22 feet from each street-facing
façade is not occupied by structural columns or driving aisles required to access parking
spaces.
b. Upper Floor Screening
Street-facing façades above the ground floor of a Parking Garage shall screen vehicles by
partial walls, windows, or other screening devices constructed of similar building
materials as the primary structure and not less than three feet in height so that lower
portions of vehicles are not visible from adjacent public streets.
Pedestrian Walkways
Where a building façade providing customer or patron access is 400 feet in length or greater,
walkways from building entrances or sidewalks adjacent to the building shall be extended
into on-site parking areas at a rate of one per 250 feet of building façade and shall extend
into the parking area a minimum of one-third of the depth of the parking lot area.
Parking Lot Landscaping
Standards on Parking Lot landscaping can be found in Section 60.400.060, Landscaping,
Bufferyards, and Fences.
Use of Vehicle Parking
Off-street parking shall be improved and available for use at the time of final building
inspection when a use or structure is first occupied, enlarged, or increased in capacity. When
a change in use is proposed, the Community Development Director shall review the site
layout in relation to the new use to ensure adequate off-street parking is available.
Off-street parking shall be permitted only in areas designed and maintained for such use
consistent with the requirements of this Section 60.400.070F.4.c.
Areas designated for off-street parking shall not be used for the open storage of goods or the
commercial repair of vehicles.
Automotive vehicles or trailers without current legal license plates or that are inoperable
shall not be stored or parked in any Parking Lot in any Agricultural or Residential District
unless in a completely enclosed building.
Automotive vehicles or trailers without current legal license plates or that are inoperable
shall not be stored or parked on any public right-of-way in any Agricultural or Residential
District.
Excess, existing accessory off-street parking spaces no longer needed to comply with this
Section 60.400.070F.4.c, may not be converted to a commercial parking facility with more
than four parking spaces, unless the conversion is approved as an interim use in accordance
with Section 60.500.040M, Interim Use Permit.
Loading and Stacking Areas
Number and Size of Loading Berths Required
a. Loading births shall meet the requirements of Table 400.08-6 Required Off-Street
Loading Berths.
b. The minimum turning radius for truck traffic areas to access a loading berth shall be 40
feet.
c. A minimum stacking distance of 40 feet shall be provided at all ingress/egress access
drives intersecting with a street.
d. Variations from these standards may be approved by the Community Development
Director based on information provided by the applicant demonstrating that the vehicle
loading operations of the proposed use differ from the standards in Table 400.08-6
Required Off-Street Loading Berths or from those otherwise required by this Section
60.400.070F.4.c.
c. Loading berths and access routes to loading berths shall not interfere with Parking Lot or
Parking Garage maneuvering areas or with designated on-site patron drop-off/pick-up
locations.
d. State and City streets or rights-of-way shall not be used for loading and unloading
purposes without prior City approval of a revocable permit.
Vehicle Stacking Areas
a. All uses with an entry gate, guard house, or drive-through shall provide the minimum
number of on-site stacking spaces indicated in Table 400.08-7 Minimum Vehicle
Stacking Space Required.
Table 400.08-7 Minimum Vehicle Stacking Space Required
Use MX-T and MX-D Districts All Other Areas
b. Developments over five acres in size, new or expanded developments in the MX-D and
MX-T districts, or Site Development Plans for individual buildings containing more than
80,000 square feet of gross floor area shall provide bicycle parking at a rate of one
bicycle space per 10 vehicle spaces required for the proposed land use(s) as shown in
Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking Required, for the first 50
vehicle spaces, and then at a rate of one per 20 vehicle spaces thereafter. A minimum of
10 bicycle parking spaces are required, and no reductions are permitted based on any
approval granted through Section 60.400.080F, Minimum Parking Adjustments.
c. When Subsections a or b require the provision of more than 20 bicycle parking
spaces, at least 10 percent of the required bicycle parking spaces shall be
long-term spaces. A long-term space is one that is located inside the primary
structure containing the primary use for which the parking is provided, in an
area of that building that is secured or generally accessible to tenants and
occupants of the building and not to the general public, or is located outside
that structure but in an enclosed container or structure protected from the
weather in which the bicycle may be locked by the owner of the bicycle.
Bicycle Parking Location, Design, and Circulation
a. Bicycle parking shall be located within 100 feet of a primary building entrance along a
walkway adjacent to the building or within an abutting parking area where connected to a
primary building entrance via a walkway.
b. Bicycle parking facilities shall be designed to allow the bicycle frame and both wheels to
be securely locked to the parking structure. The structure shall be of permanent
construction such as heavy gauge tubular steel with angle bars permanently attached to
the pavement.
c. Bicycle parking areas shall be sized and designed so that locked bicycles do not
encroach over sidewalks, walkways, required open space, required landscape areas,
required usable recreation areas, private streets, or public rights-of-way.
EXTERIOR STORAGE
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.400.090 is to regulate the visual effect that uncontrolled storage
of trash, merchandise, materials, or equipment can have when viewed from adjacent properties
or adjacent public rights-of-way.
Requirements in Agricultural and Residential Districts
The following requirements apply to all Agricultural and Residential districts.
All waste, debris, or garbage shall be kept in an enclosed building or closed container
designed for such purpose.
All materials, machinery, and equipment shall be stored within a building or be fully screened
so as not to be visible from adjoining properties, except for the following when kept in good
order:
a. Laundry drying;
b. Recreational equipment;
c. Construction and landscaping materials and equipment currently being used on the
premises;
d. Agricultural materials and equipment, if intended for use on the property;
e. Off-street parking of passenger vehicles and pickup trucks; and
f. The storage of firewood.
Requirements in Mixed Use and Non-Residential Districts
The following requirements apply to all Mixed Use and Non-Residential districts.
Trash storage shall be enclosed within a structure, or an adequate outside area shall be set
aside for trash storage and shown on the Site Development Plan.
For non-residential uses in the MX-N zoning district trash, shall be stored within an enclosed
building.
All outdoor storage or containers shall be placed on a hard surface such as concrete and
shall be aesthetically screened by a permanent fence, wall, or landscaping from adjacent
properties and rights-of-way.
Outdoor storage of items for sale are exempt from screening requirements, provided they do
not face a Residential district or Residential use. This includes but is not limited to; firewood,
lawn care products, propane, road salt, and sand.
EXTERIOR LIGHTING
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.400.100 is to protect and promote the public health, safety, and
welfare by permitting reasonable uses of exterior lighting. The standards are further intended to:
Reduce excessive and unnecessary use of lighting;
Minimize light pollution, glare, and light trespass;
Maintain nighttime safety, security, and enjoyment of property;
Curtail the degradation of nighttime visual environment; and
Minimize disturbance to sensitive plants and animals.
Applicability
General Applicability
All uses in all districts shall meet the requirements of this Section 60.400.100 unless
specifically stated otherwise in this UDC.
Exceptions
The requirements of this Section 60.400.100 do not apply to ball diamonds, playing fields,
and tennis courts. Lighting for these uses shall be shielded to prevent light and glare from
spilling over onto adjacent residential properties. The maximum permitted illumination at the
property line shall not exceed one foot candle if the abutting property is located in a
Residential district, and shall not exceed two foot candles if the abutting property is located
in a Mixed Use or Non-Residential district.
Lighting for Parking Lots and Garages
Parking Lots and Garages shall comply with applicable standards in Section 60.400.080J.7,
Lighting.
Method of Measurement
Lighting levels shall be measured in foot candles with a meter sensor mounted not more than six
inches above ground level in a horizontal position at the property line. Readings shall be taken
only after the cell has been exposed long enough to provide a constant reading. Measurements
shall be made after dark with the light sources in question on, then with the same sources off.
The difference between the two readings shall be compared to the maximum permitted
illumination specified in this Section 60.400.100 for the type of luminaire used.
General Requirements
Prohibited Lights
a. Laser, strobe, flickering, or flashing lights is prohibited.
b. Tower lighting is not unless required by the Federal Aviation Administration.
c. Neon lighting and exposed strip lighting used to illuminate building facades, or used to
outline or detail buildings, windows, or doors, or used to illuminate, outline, or detail
service canopies is prohibited in or adjacent to any Residential district.
d. When neon lighting or exposed strip lighting is used for any purpose, it must not be
combined with or mounted near any reflective materials such as mirrors, shiny metals,
highly glazed tiles, or other materials that would result in reflective glare.
Intensity
a. The total light output must not exceed 50,000 lumens per acre as measured at the light
source.
b. The maximum intensity per light pole must not exceed 5,000 lumens as measured at the
light source.
c. The maximum illumination at any one location on the property must not exceed 15 foot
candles.
Location
Light sources or luminaires shall not be located within bufferyards except along Walkways,
Sidewalks, Bikeways, or Multi-Use Trails.
Internal Lighting
a. All internal luminaires that illuminate a window area that is viewable at the property line
must be designed so that the light bulb, lamp, or light source is completely shielded from
direct view of an observer standing at the property line measured at a point five feet
above grade.
b. Illumination for windows shall not exceed 2,000 lumens.
c. On each property with a primary non-residential use, all internal luminaires that are
viewable at the property line with a light intensity greater than 1,000 lumens, must be
designed so that the light bulb, lamp, or light source is completely shielded from the
direct view of an observer standing at the property line measured at a point five feet
above grade.
Hours of Operation
Exterior lighting shall observe the same hours of operation as the use itself as stated in
Section 60.300.030, Use-Specific Standards, except that a minimum level of lighting for
security purposes may be left on beyond the normal hours of operation.
Pedestrian-Oriented Lighting
On-site or building-mounted pedestrian-oriented lighting providing at least four-foot candles
at ground level with lighting level uniformity, average to minimum, shall be 2:1 or better.
Visibility Triangle
In any district that requires a front or side street building setback, there shall be no sight-
obscuring or partly obscuring lighting between three and six feet above curb grade in any
Visibility Triangle. Vertical measurement shall be made from the top of the curb on the street
adjacent to the nearest street of the triangle or, if no curb exists, from the edge of the
nearest traveled way.
Luminaire Mounting
All wall, canopy, and pole-mounted luminaires must be installed at parallel to the ground (90
degrees from vertical).
Maximum Permitted Illumination and Height
Exterior lighting shall meet the requirements of Table 400.10-1 Maximum Permitted
Illumination and Height.
For all luminaires, the maximum luminous intensity (in candelas) at or above any angle of 90
degrees above vertical is zero, and the maximum luminous intensity (in candelas) at or above
a vertical angle of 80 degrees above vertical must not exceed 10 percent of the luminous
flux of the lamp or lamps in the luminaire.
SIGNS
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.400.110 is to promote the public health, safety, and welfare of
the City by establishing comprehensive standards, regulations, and procedures governing the
erection, use, and display of devices serving as visual communications media. These standards
are further intended to:
Promote and preserve aesthetics and to allow citizens to enjoy the natural scenic beauty of
the City;
Minimize distractions and obstructions for drivers, bicyclists, and pedestrians;
Preserve property values and the neighborhood character within the City;
Balance the needs for signs and the impacts of signs by establishing minimum standards
related to the use, location, and intensity of zoning districts and land uses; and
Comply with all applicable laws, statutes, regulations, and state and federal court decisions
regarding free speech in the context of regulation of signs, and not to engage in any form of
content-based regulation of sign messages prohibited by state or federal constitutions,
statutes, or applicable court decisions.
Applicability
This Section 60.400.110 shall govern all signs located in the City to the extent that they are
not preempted by the requirements set forth in the Minnesota Outdoor Advertising Control
Act, Minn. Stat. 173.01 et. Seq. and the Federal Highway Beautification Act, 23 U.S.C. 131
et. Seq. governing the control and regulation of signs along state and federal highways or
exempted by Section 60.400.110C.
Required sign permits shall be approved pursuant to Section 60.500.060L, Sign Permit.
In the event of a conflict between the standards in this Section 60.400.110 and the
standards in the Destination Medical Center Design Guidelines, the Design Guidelines apply.
Signs Not Requiring a Permit
The following types of signs are exempt from the Sign Permit process.
Any sign erected, maintained, required, or posted by the City, state, or federal government
when erected and maintained pursuant to law or in the public interest, as determined by that
governmental entity.
Any sign inside a building not attached to a window or door that is not legible from a distance
of more than three feet beyond the lot line of where the sign is located.
Murals and up to two Banner signs that are in compliance with applicable standards in
Section 60.400.110H and Section 60.400.110I.
Any non-lighted sign not exceeding three feet in height and not exceeding three square feet
in area that is oriented, located, and designed to be viewed by occupants or users of the
property while on the property, and not to be generally legible from abutting streets or
properties.
One non-lighted sign at each entrance to, and one non-lighted sign at each exit from, any lot
containing the drive-through lane of an allowed Drive-in Facility in any Mixed Use district,
provided the sign does not exceed three feet in height and does not exceed three square feet
in area.
Signs located on allowed primary or accessory athletic fields designed and used for
competitive sports, that are oriented, located, and designed for viewing by participants in and
spectators of those competitive sports, and that do not have any lighted surface facing and
located within 200 feet of any residential primary use in a Residential district.
Any sign affixed to an athletic facility structure (excluding fencing) in the MX-I district that
does not exceed 2,400 square feet in area and does not result in more than 10,000 square
feet in total sign area of all such signs per use.
Sound trucks or other moving advertising media while operated on a public right-of-way.
Signs under 12 inches in height to enable emergency personnel to accurately identify
structures or locations.
Any temporary sign in compliance with Minn. Stat. Ch. 211B.045.
Any temporary sign erected during any period a property or a portion of a property is actively
listed for sale or lease and that does not exceed 24 square feet in area or four feet in height.
One temporary sign, located at a construction site or on a construction barricade, beginning
on the date a building permit is issued and ending on the date on which the last initial
certificate of occupancy related to that building permit is granted.
a. In Residential districts that contain Household Living uses other than Multifamily
Dwellings, the sign shall not exceed 16 square feet in area and shall not exceed four feet
above grade.
b. In Residential districts for all uses other than those subject to Subsection a above, the
sign shall not exceed 36 square feet in area and shall not exceed six feet above grade.
c. In Mixed Use and Non-Residential districts, this sign shall not exceed 64 square feet in
area and shall not exceed 10 feet above grade.
Signs Requiring a Permit
All signs erected, altered, or replaced within the City that are not listed in Section
60.400.110C require a Sign Permit pursuant to Section 60.500.060L.
Any lighted sign requires a Sign Permit pursuant to Section 60.500.060L.
A new permit consistent with the standards in this Section 60.400.110D is required each
time:
a. A new primary building is constructed;
b. The gross floor area of an existing primary building is expanded by more than 50 percent;
c. An existing primary building is improved or redeveloped, and the value of that work
exceeds 50% of the value of the existing primary building, as shown in applicable
property tax records;
d. A new primary use of a property is begun;
e. The existing primary use of a property is changed from one category of uses to another
(for example, from an Entertainment and Recreation use to a Retail Sales use) as shown
in Table 300.02-1 Allowed Uses Table.
Prohibited Signs
The following types of signs are prohibited.
Billboards that contain stacked multiple display faces.
Flashing, moving, or intermittently lighted signs in:
a. Any Agricultural and Residential district;
b. The MX-D Medical subdistrict; and
c. Any Mixed Use or Non-Residential lot abutting or directly across from an Agricultural and
Residential district.
Any sign that is constructed to resemble an official marker erected by the City, state, or any
governmental agency or that by reason of positioning, shape, or color would conflict with the
proper functioning of any traffic sign or signal or would impair or cause confusion of vehicular
or pedestrian traffic.
Any sign that contains any obscene wording or images.
Sign Standards
The following standards apply to all signs, including billboards. In the event of a conflict between
these standards and those in Section 60.400.110G Billboards, the billboard standards apply..
Design and Safety Requirements
a. No sign shall be placed so as to obstruct or interfere with a window, doorway, or fire
escape.
b. Signs shall not extend into the vertical space between three feet and six feet above curb
grade within any Visibility Triangle. Vertical measurement shall be made from the top of
the curb on the street adjacent to the nearest street of the triangle or, if no curb exists,
from the edge of the nearest traveled way.
c. No sign that is permitted to extend over a public right-of-way may have a lower edge less
than nine feet above the grade level of the right-of-way.
d. All permanent signs shall be constructed to meet Building Code standards for wind
resistance and wind loads. Signs shall be rigidly suspended by means of fastening or
support so as not to be free swinging nor a menace to persons or property.
e. Signs illuminated by electricity or equipped in any way with electrical devices shall
conform to the provisions of the electrical code.
f. Adequate provisions shall be made for grounding metallic parts of roof signs exposed to
lightning.
g. The exposed uprights, superstructure, and/or backside of all signs shall be painted a
neutral color such as light blue, gray, or white unless it can be demonstrated that such
part of the sign designed or painted in another manner is integral to the overall design of
the sign.
h. No signs shall be painted on, attached to, or affixed to any trees, rocks, or similar organic
or inorganic natural matter, or on any power line or telephone pole.
i. No signs except those of a governmental entity shall be erected or allowed to extend over
a public right-of-way, except that in the MX-D Medical subdistrict, such signs are
permitted if a revocable permit from the City is obtained prior to issuance of a sign
permit.
j. Each sign shall be set back from each lot line by at least two feet. Billboards shall also
comply with Section 60.400.110G.
Lighting of Signs
a. Internal lighting, back lighting, and spot lighting are permitted to illuminate signs as
stated in Table 400.11-1 General Sign Standards.
b. Each light source for internal lighting, back lighting, or spot lighting of a sign shall be
shielded so that the source is not visible from any Agricultural and Residential district,
any Residential Use in a Mixed Use district, and from any public right-of-way.
c. Lighted signs adjacent to Residential districts and located within a zone that restricts
hours of operation may only be lit during business hours.
Table of Sign Standards
Table 400.11-1 General Sign Standards, states the general sign standards for all signs in all
districts, unless stated otherwise in this Section 60.400.110.
Table 400.11-1 General Sign Standards
I = Internal B = Backlight S = Spotlight
Projecting Sign
Maximum 1 1 1 1
Number
Maximum Area 8 sq. ft. 12 sq. ft. 16 sq. ft. 24 sq. ft.
Not Permitted
Maximum Height 12 feet 12 feet 16 feet 18 feet
Permitted Lighting I, B I, B I, B I, B
Permitted Lighting S, I, B S, I, B
b. In addition, one freestanding sign per entrance of the business center is permitted. Each
additional freestanding sign above the first is permitted at no more than 50 percent of
the maximum freestanding sign area permitted for the property.
Marquees or Sun Canopies
a. No sign affixed to or an integral part of a marquee shall be less than eight feet above any
sidewalk level or its equivalent in the absence of a sidewalk. Marquees shall be
permitted an area up to double that permitted for freestanding signs, provided that the
increase in area above that allowed for freestanding signs is matched by a reduction in
the area of other permitted primary signs.
b. The sun canopy area shall count against the permitted wall sign area, but the sun canopy
shall not count against the permitted number of primary signs.
c. Lighting is prohibited on marquee signs or sun canopy signs on secondary facades when
the secondary façade is adjacent to and facing a Residential district.
Service Canopies
a. Where a service canopy is permitted to protect outdoor customers from weather
conditions, up to 50 percent of the vertical canopy façade area may be used for signage,
and the permitted canopy signage shall be in addition to other sign allowances on the
property.
b. Lighted signs on any service canopy façade adjacent to and facing a Residential district
are prohibited.
c. Electronic message boards on service canopies are prohibited.
Electronic Message Boards
a. Only freestanding signs and wall signs in Mixed Use and Non-Residential districts may
include an electronic message board.
b. Electronic message boards are prohibited in Agricultural, Residential, MX-N, and MX-S
districts.
c. Electronic message boards are prohibited on any Mixed Use or Non-Residential lots
adjacent to and facing an Agricultural or Residential district.
d. Each permitted electronic message board shall be integrated into the overall sign face.
e. The area of the electronic message board signage shall not exceed 50 percent of the
total sign area of the wall or freestanding sign face where it is integrated, or 32 square
feet, whichever is less.
f. The top of any permitted electronic message board must not exceed 12 feet above
grade.
g. The electronic message display shall be programmed so it contains only static images,
does not change more frequently than once every eight seconds, and transitions
between images instantaneously or through dissolve or fade transitions, and without
scrolling, flashing, fading, blinking, or other similar transitions. If dissolve or fade
transitions are used, the time between messages shall not exceed one second of time.
The electronic message board content may not move or create the appearance of
movement, through varying light intensity or otherwise, on any part of board.
h. Each electronic message board shall be provided with automatic dimming software or
solar sensors to control brightness for nighttime viewing and varying daytime lighting
conditions.
i. No electronic message board may be illuminated at a level greater than 5,000 nits
during daylight hours, or at a level greater than 500 nits during nighttime hours.
j. In districts or when associated with allowed uses that have restricted hours of operation,
electronic message boards may operate only during permitted business hours.
Billboards
Spacing
All billboards erected after December 22, 1992, shall comply with the following spacing
standards:
a. No billboard shall be located within 1,000 feet of another billboard located on the same
side of the street. Distances between billboards shall be measured along the adjacent
right-of-way line of the street or highway where the billboard is directed as shown in
Figure 1a.
b. No billboard shall be located within a 100 foot radius from the intersection of the rights-
of-way of two or more streets or highways as shown in Figure 1b.
c. No billboard shall be located within 200 feet of the intersection of a street and a railroad
right-of-way. The distance shall be measured from the center point of the street-railroad
intersection to the nearest edge of the billboard as shown in Figure 1c.
d. No billboard shall be located within 300 feet of a Place of Worship, School, or Medical
Facility. This distance shall be measured from the nearest edge of the billboard to the
Place of Worship, School, or Medical Facility to the closest point on any boundary line of
the Place of Worship, School, or Medical Facility property as shown in Figure 1d. This
restriction only applies to Place of Worship, School, or Medical Facility properties that
abut the same right-of-way where a billboard is oriented, regardless of whether the
billboard is located on the same side or the opposite side of the right-of-way as the Place
of Worship, School, or Medical Facility.
e. No billboard shall be located within 250 feet of a boundary of an Agricultural and
Residential district. This distance shall be measured from the nearest edge of the right-
of-way to the closest point on any boundary of the Residential district as shown in Figure
1e.
f. No billboard shall be located within 300 feet of and oriented toward the following
portions of the following streets and highways within the City:
1) County State Aid Highway 22 from trunk Highway 52 at Apache Mall westerly and
northerly to Trunk Highway 52 at 55th Street NW,
2) County State Aid Highway 22 from Trunk Highway 14 at the University Center
northerly and westerly to Trunk Highway 63 at 37th Street NW; and
3) 55th Street NW from Trunk Highway 52 easterly to County Road 133 (West River
Road).
Figure 1a
Figure 1b Figure 1c
Figure 1e
Figure 1d
Temporary Signs
Banners
a. Each banner shall be installed or maintained parallel to a building façade or other
vertical building surface.
b. Each banner shall be mounted not more than 18 inches from the wall surface where it is
attached.
c. Banners in Agricultural and Residential districts shall be subject to the following
limitations.
1) For non-residential uses, no more than one banner shall be permitted per use or
per tenant. No banners are permitted on any wall abutting a residential use
containing less than four dwelling units, or adjacent to an AG, R-1, R-2, or R-2x
district.
2) For residential structures with four or more dwelling units, one banner per primary
structure shall be permitted, provided the banner is oriented toward an abutting
primary collector or higher order street or is adjacent to any district other than the
AG, R-1, R-2, and R-2x districts.
3) No banners are permitted on any wall abutting a residential use containing fewer
than four dwelling units or adjacent to a R-1, R-2, or R-2x district.
4) In all other circumstances, banners are prohibited in Residential districts.
Portable Signs
Freestanding portable signs are permitted in the MX-G, MX-D, LI, and SI districts after
approval of a sign permit pursuant to Section 60.500.060.H, and shall comply with the
following standards:
a. No sign shall exceed 24 square feet in area or four feet in height.
b. No sign shall be allowed for a period exceeding 14 days in any 12 month period. Each
sign shall be removed within two days after the completion of the event that it relates.
Once the sign permit expires, no additional permits for such signs shall be issued for the
property during the 12 month period.
c. Each sign shall meet all other applicable criteria listed in this Section 60.400.110.
Murals and Other Displays
Applicability
a. Except as stated in Subsection b below, this Section 60.400.110I applies to all displays
on walls, or structures that:
1) Are not types of signs listed in Section 60.400.110C or Section 60.400.110E ; and
2) Exceed the permitted height, size, duration, or another applicable physical standard
in this Section 60.400.110.
b. This Section 60.400.110I does not apply to any City-sponsored signs, wall graphics, or
displays that are located:
1) On City property; or
2) On public utility boxes, meters, or panels where such placement is allowed by a
written contract between the City and any utility provider.
Special Review Required
a. Applications for approval of a mural or other display under this Section 60.400.110I shall
be reviewed by the Community Development Director pursuant to the review criteria in
Subsection 3 below.
b. A decision on the application shall be made within 45 days after the City’s receipt of a
complete application. Any appeal of the decision shall be heard and resolved as set forth
in Section 60.500.030F.2, Appeals.
c. An approved application expands the number, size, and duration of signs otherwise
permitted on the lot or development site. Any approval of a special display shall not
affect the ability of the applicant to erect or maintain any other signs on the property
permitted by this Section 60.400.110, and the approved display shall not be included in
calculations to determine the total sign area or number of authorized signs.
d. An approved application runs with the property unless otherwise specified by the
Community Development Director in the record of approval, and all conditions and
limitations related to the approval shall be binding on future owners and users of the
property.
Review Criteria
The Community Development Director may approve an application for a mural or other
display if it finds that the proposed mural or display:
1) Is a form of speech or expression protected by the First Amendment to the U.S.
Constitution and/or the Minnesota Constitution;
2) Will be created, constructed, erected, or displayed in a way that is visually distinct
from other permitted signs on the property;
3) Does not exceed the dimensions of any surface upon which it is mounted;
4) Will be of interest to the general public or that part of the public to whom it is
visible;
5) If located on public property, will activate or enhance a public space or streetscape;
6) Will be treated to address vandalism and exposure to expected weather conditions;
7) Will not require extensive or repeated maintenance, unless the applicant has
provided adequate assurance (including financial assurance) that maintenance
and repairs will be timely performed;
8) Does not create a threat to public health or safety or to vehicular, bicycle, or
pedestrian traffic safety;
9) Does not create noise, sound, light, reflection, glare, shading, flickering, vibration,
or odor impacts on nearby properties; and
10) Does not impair the performance of required City functions on or around the
property.
Message Substitution
Any sign permitted pursuant to this Section 60.400.110 that contains a commercial
message may be revised to contain a non-commercial message at any time, without the
need to obtain a Sign Permit.
Any sign permitted pursuant to this Section 60.400.110 that contains a non-commercial
message may be revised to instead contain a commercial message at any time, without the
need to obtain a Sign Permit.
Changes in the message on a permitted sign shall not be considered alteration of the sign,
as that term is used in this Section 60.400.110.
Sign Measurements
Area of a Sign
a. Sign area is calculated as the area within a continuous perimeter with up to eight straight
sides that encloses the limits of text and graphics of a sign, together with any frame or
other material or color forming an integral part of the display or used to differentiate the
sign’s message from the background against which it is placed. The area excludes the
structure upon which the sign is placed (unless the structure is an integral part of the
display or used to differentiate it), but includes any open space contained within the
outer limits of the display face of a sign, or between any component, panel, strip, or
figure of any kind composing the display face, whether this open space is enclosed by a
frame or border or not.
b. Support structures will not be counted against total sign area as long as such elements
are appropriately scaled to the size of the copy as determined by the Community
Development Director.
Measuring the Height of a Sign
a. Sign height is measured as the vertical distance from the average elevation of the finish
grade within a six-foot radius at the base of the sign to the top of the sign, including all
backgrounds and support structures, exclusive of any filling, berming, mounding, or
landscaping, solely done for the purpose of locating the sign.
b. If natural grade at the base of a sign is lower than the grade of an adjacent road, the
height of the sign may be measured from the top of curb elevation.
c. For purposes of measuring the size of a billboard sign, only one side of a sign with two
back-to-back parallel sign surfaces shall be the area of one of those surfaces.
INCENTIVES
Purpose
This Section 60.400.120 establishes incentives to encourage public benefits in exchange for
increased development density, size, or flexibility. These public benefits include the development
of affordable housing for low-income households, infrastructure improvements, sustainable
development practices, added public amenities, and heritage preservation. Incentives are only
available for actions in each of these areas that are not otherwise required by this UDC, the
Rochester Code of Ordinances, other City regulations, or state and federal law. These incentives
are designed to further enhance the public health, safety, and welfare of the community.
Combination of Bonuses
More than one bonus in Table 400.12-1 Summary of Incentives may be earned on a single
property or development, but no combination of bonuses in Table 400.12-1 may result in the:
Maximum FAR on any lot or development site being increased by more than 25 percent
above the maximum FAR that would otherwise apply under this UDC; or
Maximum gross floor area on any lot or development site being increased by more than 25
percent above the maximum gross floor area that would otherwise apply under this UDC; or
Number of dwelling units on any lot or development site being increased by more than 25
percent above the maximum number of dwelling units that could be located on that lot or
development site under this UDC.
Incentive Requirements
Incentives listed in Table 400.12-1 Summary of Incentives shall only be available to applicants
that comply with all requirements for that bonus listed in this Section 60.400.120E.
Housing for Low Income Households
In order to earn the incentive identified in Table 400.12-1 Summary of Incentives, the
affordable housing units shall meet one of the following three requirements, as determined
by the Community Development Director.
a. The units are restricted for occupancy for individuals whose income is 60 percent or less
of the area median gross income for rental properties and less than 110 percent of the
area median gross income for owner occupied properties for at least 30 years; and
b. The project has been awarded Low Income Housing Tax.
Additional Infrastructure
In order to earn the incentive identified in Table 400.12-1 Summary of Incentives, the
additional infrastructure provided shall meet one of the following three requirements.
a. Stormwater Management
The City Engineer shall determine the sufficiency of the proposed improvements based
on the following criteria.
1) For projects with a disturbance area of less than one acre, the applicant provides
on-site water treatment for 100 percent of the water quality volume, regardless of
the proposed disturbance area. This incentivizes on-site treatment of the water
quality volume, as defined by the latest MS4 Permit.
2) For projects with a disturbance area of one acre or more, the applicant provides on-
site water reduction of 100 percent of the water quality volume, as defined by the
latest MS4 permit. This incentivizes on-site stormwater reduction on a project that
would otherwise have non-volume-reducing treatment options available such as
filtration, detention, or constructing an off-site treatment.
b. Street Improvements
1) Eligible improvements include but are not limited to the construction or payment for
mobility improvements such as vehicle travel lanes, sidewalks, bikeways, or multi-
use trails.
2) The street improvements are constructed, dedicated, and paid for by the applicant
and provide additional benefits for the residents or occupants of the proposed
development.
3) The street improvements are in a location where the proposed street improvements
are needed by the City, of and a type and design that are needed by the City,
comply with applicable City construction standards, and are not required to be
provided by the applicant to mitigate potential impacts of the proposed
development by this UDC or other adopted City regulations, all as determined by
the City Engineer.
c. Utility Lines
1) Eligible improvements include but are not limited to the provision of a new link or
connection to complete or improve the efficiency of an existing water, storm
drainage, and/or electric line, the replacement of an existing water, storm drainage,
and/or electric line to improve existing service, converting overhead electric lines to
underground lines where that is not otherwise required, installing in-building
transformer vaults in the MX-D district, and installing oversized water mains in
residential developments.
2) The water, storm drainage, and/or electric lines are constructed, dedicated, and
paid for by the applicant and provide additional benefits for the residents or
occupants of the proposed development.
3) The water, storm drainage, and/or electric lines are in a location where the
proposed lines are needed by the City, and of a type and design that are needed by
the City, comply with applicable City construction standards, and are not required to
be provided by the applicant to mitigate potential impacts of the proposed
shall not be deemed to be odorous unless a chemist demonstrates that a discernible odor is
being emitted.
Uses that are required by state or federal regulations to obtain state or federal level air
quality permits are prohibited in any district other than the LI or SI districts except where
authorized as part of a Distinctive Development.
Heat
Where federal and state regulations are not applicable, no continuous or repetitive discharge or
emission of heat shall be allowed if it increases the ambient air or water temperature by one or
more degree centigrade beyond the lot line.
Fire and Explosion Hazards
All activities involving, and all storage of, flammable and explosive materials shall be provided
with adequate safety devices against the hazard of fire and explosion and with adequate
firefighting and fire suppression equipment and devices standard in the industry. Burning of
waste materials in open fires is prohibited.
Glare
In the LI and SI districts, no direct or sky reflected glare, whether from flood lights or from
high temperature processes, such as combustion or welding, shall cause illumination in
excess of 0.5 foot candles at the point of measurement.
In all other districts, no operation or activity shall be conducted so that any glare, whether
direct or reflected, is visible at the point of measurement.
Smoke
Measurement of smoke shall be at the point of emission.
The Ringleman Smoke Chart published by the United States Bureau of Mines shall be used
for the measurement of smoke. Table 400.13-1 Maximum Smoke Levels indicates for the
various zoning districts the acceptable level of smoke emissions. These provisions,
applicable to visible gray smoke, shall also apply to visible smoke of a different color but with
an equivalent apparent opacity.
Particulates
No solid or liquid particles shall be emitted at any point in concentrations to exceed 0.1
grains per cubic feet of conveying gas in any residential district and 0.3 grains per cubic feet
of conveying gas in any other district. For measurement of the amount of particles in gases
resulting from combustion, standard corrections shall be applied to a stack temperature of
500 degrees Fahrenheit and 50 percent excess air.
In addition to complying with those standards in Subsection 1, all uses shall comply with all
applicable state and federal standards regarding particulate emissions, and in case of
conflict the standards in Subsection 1, and applicable state or federal standards, the stricter
standard shall apply unless the state or federal standards require a different result.
Vibration
Vibration refers to ground transmitted oscillations. For the purposes of identifying and
measuring different types of vibration:
a. Amplitude shall mean the maximum displacement of the surface of the earth from its
normal resting position. Amplitude is generally measured in inches or mils.
b. Discrete Impulses shall mean a ground transmitted vibration stemming from a source
where specific impulses do not exceed 60 per minute or one per second.
c. Frequency shall mean the number of times that a displacement completely repeats itself
in one second of time. Frequency shall be expressed in cycles per second (cps) or hertz
(Hz).
d. Impact shall mean an earthborn vibration generally produced by two or more objects
striking each other so as to cause separate and distinct pulses.
Ground transmitted vibration shall be measured using a seismograph or complement of
instruments capable of recording vibration displacement and frequency, particle velocity, or
acceleration simultaneously in three mutually perpendicular directions.
Vibration shall not exceed the levels in Table 400.13-2 Vibration Levels.
The maximum particle velocity shall be the maximum vector sum of three mutually
perpendicular components recorded simultaneously. Particle velocity may also be expressed
as 6.28 times the displacement in inches multiplied by frequency in cycles per second.
Steady state vibrations are ones that are continuous or in discrete impulses of more than 60
per minute. Discrete impulses that do not exceed 60 per minute shall be considered impact
vibrations. Impact vibrations are limited to values that are no greater than twice those
specified above.
Noise
All activities shall comply with the Rochester Code of Ordinances Section 8-7-8 regarding
permissible levels of noise and shall be conducted so as to avoid the creation of any noise
that would create a public nuisance interfering with the use and enjoyment of adjacent
properties.
Any amplified sound equipment shall be mounted so as to direct sound inward from property
boundaries, rather than outward towards property boundaries.
Amplified sounds at a level higher than 65 decibels (the level of normal conversation) shall
not be allowed to cross lot lines unless an approval has been issued for that purpose.
Public Pre-
Review and Decision-Making Bodies
Notice Submittal
Development Director
Heritage Preservation
Information Meeting
Pre-Development
Zoning Board of
Neighborhood
Commission
Commission
City Council
Community
Published
Planning
Meeting
Appeals
Posted
Mailed
Public Pre-
Review and Decision-Making Bodies
Notice Submittal
Development Director
Heritage Preservation
Information Meeting
Pre-Development
Procedure UDC Section
Zoning Board of
Neighborhood
Commission
Commission
City Council
Community
Published
Planning
Meeting
Appeals
Posted
Mailed
Final Plat Section
Y R [D]
60.500.040H
Official Street Map Adoption Section
Y R R [D]
60.500.040I
Section
Public Street Vacation Y R R [D]
60.500.040J
Distinctive Section
Development Y Y Y Y Y R [R] [D]
60.500.040K
Conditional Use Permit Section
Approved by City Council Y Y Y Y Y R R [D]
60.500.040L
Interim Use Permit Section
Y Y Y Y Y R R [D]
60.500.040M
Decisions That May Require a Hearing by an Appointed Body
Conditional Use Permit
Section
Approved by Planning Y Y Y Y Y R [D] [A]
60.500.050A
Commission
Certificate of
Section
Appropriateness – Major R [D][3] [A]
60.500.050B
Alterations
Shoreland Protection Permit Section
R [D] [A]
60.500.050C
Public Pre-
Review and Decision-Making Bodies
Notice Submittal
Development Director
Heritage Preservation
Information Meeting
Pre-Development
Procedure UDC Section
Zoning Board of
Neighborhood
Commission
Commission
City Council
Community
Published
Planning
Meeting
Appeals
Posted
Mailed
Rental Housing Certificate Section
D [A]
60.500.060E
Temporary Use Permit Section
D [A]
60.500.060F
Minor Land Subdivision Section
Permit Y D [A]
60.500.060G
Floodplain Development Section
Permit [5] [A]
60.500.060H
Grading Permit Section
60.500.060H.4. [5] A
f
Lot Line Readjustment Section
D [A]
60.500.060J
Easement Vacation Section
[5] [A]
60.500.060K
Sign Permit Section
D [A]
60.500.060L
Public Pre-
Review and Decision-Making Bodies
Notice Submittal
Development Director
Heritage Preservation
Information Meeting
Pre-Development
Procedure UDC Section
Zoning Board of
Neighborhood
Commission
Commission
City Council
Community
Published
Planning
Meeting
Appeals
Posted
Mailed
[5] Decision made by City Engineer.
d. Members shall serve a term of three years, and until a successor is appointed and
qualifies.
e. Each member of the commission, before entering upon his duties, shall take and
subscribe an oath of office as prescribed by the city Charter.
f. Vacancies occurring on the commission shall be filled for the unexpired term by an
appointment by the mayor with the approval of the City Council.
g. The mayor, with the advice and consent of the council, shall have the authority to remove
any members of the commission whenever the best interests of the city shall be served
thereby.
h. The commission shall adopt a set of rules to govern its own meetings and procedures,
which rules shall not be inconsistent with the provisions of the council, Charter and this
Code.
Powers and Duties Related to the UDC
The Commission shall have advisory and decision-making powers relative to various
administrative procedures as identified in the Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 20,
which shall include but not be limited to those shown in Table 500.01-1 Summary Table of
Review Procedures.
Heritage Preservation Commission
Creation
a. The Heritage Preservation Commission (HPC) shall consist of nine voting members.
b. In addition to the voting members, the Heritage Preservation Commission shall include, if
available, a member of Olmsted County Historical Society, who shall be a non-voting
member. This individual will be included in discussion and deliberation of ongoing
business and be present for the purpose of building collaboration between the two
organizations.
c. All members shall be nominated by the Mayor and appointed by the City Council.
Heritage Preservation Commission members must be persons with demonstrated
interest and expertise in historic preservation and must reside within the City.
Demonstrated interest and expertise may include experience and interest in a variety of
avocations and fields engaged in historic preservation efforts and issues, including,
without limitation, architecture, construction, legal, real estate, and economic
development.
d. Heritage Preservation Commission members shall serve staggered three-year terms.
e. Each term of office shall expire on December 31 of the year the term is scheduled to
expire. All subsequent appointments will be made for three-year terms. All members shall
serve until their successors have been appointed and qualified.
f. When a vacancy occurs, the Mayor shall nominate a successor for approval by the City
Council to fill the unexpired term of the office. If a vacancy occurs in a term with less than
45 days remaining, the Mayor may allow the term to expire without nominating a
successor.
g. Members will not receive a salary for their services, but may be compensated for any
approved expenses incurred in the performance of their duties in accordance with
guidelines established by the City Council.
h. The Heritage Preservation Commission shall meet at least four times a year.
i. The Heritage Preservation Commission shall elect from its members such officers as it
may deem necessary. The Commission shall have the power to designate and appoint
from its members various committees.
j. The Heritage Preservation Commission shall follow adopted City policy for the conduct of
its affairs and for the purpose of carrying out the intent of Section 60.200.040C HPO –
Heritage Preservation Overlay and related procedures in Chapter 60.500 Procedures
and Administration.
Powers and Duties Related to the UDC
The Commission shall have advisory and decision-making powers relative to various
administrative procedures as identified in the Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 20,
which shall include but not be limited to those shown in Table 500.01-1 Summary Table of
Review Procedures.
Zoning Board of Appeals
Creation
a. There shall be a Zoning Board of Appeals consisting of seven members, one of whom
shall be a member of the Planning Commission.
b. All members shall be appointed by the Mayor with the approval of the City Council.
c. Members shall serve for a term of three years, except the Planning Commission
representative, who shall serve for a term of one year.
d. No member shall serve more than two consecutive terms.
e. The Zoning Board of Appeals shall choose a chair from among its membership and
determine its rules of proceeding, a copy of which shall be filed with the Community
Development Director.
Powers and Duties Related to the UDC
a. The Zoning Board of Appeals shall have advisory and decision-making powers relative to
various administrative procedures as identified in the Rochester Code of Ordinances
Chapter 20, which shall include but not be limited to those shown in Table 500.01-1
Summary Table of Review Procedures.
b. Additional Zoning Board of Appeals duties related to the APO district are in Section
60.200.040B, APO -- Airport Protection Overlay.
City Council
Creation
The City Council shall be organized as stated in Chapter V of the Charter of the City of
Rochester.
Powers and Duties Related to the UDC
The City Council shall have all those powers and duties available to the governing body of a
municipality in the state of Minnesota, including but not limited to those powers stated in
Chapter V of the Charter of the City of Rochester, which shall include but not be limited to
those shown in Table 500.01-1 Summary Table of Review Procedures.
COMMON PROCEDURES
General
The common review procedures in this Section 60.500.030 provide the foundation for
specific review and approval procedures identified in Section 60.500.040 through Section
60.500.060K.
Not all common review procedures apply to every development application type. Section
60.500.040 through Section 60.500.060K identify how these common review procedures
are applied to specific application types, and identify additional procedures and
requirements beyond the common review procedures.
Pre-Submittal Activities
Pre-Development Meeting
a. Purpose
The Pre-development Meeting is intended to provide an opportunity for the applicant to
meet with Staff prior to submitting a formal application for development, to review
property zoning and utility availability, identify required development review processes
and public hearings, and determine public improvements and engineering studies that
may be required. Staff can offer guidance and information that helps the applicant to
better prepare the formal application.
b. Applicability
Pre-development Meetings are required as follows:
1) A Pre-development Meeting is required prior to the submission of certain
application types, as shown in Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review
Procedures.
2) All applications that propose development of residential with five or more units,
mixed-use, commercial, or industrial development are required to participate in a
Pre-development Meeting.
3) The Community Development Director shall provide a mailed postcard notice of the
Neighborhood Information Meeting at least 10 calendar days prior to the meeting
in accordance with Section 60.500.030C.1.b, Written Notice.
4) The Community Development Director shall also notify Registered Neighborhood
Associations, if any exist, where the proposed development is located.
5) Neighborhood Information Meetings shall not be scheduled to conflict with regularly
scheduled City Council meetings or on federal holidays, including Election Day.
6) Staff shall not present, evaluate, or approve development proposals at
Neighborhood Information Meetings.
7) Multiple applications related to a single action or development or that are to be
reviewed concurrently by City Council require a single Neighborhood Information
Meeting.
8) An application for development shall include a written summary stating the time
and location of the meeting, the number of attendees and the topics discussed.
The summary shall list each concern raised at the meeting, and for each such
concern, any changes made to the application in response to that concern or the
reason why no change was made.
9) The application for development shall be submitted within 30 calendar days from
the date of the Neighborhood Information Meeting.
Public Hearings
Where Table 500.01-1 Summary Table of Review Procedures, indicates that a public hearing is
required, the hearing shall be scheduled, noticed, and conducted as follows.
Notice Requirements
a. Notice of a Hearing
Notice of a hearing shall contain the following information:
1) The date, time, and place of the hearing;
2) Where the hearing involves a development application for a specific parcel of land,
a description reasonably calculated to inform a person of the location of the
property for which the development permit or other action is pending, including the
use of a map or postal address and a subdivision lot and block designation, a
metes and bounds description, or the tax map designation assigned by the County
Assessor;
3) The nature of the issue that requires a hearing;
4) The interested parties that have standing to appear and be heard;
5) The sections of the UDC that are pertinent to the hearing procedure; and
6) Where information regarding the application may be examined and when and how
written comments may be submitted.
b. Written Notice
1) Notice Required
Unless otherwise provided, addresses for a mailed notice required by this UDC
shall be obtained from the County’s real property tax records and sources of
property owner and tenant mailing addresses obtained no more than 60 days prior
to mailing. Mailed notice shall be sent out by the Community Development Director
at least 10 calendar days prior to the day of the hearing. Notice shall be provided
to:
(a) All owners and tenants of property within 350 feet of the property subject to
the application, provided that no fewer than 50 distinct property owners and
the tenants of those property owners shall be notified;
(b) Any township included within or adjacent to the property subject to the
application;
(c) City Council; and
(d) In the case of properties located in the FPO district, to the Minnesota
Commissioner of Natural Resources so that the Commissioner receives the
notice at least 10 days before the hearing.
2) Omissions and Effect of Omissions
(a) Written notice is not required when a person’s name is not in the tax records
at the time an application is filed, unless the address is on file with the
Community Development Director.
(b) The failure of a property owner to receive written notice after a good faith
attempt to comply with the notice requirements shall not invalidate the
underlying action.
(c) If any omission or defect in the written notice is brought to the attention of
the hearing body, either at or prior to the hearing, the hearing body shall
consider the defect prior to proceeding on the application. If it is found the
omission or defect impaired a surrounding property owner’s ability to
participate in a public hearing, then the hearing body shall continue the
hearing on the proposed application for at least 10 calendar days.
(d) Any omission or defect which is not brought to the attention of the hearing
body, or which is found not to have impaired the ability of a surrounding
property owner to participate, shall in no way impair the validity of the
proceedings on the proposed application.
c. Published Notice
When published notice is required, it shall be published in a newspaper of general
circulation, or in any other format authorized by Minnesota state law, at least 10
calendar days prior to the day of the hearing.
d. On-Site Posted Notice
1) When Required
On-site public notice signage shall be erected on the property where a
development application is filed that requires City Council approval.
2) Sign Requirements
(a) Posted Signs
(i) Required sign(s) and content ofthe signs shall be provided by the
Community Development Department.
(ii) The applicant shall be responsible for posting the sign(s) at least 10
calendar days prior to the date of the first public hearing, and maintaining
the sign(s) until the public hearing body has taken final action upon the
application.
(iii) Posted sign(s) must be visible to the public, with an unobstructed view
from the public right-of-way. At least one sign shall be placed for every
300 feet of linear frontage abutting a public right-of-way, not including
alleys. Signs shall be posted on the subject property (not the public right-
of-way), within five feet of the lot boundary. If the subject property does
not have street frontage, at least one sign must be placed so that it is
visible to the public.
(b) Demonstration of Compliance
(i) Prior to the first public hearing or public meeting date, the applicant shall
submit evidence of compliance with these posting requirements between
the date on which signs must be posted and the date of the first public
hearing or public meeting.
(ii) Failure to submit evidence shall be treated as failure to comply with the
requirements of this Section 60.500.030C.1.d. If the applicant does not
provide evidence that any failure to comply with these requirements has
not impaired the public’s ability to participate in the public hearing, the
hearing body may continue the hearing for at least 10 days.
(iii) If failure to comply with these requirements is not brought to the
attention of the hearing body, or if the hearing body finds that failure to
comply has not impaired the public’s ability to participate in the public
hearing, this failure shall not prevent the conduct of the public hearing or
meeting or impair the validity of the proceedings on the application.
b. Following a hearing, the hearing body shall, within the time limits imposed by this UDC,
approve, approve with conditions, or deny the application or, if the hearing is in the
nature of an appeal, affirm, reverse, or remand the decision that is on appeal.
c. The final decision may be extended for a reasonable period of time by agreement
between the applicant and the Community Development Director, who shall determine
an end date.
Application Submittal and Processing
Application Submittal Requirements
Each application shall include all forms and information required by the City for that type of
application as stated on the City’s website and/or this UDC. In addition, the following
information shall be submitted with an application, as applicable.
a. Environmental Review
1) The current rules issued under the authority granted in Min. Stat. Ch. 116D,
implementing the Environmental Policy Act, shall be followed in determining the
need for preparation of Environmental Review Program documents.
2) Necessary documents, such as Environmental Assessment Worksheets and
Environmental Impact Statements, shall be prepared and the review of such
documents completed prior to application submittal.
b. Traffic Impact Study
1) Applicability
The following provisions apply to all portions of the City except those portions of
the MX-D zoning district that are not required to provide on-site off-street parking
as described in Table 400.08-1, Minimum and Maximum Vehicle Parking
Required.
(a) A Rezoning Traffic Analysis, Traffic Impact Report, Traffic Design Analysis, or
waiver of those requirements by the City Engineer is required for all
applications subject to this Subsection b, and must be approved by the City
as complete and containing all required information before the application is
submitted. The adequacy of the analysis will be determined during review of
the UDC application to which the analysis relates.
(b) A scoping meeting with the City Engineer may be scheduled to determine
whether a Rezoning Traffic Analysis, Traffic Impact Report, or Traffic Design
Analysis is required.
(c) Rezoning Traffic Analysis
(i) A Rezoning Traffic Analysis shall be required for a Conditional Use Permit,
Major or Minor Land Subdivision Permit or General Development Plan
approval, Site Development Plan approval, or Zoning Certificate, where
the application involves any of the following, unless that requirement is
waived or modified pursuant to this UDC.
Payment of Fees
a. Staff shall maintain an official fee schedule on the City’s website for any application,
permit, or process requiring a fee. Such fees shall be approved by the City Council. The
official fee schedule shall be available to the public in the Community Development
Department Office.
b. Fees shall be paid at the Community Development Department office at the time of
application submittal. When the Community Development Department has received a
complete submittal, Staff shall calculate the total amount of the application fee and any
other applicable fees. All payments shall be made to the City of Rochester.
c. Until all applicable fees, charges, and expenses have been paid in full, no action shall be
taken on any application, subdivision request, or permit.
d. The Community Development Director may waive the application fee for any proposal
that is actively being promoted by a unit of local government or quasi-public organization
or that involves a local subsidy.
e. No refunds shall be permitted after a Planning Commission or City Council hearing on the
application has been held, regardless of whether or not the Planning Commission or City
Council has taken action on the application.
Completeness of Application
a. On receiving an application, Staff shall determine whether the application is complete
and is consistent with conditions of previous approvals by an appointed or elected body
applicable to the same property. A complete application is one that contains all
information and materials required by the City website and this UDC for submittal of the
particular application, and that has sufficient detail and readability to evaluate the
application for compliance with applicable review standards of this UDC.
b. No application shall be considered complete until all pre-submittal requirements as listed
in Section 60.500.030B have been satisfied and all required fees have been paid.
c. Upon determining that the application is incomplete, the Community Development
Director shall notify the applicant of the submittal deficiencies. The applicant may correct
the deficiencies and resubmit the application for a determination of completeness until
Staff determines the application is complete.
d. If the Community Development Director notifies an applicant of missing or deficient
materials in an application under this UDC, and the applicant does not submit the
missing materials or corrected materials within 90 days after the date on which the
Director transmits the notice, the applicant will be considered inactive, and materials
submitted to date will be returned to the applicant. Any application processing fees paid
by the applicant in connection with an inactive application shall not be refunded.
e. No development application shall be reviewed for compliance with this UDC or scheduled
for a public hearing by any review or advisory body until it is determined to be complete.
Withdrawal of an Application
a. If a formal application is withdrawn before it is heard by the Planning Commission, the
withdrawal shall be without prejudice and shall have no effect upon any subsequent
application.
b. If a formal application is withdrawn after it is heard by the Planning Commission, the
withdrawal shall be with or without prejudice as the governing body shall decide.
Concurrent Review
a. Two or more applications may be reviewed concurrently. The concurrent review of
multiple applications shall be subject to the same criteria and findings that apply to each
application individually as stated in this UDC. Each application requires a separate action
by the designated hearing body.
b. The following application types may be reviewed concurrently:
1) Amendment of Official Zoning Map;
2) General Development Plan;
3) Site Development Plan;
4) Questions of Land Use Plan conformance that are to be decided by the Council
after review;
5) Major Land Subdivision Permit;
6) Conditional Use Permit;
7) Variance; and
8) Minor Modification.
c. Where an application that may be approved by the Community Development Director
pursuant to Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review Procedures, is being reviewed
concurrently with an application that requires approval by an appointed or elected body,
the Director’s decision shall accompany and be considered to be part of the application
considered by the appointed or elected body, but shall not become final unless and until
the elected or appointed body acts to approve the application or approve it with
conditions.
Review and Decision
Staff Report
a. For each application for which the Planning Commission or City Council serves as a
hearing board or decision-maker, the Community Development Director shall prepare a
Staff Report indicating whether the application complies with applicable provisions of this
UDC and other adopted City, state, or federal regulations.
b. The Staff Report shall recommend that the hearing board and/or decision-maker
approve, approve with conditions, or deny the application based on its compliance with
this UDC, including without limitation those criteria for approval for that type of
application listed in this UDC.
Approval of Incentives
a. Section 60.400.120, Incentives lists the review and decision procedure and criteria
required for approval of an incentive.
b. Decisions regarding applicable incentives are made by the Community Development
Director.
c. If the Director approves any incentives requested in the application, any applicable
review of the application by an appointed or elected body required by this UDC shall be
based on the application including all incentives approved by the Community
Development Director.
d. If the Director determines that approval of any incentive requested in the application will
impose on the City obligations to finance operation or maintenance expenses related to
the incentive, and that the City’s current budget or budgetary processes will not or may
not be able to support those costs, the Director may deny the requested incentive, and
any applicable review of the application by an appointed or elected body required by this
UDC shall be based on the application not including those incentives denied by the
Director.
Decision
The application shall be subject to review, hearings, recommendations, and decisions as
indicated in Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review Procedures.
a. Development Approvals by Community Development Director
If Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review Procedures, indicates that the Community
Development Director shall make the decision on an application, the Director shall
approve the application, or approve it with conditions, if it complies with the following
criteria, unless specific criteria for approval of that type of application are listed in
Section 60.500.060 Development Approvals by Community Development Director or
another Section of this UDC, in which case the specific criteria listed in Section
60.500.060 or the other section of this UDC shall apply.
1) Following acceptance of an application, the Community Development Director shall
either issue or deny a permit or certificate within the following time frames:
Table 500.03-1 Timeframe for Action on Accepted Applications
Permit Type Maximum Number of Days
(a) The application complies with all applicable provisions of this UDC and other
adopted City regulations, as modified by any previously approved Minor
Modification, Major Modification, or Variance;
(b) The application is consistent with any previous development approvals
related to the property including but not limited to any approved General
Development Plan, Distinctive Development, Major Land Subdivision Permit,
or Minor Land Subdivision Permit; and
(c) The application will mitigate any negative impacts on surrounding properties
to the maximum extent practicable.
3) Additional Provisions for Decisions to be Made by the Planning Commission
If Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review Procedures, indicates that the
Planning Commission shall make the decision on an application, the following
additional provisions shall apply:
(a) Referral and Notice
(i) Following acceptance of an application subject to Planning Commission
approval, Staff shall, within three days, transmit one copy of the
application, or appropriate parts of the application, to each referral
agency for review and comment. If the referral agency does not comment
within seven days, the referral agency shall be presumed to have no
comment, unless an extension of up to seven days is requested by the
agency and granted by the Community Development Director.
(ii) The Community Development Director shall also mail a Notice of
Proposed Action to all persons designated to receive notice as stated in
Section 60.500.030C.1.b, Written Notice. The notice shall contain a
synopsis of the development, instructions on where to obtain additional
information, and shall advise notified persons of their right to request a
public hearing before the Planning Commission by written application.
(b) Preliminary Decision
(i) The Community Development Director shall review any information
received under Section 60.500.030D.
(ii) Following the preliminary decision on the application, the Community
Development Director shall prepare a notice of action as required by
Section 60.500.030F.1 and shall transmit a copy to the Planning
Commission at their next regularly scheduled meeting. Written requests
for public hearings received from persons receiving a notice of proposed
action shall also be included in the transmittal to the Planning
Commission.
b. Any condition of approval that requires an applicant to dedicate land or pay money to a
public entity in an amount that is not calculated according to a formula applicable to a
broad class of applicants shall be roughly proportional both in nature and extent to the
anticipated impacts of the proposed development, as shown through an individualized
determination of impacts.
c. During its consideration, the decision-making body may consider alternative potential
conditions, and no discussion of potential conditions shall be deemed an attempt or
intent to impose any condition that would violate the federal or state constitutions,
statutes, or regulations. Discussions of potential conditions to mitigate impacts do not
reflect actions by the decision-making body unless and until the decision-making body
takes formal action to attach that condition to a development approval.
Financial Assurances
a. Unless otherwise provided in this UDC or another City regulation, if the applicant is
required by this UDC or other City regulation to complete or install any public and private
improvements or amenities, or to comply with continuing obligations to mitigate impacts
of activities approved under this UDC, including but not limited to those related to Sand
or Gravel Excavation, Quarry, or Interim Use Permits related to land alterations, the
applicant may be required to provide financial security to the City to ensure that the City
will have adequate funds on hand to complete the required improvements or amenities
or to bring the operations of the approved structure or activity into compliance with this
UDC or any development permit or approval.
b. Financial security will only be used by the City to complete required public and private
improvements or amenities, or to bring properties into compliance if the applicant fails to
provide those improvements in a timely manner as required by this UDC after written
notice from the City and a reasonable opportunity to remedy the failure to construct or
perform.
c. Any required financial assurances will be released by the City, in whole or in part, only
when the City has confirmed that the remaining financial security is adequate to protect
the City from damage or liability for any remaining obligations to construct or comply.
Development Agreements
The City may require an applicant to execute, and City Council is authorized to execute with
the applicant, one or more development agreements to address the phasing of development,
to assign financial, operations, and management responsibilities over time through
infrastructure or service agreements, to ensure the timely completion of any required on or
off site infrastructure or amenities through financial guarantees or phasing agreements, to
identify any public incentives or agreements between the City and the applicant, and to
address any other items related to the design, execution, or potential impacts of an
application under this Section 60.500.030E.8.
Findings and Order
The hearing body shall prepare findings of fact and an order that includes:
a. A statement of the applicable criteria and standards against which the proposal was
reviewed;
b. The reasons supporting a conclusion to approve or deny an application with or without
conditions; and
c. The decision to approve or deny the proposed application and any conditions of approval
attached to the decision.
Record of Proceedings
a. Minutes of the proceedings before the hearing body shall be prepared by the responsible
party.
b. Testimony shall be transcribed if required for judicial review or if ordered by the hearing
body.
c. The hearing body shall, where practical, retain as part of the hearing record each item of
physical or documentary evidence presented and shall have the items marked to show
the identity of the person offering the same and whether presented on behalf of a
proponent or opponent. Exhibits received into evidence shall be retained by the
Community Development Director until after the applicable appeal period has expired, at
which time the exhibits may be released to the person identified thereon, or otherwise
disposed.
d. The findings and order shall be included in the record.
e. An individual shall have access to the record of the proceedings at reasonable times,
places, and circumstances. An individual shall be entitled to make copies of the record at
the individual’s own expense.
Post-Decision Actions and Limitations
Notice of Action
a. The Community Development Director shall notify the applicant in writing as to the final
disposition of the application.
b. The notice shall indicate the date when the decision will take effect and shall describe
the right of appeal pursuant to Section 60.500.030F, Post-Decision Actions and
Limitations.
c. In the case of zoning certificates, rental housing permits, and sign permits, the
application form may be used to transmit the notice of action.
d. In the case of all other permits required by this UDC, the Community Development
Director shall prepare a written Notice of Action containing findings of fact, and the
conclusions based thereon, along with any conditions imposed upon the issuance of the
permit, and shall transmit a copy of the notice to the applicant.
Appeals
a. Availability and Effect of Appeals
d. Notice of Appeal
1) At least 10 days prior to the hearing, the Community Development Director, acting
on behalf of the Appeal body, shall by certified or registered mail, return receipt
requested, or by personal service, give notice of the time and place of the hearing
to the appellant, and/or the official whose decision is being appealed; and by inter-
office delivery to the following where they are not already an interested party:
(a) The City Attorney; and
(b) Other affected officers and agencies of the City government.
2) If the appeal is likely to result in the issuance of a permit, the Community
Development Director shall within the same period of time by first class mail give
notice to an owner of record for tax purposes or an occupant of each separately
owned adjoining property. Such notices shall advise that an appeal from an
administrative officer is pending and direct further inquiry to the Community
Development Director.
3) Required notices are for the convenience of adjoining property owners and any
defect or omission therein shall not impair the validity of the public hearing with
respect to any appeal.
e. Conduct of Appeals
1) Appeals to the Zoning Board of Appeals
(a) Types of Applications
The Zoning Board of Appeals shall hear appeals on applications as specified
in Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review Procedures, including appeals
of interpretations of this UDC made by the Community Development Director.
(b) Appeal Criteria and Findings
(i) The Zoning Board of Appeals must make appeal decisions based on in its
minutes with respect to the specific appeal, findings of fact, and
conclusions of law, and upon substantial evidence or testimony which is
competent, relevant, and material.
(ii) Findings as to the existence or nonexistence of crucial facts shall be
based upon evidence or testimony unless the party or parties before the
Zoning Board of Appeals stipulate the facts or waive these requirements.
(iii) Every decision of the Zoning Board of Appeals shall also include the vote,
abstention from voting, or absence of each member.
(iv) The burden of producing substantial evidence or testimony is upon the
party who files the appeal. Failure to do so shall result in denial of the
appeal.
(v) The Zoning Board of Appeals may reverse or affirm, in whole or in part, or
modify the order, requirement, decision, or determination appealed from
and shall make any order, requirement, decision, or determination that in
its opinion ought to be made under the circumstances. For this purpose,
the Zoning Board of Appeals has all of the powers of the official from
whom the appeal is taken.
(vi) In rendering a decision with respect to an appeal from any order,
decision, or determination, the Zoning Board of Appeals shall strictly
interpret the language of the UDC and shall find that the Community
Development Director’s decision was correct or in error.
(vii) The Zoning Board of Appeals shall not render any decision that confers
rights or privileges on the appellant that are otherwise not permissible
under the strict interpretation of the language of this UDC.
2) Appeals to the City Council
(a) Types of Applications
The City Council shall hear appeals on applications as specified in Table
500.01-1, Summary Table of Review Procedures.
(b) Appeal Criteria and Findings
(i) Unless otherwise provided in this UDC, City Council review of the decision
on appeal shall be based on the record of the proceedings before the
original hearing body, but may be supplemented by additional documents
or testimony related to those records.
(ii) The Planning Commission shall base its decision upon the appellate
record. The appellate record shall include:
m. A factual report prepared by the Community Development Director;
n. The evidence submitted by the appellant and any other person at the
previous and appellate public hearings;
o. All exhibits, materials, pleadings, memoranda, stipulations, and motions
submitted by the appellant and any other person at the previous and
appellate public hearings; and
p. The transcript of the previous hearing if available or a summary of the
evidence.
(iii) Notice of the public hearing shall be mailed to all property owners entitled
to receive notice under the requirements applicable to the original permit
application.
3) Appeals to District Court
After all administrative remedies and local appeals have been exhausted, any
person or persons jointly or severely aggrieved by a decision, may present to the
District Court of Olmsted County, an application setting forth that such a decision is
illegal, in whole or in part, and specifying the grounds of the illegality. Such
application shall be presented to the District Court within 30 days after the
Community Development Director has served a copy of the written decision upon
the applicant.
Validity of UDC Approvals
a. A permit or license issued in conflict with the provision of this UDC shall be null and void
and of no effect. Where a landowner has, in good faith and in reliance upon a permit
issued in error, begun construction, the matter shall be referred to the City Council for
disposition.
b. Permits, certificates, and variances are valid only for the periods shown below:
NOTES
[1] Construction or use pursuant to the approval must be initiated within this timeframe.
c. The property owner or holder of a permit or approval under this UDC that is listed in Table
500-03-1 above may apply for a one-time extension of the expiration period listed in that
table. The Community Development Director may approve a one-time extension of up to
one-half the length of the initial validity period if the Director determines that the property
owner or holder of the permit or approval is moving diligently to initiate development
under that permit or approval but that progress on the project has been delayed for
reasons other than the inactivity, delay, or other actions of the property owner or holder.
d. An approved permit or certificate is assignable in writing to a purchaser, lessee, or tenant
of the property, provided the assignee has agreed to the assignment in writing, but an
assignment does not discharge any prior assignee from any obligation owed to any local
governmental unit in connection with the development, unless the applicable unit of
government consents to the discharge.
e. Changes to the UDC that have been approved by City Council on first reading shall apply
to applications filed before the date of first reading approval, but for which a certificate or
permit has not yet been issued, unless the amendment provides otherwise, or unless City
Council determines that the former ordinance should be made applicable in a particular
case in the interest of justice.
f. If this UDC is amended to prohibit or change the standards applicable to a development
authorized by a certificate or permit, the permit becomes void by operation of the law on
the effective date of the amendment, unless the ordinance establishing the amendment
provides otherwise or the applicant, in good faith and in reliance upon the permit, within
90 days, began construction subsequent to the issuance of the permit but before
adoption of the amendment.
appointed body, or City Council to review and approve the initial development application
or permit.
f. Major Amendments – Conditional Use Permits
Minor Amendments to Conditional Permit may be reviewed and approved as described in
Section 60.500.050A.5.b.
3) The final decision may be extended for a reasonable period of time by agreement
between the applicant and the Community Development Director, but not to exceed
six months from the date of the first hearing on the matter.
Criteria for Comprehensive Plan Adoption or Amendment
The Planning Commission shall recommend, and City Council may approve, the adoption of a
new Comprehensive Plan for the City, or an amendment to an existing adopted
Comprehensive Plan for the City, if it determines that the following criteria are met:
a. The approval of the new Comprehensive Plan or Comprehensive Plan amendment is in
the best interests of the City, and will protect environment and the health, safety, and
welfare of the citizens of the City, and particularly those of historically marginalized
citizens and citizens experiencing disability.
b. The approval of the new Comprehensive Plan or Comprehensive Plan amendment
complies with all applicable requirements of Minnesota state law.
Growth Management Map Amendment
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.500.040B is to describe the process by which the adopted
Growth Management Map may be amended from time to time in compliance with applicable
Minnesota state law.
Applicability
This process is applicable to all applications to amend the City’s Growth Management Map,
and may be required to be completed before an application for an Official Zoning Map
Amendment or another application under this UDC may be recommended for approval or
approval with conditions.
Applicability
The provisions of the UDC may periodically be amended or repealed. An amendment to the
text of this UDC may only be initiated by the Community Development Director, Planning
Commission, or City Council, or by a property owner if required by Minnesota law.
Procedure for UDC Text Amendment Approval
Amendments to the Official Zoning Map
UDC TEXT AMENDMENT APPROVAL
Amendments shall comply with all
applicable requirements of Section
COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT
60.500.030 Common Procedures unless DIRECTOR REVIEW &
modified or supplemented by this Section RECOMMENDATION
60.500.040E.3.
a. Notice and Hearing PLANNING COMMISSION
REVIEW &
1) The application for a UDC text RECOMMENDATION
amendment shall be scheduled for
public hearings before the
Planning Commission and City
Council in accordance with Section CITY COUNCIL DECISION
60.500.030, Common
Procedures.
2) In addition, written notice of any indicates public hearing
proposed amendment to the FPO
district boundaries or the boundaries of Flood Fringe (FF), Floodway (FW), or Flood
Prone (FP) subdistricts within the FPO district, together with the text of the
proposed amendment and any supporting technical studies, shall be sent to the
Minnesota Commissioner of Natural Resources so that the Commissioner receives
notice at least 10 days before each public hearing.
b. Planning Commission Hearing and Recommendation
1) The Planning Commission shall hold a public hearing on the application for a UDC
Text Amendment pursuant to Section 60.500.030C.2, Conduct of Public Hearing.
2) Following the hearing, the Planning Commission shall, within the time limits
imposed by this UDC, recommend that City Council approve, approve with
conditions, or deny the application, based on the criteria in Subsection 4 below.
c. City Council Action
1) The City Council shall hold a public hearing on the application for UDC Text
Amendment pursuant to Section 60.500.030C.2, Conduct of Public Hearing.
2) Following the hearing, the City Council shall, within the time limits imposed by this
UDC, approve, approve with conditions, or deny the application, based on the
criteria in Subsection 4 below.
3) The final decision may be extended for a reasonable period of time by agreement
between the applicant and the Community Development Director, but not to exceed
six months from the date of the first hearing on the matter.
Criteria for UDC Text Amendment Approval
The Planning Commission shall recommend, and City Council may approve, an amendment
to the text of this UDC if it determines that the following criteria are met:
a. General
1) There is a public need for the amendment;
2) The amendment accomplishes one or more of the purposes of this UDC, the
Comprehensive Plan, or other adopted City plans or policies; and
3) Adoption of the amendment will be lawful.
b. Amendments to FPO District or Flood Protection Regulations
In addition, if the application includes changes to the FPO District or any standard,
criteria, or other regulation of this UDC related to the protection of the public from flood
risks, the following criteria shall apply:
1) The proposed change complies with the Federal Emergency Management Agency’s
(FEMA) Technical Conditions and Criteria and has been approved in writing by
FEMA; and
2) The proposed change has been submitted to and approved by the Minnesota
Commissioner of Natural Resources.
Rezoning (Official Zoning Map Amendment)
Purpose
The Rezoning (Official Zoning Map Amendment) procedure is intended to provide a
mechanism for the City to consider an application for the rezoning of real property within the
jurisdictional area of the City and to ensure that the statutory requirements established in
Minnesota law for the zoning of real property are met.
Applicability
a. The City Council may amend the boundaries of zoning districts established on the Official
Zoning Map, except for the HPO – Heritage Preservation Overlay district, as stated in this
Section 60.500.040A.
b. The City Council may amend the boundaries of the HPO – Heritage Preservation Overlay
as stated in Section 60.500.040F Designation or Removal of Landmark Property or
Landmark District.
c. Zoning of land in the process of annexation may be done in conjunction with the
Annexation of Land proceedings, but shall be subject to the procedure and notice
requirements of this Section 60.500.040A. The proposed zoning ordinance shall not be
passed on final reading prior to the date when the annexation ordinance is passed on
final reading but the ordinance annexing the property can also zone the property.
1) If the City initiates the Annexation of Land and the land use plan shows that the
future use of the property is low density residential and other provisions of this
Section do not require another designation, the land will be zoned R-2.
2) If the City initiates the Annexation of Land and the future land use plan shows that
the future use of the property is something other than low density residential, the
land will be zoned H with a hearing to be held within 60 days after annexation.
3) If the landowner initiates the Annexation of Land, the landowner shall identify the
zoning district for the property at the time of annexation. For any lands designated
as low density residential on the future land use map, the landowner shall request
R-2 zoning.
d. Property that is located within a designated Special Flood Hazard Area inundated by the
100 year Flood on the adopted Floor Insurance Rate Map for Olmsted County,
Minnesota, and Incorporated Areas effective April 19, 2017, and any amendment to that
map, shall be designated as the Flood Prone (FP) district (as defined November 3, 1980)
except those areas designated as Flood Fringe A (FFA) under the Olmsted County Zoning
Ordinance that upon annexation shall be designated as the Flood Fringe (FF) District.
e. Property designated on the adopted Flood Insurance Rate Maps for Olmsted County,
Minnesota and Incorporated Areas effective April 19, 2007, and any amendments
thereto as Floodway Areas in Zone AE shall be designated as the Floodway (FW) District.
f. Within 30 days after the effective date of an Annexation of Land that was adopted
without designating a zoning district, or within six months after the passage of a joint
resolution designating an area in need of orderly annexation, the Community
Development Director shall prepare a report for the Planning Commission examining the
existing pattern of development in the area, the character of the property, and the land
use plan recommendation for the area, and shall include a recommendation on suitable
zoning designation for the property. If the City Council finds it is important to the
protection or implementation of City policies, interim regulations may be applied to the
annexed area until more permanent action can be taken.
(a) The area, as presently zoned, is inconsistent with the policies and goals of
the Comprehensive Plan;
(b) The area was originally zoned erroneously due to a technical or
administrative error;
(c) While both the present and proposed zoning districts are consistent with the
Comprehensive Plan, the proposed district better aligns with the policies and
goals of the Comprehensive Plan or other adopted City plans or policies, as
determined by City Council;
(d) The area has changed or is changing to such a degree that it is in the public
interest to rezone to encourage development or redevelopment of the area
consistent with the policies and goals of the Comprehensive Plan; or
(e) The area includes lands identified as Decorah Edge and the amendment
would provide for beneficial development that maintains typical urban density
while preserving habitat and protecting processes that maintain groundwater
quality and quantity.
(f) The area includes lands identified on adopted City plans as an important
natural or historic resource, and the amendment would provide for beneficial
development that would protect those resources.
b. Amendment of FPO District Boundaries or Internal Designations
If the application is for an amendment of FPO district boundaries or the boundaries of
Flood Fringe (FF), Floodway (FW), or Flood Prone (FP) subdistricts within the FPO district,
the following criteria shall apply instead of those in Subsection a above. The floodplain
designation shall not be revised or removed from floodplain areas unless:
1) The proposed change complies with the Federal Emergency Management Agency’s
(FEMA) Technical Conditions and Criteria and has been approved in writing by
FEMA; and
2) The proposed change has been submitted to and approved by the Minnesota
Commissioner of Natural Resources; and
3) The applicant demonstrates that:
(a) The designation is in error; or
(b) The area has been filled to or above the elevation of the regional flood and is
contiguous to lands outside the floodplain; or
(c) The Minnesota Commissioner of Natural Resources has approved in writing a
special exception to Subsections 2(a) and 2(b) based on the Commissioner’s
determination that the lands are adequately protected for the intended use
through other measures.
3) Economic Hardship
Removal of a landmark property or part or all of a landmark district designation
shall be approved if an application demonstrates that the property or properties
proposed for removal are burdened by an economic hardship and cannot earn a
reasonable economic return, as evidenced by the following information:
(a) Current level of economic return, including:
(i) Amount paid for the property, date of purchase, party from whom
purchased, and any relationship between the owner of record, the
applicant, and person from whom the property was purchased;
(ii) Amount owed on the property and annual debt services payments;
(iii) Current value of the property, as evidenced by the current assessed value
of the property for tax purposes, value from any appraisal performed
within the previous two years, and documentation of any local, state, and
federal taxes paid upon the property or value assigned to the property for
purposes of tax deductions, tax credits, or depreciation over the previous
four years; and
(iv) Annual gross and net income from the property and for the previous three
years, itemized operating and maintenance expenses for the previous
three years, and depreciation deduction and annual cash flow before and
after debt service, if any, during the same period.
(b) Current use of the property and feasibility of alternative uses for the property
that could earn a reasonable economic return. Assessment of feasibility shall
be based on:
(i) Report from a qualified architect or structural engineer as to the
structural soundness of any building on the property and its suitability for
rehabilitation.
(ii) Cost estimates for the proposed construction, alteration, demolition, or
removal, and an estimate of any additional costs that would be incurred
to comply with the requirements for rehabilitation.
(iii) Expert testimony or opinion on the feasibility of rehabilitation or reuse of
the existing structure by an architect who meets professional
qualifications established by the standards.
(c) Estimated market value of the property in each of the following conditions, as
evidence by any appraisal performed in the last two years; any listing of all or
a portion of the property for sale, lease, rental, or occupancy during the last
two years; or other relevant reports or information:
(i) In its current condition;
(ii) After completion of the proposed alteration or demolition; and
(iii) After renovation of the existing property for continued use.
(d) Any additional data that supports the claim of economic hardship.
(e) A determination of economic hardship will not be granted to a property owner
who has engaged in demolition by neglect. A property owner shall provide
proof of having conducted routine maintenance and any necessary major
repairs on a designated property to support its continued preservation, and
demonstrate that demolition by neglect is not the cause the economic
hardship request.
Major Land Subdivision Permit
Purpose
a. The Major Land Subdivision Permit process is intended to ensure that the creation of
new developable lots within the City comply with all applicable requirements of state law,
this UDC, and all applicable City and other government regulations related to
transportation, utilities, protection of sensitive lands, and the provision of public services,
and are consistent with the adopted Rochester Comprehensive Plan.
b. A Major Land Subdivision Permit is the initial document authorizing the creation of a
major subdivision of land and is recognized as the preliminary subdivision plat under
Minnesota state law. A Final Plat approval pursuant to Section 60.500.040H will also be
required before land subdivision activity can proceed.
Applicability
a. This Section 60.500.040G applies to all activities that will create new developable lots,
or that creates a new vertical subdivision as defined in Minnesota state law, or that is
otherwise defined as a Subdivision of Land by the state of Minnesota or City ordinance,
except for:
1) Those activities exempt from regulation by Minnesota Statute Chapter 462;
2) Those activities exempt from these regulations by the Community Development
Director because all of the proposed lots front on a platted or dedicated street
right-of-way and for which no major changes to the right-of-way are proposed.
3) Those activities related to land or lots that are eligible for approval as a Lot Line
Readjustment pursuant to Section 60.500.060J; and
4) Those divisions of land that are eligible for approval as a Minor Land Subdivision
Permit pursuant to Section 60.500.060G.
f. The plan for soil erosion and stormwater management meets the adopted standards of
the City of Rochester and is consistent with the adopted Stormwater Management Plan
or adopted drainage or stormwater policies.
g. The vehicular, pedestrian, transit and non-motorized system is consistent with adopted
transportation plans and is consistent with the street layout standards listed in Section
60.400.040C Subdivision Level Connectivity and Circulation and applicable traffic
service standards.
h. The soils, topography and water tables have been adequately studied to ensure that all
lots are developable for their designated purposes.
i. The proposed subdivision will not have off-site impacts on the street, drainage, water, or
wastewater systems that exceed adopted standards.
j. The lot and block layout provide for safe and convenient pedestrian, non-motorized
vehicle, transit, vehicular, service and emergency access, efficient utility service
connections, and adequate buildable area in each lot for planned uses.
k. The proposed subdivision has taken into account the current six-year and other Long-
Range Capital Improvements Programs and the elements listed in those programs in the
design of the subdivision.
l. The proposed subdivision will not have adverse impacts on the safety or viability of
permitted uses on, or the efficient continued development of, adjacent properties.
m. Rights-of-way and easements of adequate size and dimension are provided for the
purpose of constructing the street, utility, and drainage facilities needed to serve the
development.
n. The proposed parks, trail thoroughfares, and open space dedications are consistent with
adopted plans, policies, and regulations.
o. If located in a residential zoning district, the subdivision addresses the need to avoid
spillover parking from subdivision residents into surrounding residential districts.
p. For any land located within the Special Flood Hazard Area of the FPO – Floodplain
Overlay:
1) The proposed subdivision adequately mitigates the risks of flooding, inadequate
drainage, soil and rock formations with severe limitations for development, severe
erosion potential, or any other floodplain related risks to the health, safety, or
welfare of the future residents of the proposed subdivision in a manner consistent
with this ordinance;
2) Each lot contains a potential building site located outside of the Floodway District at
or above the regulatory flood protection elevation;
3) Adequate drainage is provided to reduce exposure of flood hazard;
4) For all subdivisions containing land within the Floodway and/or Flood Fringe District
boundaries, the regulatory flood protection elevation and the required elevation of
all access roads are clearly labeled on all required subdivision drawings and
platting documents;
5) The subdivision provides road access both to the subdivision and to the individual
building sites no lower than two feet below the regulatory flood protection elevation;
and
6) All public utilities and facilities, such as sewer, gas, electrical, and water systems,
are located and constructed to minimize or eliminate flood damage.
Final Plat
Purpose
The Final Plat process is intended to ensure that all aspects of a Major or Minor Land
Subdivision Permit approved or approved with conditions pursuant to this UDC is accurately
documented and recorded in the public land records through the preparation of a subdivision
plat meeting the requirements of Minnesota law.
Applicability
The Final Plat process applies to all lands that are the subject of a Major or Minor Land
Subdivision Permit that has been approved or approved with conditions, and must be
completed before a Zoning Certificate for any activity on the lots shown in those Permits may
occur.
Procedure for Final Plat Approval
a. Applications for a Final Plat shall
comply with all applicable
requirements of Section 60.500.030
Common Procedures unless modified
or supplemented by this Section
60.500.040H.
b. The Community Development Director
shall approve, approve with
conditions, or deny an application for a
Final Plat approval based on the
criteria in Subsection 4 below.
c. Phased Development
Where a final plat for phased development is subject to a development agreement with
the City, phasing will be allowed up to six years for two phases, eight years for three
phases and ten years for four phases.
Criteria for Final Plat Approval
The application shall be approved or approved with conditions, and the applicant authorized
to record the Final Plat, if the Community Development Director determines that:
a. A Grading Permit for the property included in the Final Plat has been approved, or
approved with Conditions pursuant to Section 60.500.060H.4.f; and
b. The plat complies with all applicable provisions of this UDC and Minnesota law and
accurately reflects all changes required by the City during the Major or Minor Land
Subdivision Permit process.
Official Street Map Adoption
This Section 60.500.040I implements Minnesota Statute 394.361 Official Map. In case of
conflict between the provisions of this Section and the statute, the statute will apply.
Purpose
The Official Street Map Adoption process is intended to clarify how the map designating the
locations, names, and details of public streets in the City may be adopted, in conformance
with Minnesota state law.
Applicability
This Section 60.500.040I shall apply
whenever the City Council determines
that any aspect of the Official Street
Map should be updated, and whenever
an update of that map is required by
Minnesota Law.
Procedure for Official Street Map
Adoption
Applications for adoption or amendment
of the Official Street Map shall comply
with all applicable requirements of
Section 60.500.030 Common
Procedures unless modified or
supplemented by this Section
60.500.040I.
a. Application, Notice, and Hearing
1) An application for adoption or amendment of the Official Street Map may be filed by
the Community Development Director, City Engineer, Planning Commission, or City
Council.
2) The application for adoption or amendment of the Official Street Map shall be
scheduled for public hearings before the Planning Commission and City Council in
accordance with Section 60.500.030, Common Procedures.
b. Planning Commission Recommendation
The Planning Commission shall, within the time limits imposed by this UDC, recommend
that the City Council approve, approve with conditions, or deny the application, based on
the Criteria in Subsection 4 below.
Distinctive Development
Purpose
The purpose of the Distinctive Development procedure is to allow landowners to propose
certain types of development that cannot be accomplished through other zoning districts and
procedures in this UDC provided that those developments provide to the City benefits equal
to or greater than what the City would achieve if the Distinctive Development procedure were
not used. The Distinctive Development procedure may not be used simply to obtain relief
from otherwise applicable standards in Section 60.300.030, Use-Specific Standards, or to
obtain relief from otherwise applicable standards in Chapter 60.400, Development
Standards, and Incentives that could have been granted pursuant to Section 60.400.120.
Applicability
The City may accept an application for Distinctive Development approval if the proposed
development cannot be accomplished through any combination of the base and overlay
zoning districts in this UDC with any adjustments to UDC standards permitted pursuant to
Section 60.500.070, Flexibility and Relief, or by providing the benefits required for certain
types of flexibility pursuant to Section 60.400.120 Incentives.
Procedure for Distinctive Development Approval
Applications for Distinctive Development
shall comply with all applicable requirements
of Section 60.500.030 Common Procedures
unless modified or supplemented by this
Section 60.500.040K.
a. Application
1) The application may include any
use or combination of uses listed in
Table Section 60.300.010B
Allowed Uses Table, but may not
include any uses not listed in that
Table.
2) The application shall list each
standard in Section 60.300.030,
Use-Specific Standards, and in
Chapter 60.400, Development Standards, applicable to similar types and
density/intensity of land, land use, or development that is to be modified or that
shall not apply in the Distinctive Development. Unless identified for modification in
the application and approved pursuant to this Section 60.500.040K, the applicable
standards in Section 60.300.030, Use-Specific Standards, and in Chapter 60.400,
Development Standards, shall apply.
3) The Community Development Director may require that an application for approval
of a Distinctive Development include a General Development Plan based on the
size, complexity, or anticipated impacts of the proposed Distinctive Development.
b. Notice and Hearing
1) Notice of the public hearing on a Distinctive Development application shall be
provided by publication in a newspaper of general circulation at least 10 days
before the date of the hearing.
2) In addition, for any Distinctive Development application, mailed notice shall be sent
to all owners of land situated wholly or partly within 350 feet of the outer perimeter
of the subject property.
c. Planning Commission Recommendation
The Planning Commission shall, within the time limits imposed by this UDC, recommend
that the City Council approve, approve with conditions, or deny the application, based on
the Criteria in Subsection 4 below.
d. City Council Action
1) The City Council shall hold a public hearing on the application for a Distinctive
Development approval pursuant to Section 60.500.030C.2, Conduct of Public
Hearing.
2) Following the hearing, the City Council shall, within the time limits imposed by this
UDC, approve, approve with conditions, or deny the application based on the
criteria in Subsection d below.
3) The final decision may be extended for a reasonable period of time by agreement
between the applicant and the Community Development Director, but not to exceed
six months from the date of the first hearing on the matter.
e. Site Development Plan(s) Required
1) Following approval of the Distinctive Development application and General
Development Plan by the City Council, the applicant shall prepare and submit a Site
Development Plan(s) for each portion of the property pursuant to Section
60.500.060B that incorporates any changes or conditions imposed by the City
Council as part of its decision.
2) The Community Development Director shall review and approve the final Site
Development Plan(s) for the Distinctive Development pursuant to Section
60.500.060C.
Criteria for Approval of Distinctive Development
The Planning Commission shall recommend for approval, and the City Council may approve,
an application for approval of a Distinctive Development if it complies with the following
criteria:
Purpose
CONDITIONAL USE PERMIT APPROVAL
The Conditional Use Permit procedure
provides a mechanism for the City to evaluate
proposed land uses that are generally COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT
DIRECTOR REVIEW &
characterized by infrequency of use, high RECOMMENDATION
degree of traffic generation, and/or
requirement of a large land area. This
procedure is intended to ensure compatibility
of such uses with surrounding areas and that PLANNING COMMISSION
DECISION
adequate mitigation is provided for
anticipated impacts. APPEAL TO
Applicability CITY COUNCIL
applicant has obtained all required state and federal permits related to floodproofing and
flood protection measures.
e. A copy of each decision approving or approving with conditions a Conditional Use Permit
in the FPO – Floodplain District Overlay shall be sent by mail to the Minnesota
Commissioner of Natural Resources within 10 days after the decision.
Criteria for Conditional Use Permit Approval
a. General
The Planning Commission or the City Council, as indicated in Table 300.02-1, shall
approve a Conditional Use Permit if it determines that the proposed use will not create
any of the following negative impacts.
1) Vehicular loading, unloading, parking, and vehicular or pedestrian circulation on the
site will create hazards to safety or will impose a significant burden upon public
facilities;
2) The Site Development Plan does not provide pedestrian access to any
customer/tenant ingress/egress of the building, including from a public right-of-way
and off-street parking area that serves the use while minimizing non-
vehicular/vehicular conflicts;
3) The operation of the use will create significant negative impacts on the surrounding
area or will impose undue burdens on the sewers, sanitary and storm drains, water,
or similar public facilities;
4) The application will create significant negative environmental impacts on the
surrounding area.
5) The application or related Site Development Plan fails to comply with one or more
previous use or development approvals for the property, including without limitation
any Distinctive Development approval or General Development Plan applicable to
the property; and/or
6) The application or related Site Development Plan fails to comply with all applicable
UDC regulations or other City adopted regulations applicable the use or zone
district in which the property is located, including but not limited to any Use-Specific
Standard applicable to the proposed use in 0, unless a Minor Modification, Major
Modification, or Variance permitting that deviation has been approved by the City.
b. Additional Criteria for Approval in FPO – Floodplain District Overlay
If the application relates to property in the FPO – Floodplain Overlay, the Planning
Commission or the City Council, as indicated in Table 300.02-1, shall approve a
Conditional Use Permit if it determines that the following additional criteria have been
met.
1) The application may only be approved or approved with conditions if the applicant
has obtained all required local, state, and federal government permits related to
floor protection and floodproofing.
(d) The types, uses, and numbers of watercraft that the project will generate are
compatible in relation to the suitability of public waters to safely
accommodate watercraft;
2) Setbacks from the Ordinary High Water Level;
3) Limitations on the natural vegetation to be removed or the requirement that
additional vegetation be planted; and
4) Special provisions for the location, design, and use of structures, sewage treatment
systems, watercraft launching and docking areas, and vehicle parking areas.
Modifications to Approved Conditional Use Permits
a. Minor Modifications
1) Subject to the restrictions listed below, the Community Development Director is
authorized to make changes to approved Conditional Use Permits if necessitated by
engineering factors or other circumstances unforeseen at the time the permit was
approved.
2) Minor modifications include but are not limited to modification in building locations;
height; maximum m lot coverage; maximum or minimum floor area; exterior
facades; landscaping materials and placement; design of public facilities; and the
addition, deletion, or change of accessory structures or uses; but do not include any
modification of required public infrastructure addressed in a development
agreement and do not include any of the following:
(a) In the case of residential development, an increase or decrease in the
number of approved dwelling units by more than 10 percent;
(b) An increase or decrease in the floor area ratio resulting in more than ten
percent change in building coverage on the lot;
(c) Changes in site design that may create problems or conflicts associated with
vehicular traffic, transit vehicle or patron, non-motorized vehicle or pedestrian
circulation on-site and at access points;
(d) Inadequate public facilities;
(e) A reduction in off-street parking and loading spaces, unless the reduction in
parking does not result in non-conformance with the requirements of this
UDC;
(f) A significant change in the character of the project as originally approved
including:
(i) Elimination of one of the major approved elements of the project such as
the approved use;
d. The proposed development does not comply with all applicable standards of the SDO –
Shoreland District Overlay, the standards of the underlying zoning district, or the
standards specifically applicable to the proposed use, and a variance or modification to
allow such deviation has not been secured by the applicant.
e. The proposed development will increase flood heights and/or flood duration, will
increase the rate of rise, will modify the extents of the floodplain, will increase sediment
transport, and/or will increase flow velocities of the flood waters expected at the site.
f. The development poses a danger that materials may be swept onto other lands or
downstream to the injury of others or damage to property.
c. The owner of property that is not the subject of an application listed in Subsection 2.a
above may file an application to approve a General Development Plan. In this case, the
application shall include the signatures of each property owner included in the proposed
boundaries of the GDP or a statement as to why any non-signatories refused to sign.
d. Notwithstanding the provisions of Subsection 2.a above, approval of a General
Development Plan is not required in connection with the types of applications listed in
Subsections 2.a.1), 2), or 3) for:
1) Any proposed development for which no new connections to a public street are
required, and for which this UDC does not require the preparation of a Traffic
Impact Report.
2) Any proposed development for which the applicant is required to receive approval
of a Conditional Use Permit or Site Development Plan for a project that will be
approved under the provisions of a Registered Land Survey rather than a final
subdivision plat.
3) Except within the DEO - Decorah Edge Overlay, any proposed development for
which:
(a) A General Development Plan has previously been approved by City Council;
(b) The Community Development Director determines that new proposed streets
need not continue beyond the land to be subdivided in order to complete an
appropriate street system or to provide access to adjacent property.
(c) The Community Development Director has determined that any application
for re-zoning is consistent with the land use designation in the adopted
Rochester Comprehensive Plan and for which no new right-of-way, street or
utility easement is needed to accommodate the orderly development of the
subject parcel and abutting property.
Procedure for General Development Plan Approval
Applications for a General
GENERAL DEVELOPMEN PLAN
Development Plan approval shall
comply with all applicable
requirements of Section COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT
60.500.030 Common Procedures DIRECTOR DECISION
unless modified or supplemented
by this Section 60.500.040E.3. APPEAL TO ZONING
BOARD OF APPEALS
a. Criteria for General
Development Plan Approval
indicates public hearing
The Community Development
Director shall approve a
General Development Plan if the following are satisfied:
1) All applicable standards in this UDC are met including the proposed land uses for
the underlying zoning district as stated in Table 300.02-1 Allowed Uses Table, and
standards in Section 60.400.030, Subdivision Standards, and Section
60.400.040, Access and Connectivity;
2) The mix of housing is consistent with adopted the Comprehensive Plan and
Housing Plans.
3) The proposed plan makes provisions for planned improvements and streets
reflected in the City’s adopted Capital Improvements Program;
4) Utilities are available to directly serve the area of the proposed land use, or the City
is planning for the extension of utilities to serve the area of the proposed
development and such utilities are in the first three years of the City’s current 6-
Year Capital Improvements Program, or that other arrangements have been made
pursuant to Section 60.500.030E.7 Financial Assurances to ensure that adequate
utilities will be available concurrently with development;
5) Provisions for wetlands areas and DEO zoning district Edge Support comply with
applicable standards in this UDC and will maintain the quality and quantity of
groundwater recharging lower aquifers and to protect discharge, interflow,
infiltration, and recharge processes. If the eventual platting of the area will require
approval of a Major Land Subdivision Permit, the proposed development must
satisfy one of the following categories of development:
(a) A development bounded on all sides by arterial or higher-level streets,
streams, or other topographic constraints, existing development, land already
included in an approved General Development Plan, or permanent open
space that limits the inclusion of other abutting lands;
(b) A development with adequate public facilities and constituting the entire
remaining service area of a major public facility improvement (such as a
trunk sewer or water tower) that has been identified as a project in the
Capital Improvement Program;
(c) A development that consists of at least 80 acres in land area regardless of
ownership or interest, and consists of all lands for which the applicant has
ownership or interest; or
(d) A development for which a development agreement has been executed by
the owner and the city for the entire property included in the proposed
General Development Plan. The development agreement must have been
drafted based on the development of the property occurring as proposed in
the General Development Plan.
b. Modifications to a General Development Plan
The Community Development Director may approve amendments to an approved
General Development Plan if the Director determines that they comply with the criteria in
Subsection a above, and may waive any application submittal requirements not required
to evaluate the impacts of the proposed modification.
Site Development Plan
Purpose
a. The Site Development Plan review process is intended to promote the safe, functional,
and aesthetic development of property and to ensure that new structures, utilities,
streets, parking, circulation systems, yards, and open spaces are developed in
conformance with the standards of this UDC.
b. The Site Development Plan review shall consider the siting of structures and related site
improvements so as to promote harmonious relationships with adjacent development,
promote use of non-motorized transportation and transit, enhance the pedestrian
environment, and minimize bicycle, pedestrian, and motorized vehicle conflicts.
Applicability
a. Site Development Plan review is required for:
1) All site development in the City that requires a development permit except a
detached single-family dwelling, twin-home dwelling, or duplex dwelling;
2) All construction or modification of structures, parking lots and the creation of
impervious surfaces;
3) All changes of use on a site, as determined by the Community Development
Director.
b. Site Development Plan approval shall occur prior to the issuance of a building permit.
c. When a Site Development Plan application is reviewed, or when the Final Plan for a
Planned Development is reviewed, the Site Development Plan review is included as part
of those reviews.
Procedure for Site Development Plan Approval
a. An application for approval of Zoning Certificate shall be reviewed and a decision made
pursuant to Section 60.500.030 Common Procedures, pursuant to the Criteria in Section
4 below.
b. Development pursuant to an SITE DEVELOPMENT PLAN APPROVAL
approved Site Development Plan
must begin within one year after
approval, unless otherwise COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT
DIRECTOR DECISION
approved by the Community
Development Director, or the
APPEAL TO ZONING
approval becomes null and void.
BOARD OF APPEALS
c. A Land Subdivision Permit shall
be required prior to site indicates public hearing
development approval when a
properties within a landmark district, comply with all applicable provisions in Section
60.200.040E and with all other provisions of this UDC and City regulations designed protect
properties historically significant to the community.
Applicability
a. When Required
[To Be Inserted]
b. Exemptions
1) The following activities may be performed without the requirement to obtain a
Certificate of Appropriateness.
(a) Maintenance and repair that does not affect the external appearance of the
property;
(b) Interior remodeling and modifications that do not affect the external
appearance;
(c) Exterior repainting (color selection), or re-plastering similar to the existing
finish;
(d) Routine repair or maintenance such as caulking, replacement of fasteners,
repair of window glazing or other such minimally intrusive work; and
(e) Upgrading of mechanical, electrical, and plumbing systems and other code-
required work to make properties functional, when it has no visual impact to
the property as seen from off-site.
(f) If there is a question as to whether an activity qualifies as exempt from the
requirement for a Certificate of Appropriateness, the Heritage Preservation
Commission shall make the determination regarding exemption status of the
proposed activity.
(g) In an emergency situation where immediate repair is needed to protect the
safety of a building or structure and its inhabitants, the Community
Development Director and Building Official may approve the alteration
without prior Heritage Preservation Commission action.
requirements of state law, this UDC, and all applicable City and other government
regulations related to transportation, utilities, protection of sensitive lands, and the
provision of public services, and are consistent with the adopted Rochester
Comprehensive Plan.
b. A Minor Land Subdivision Permit is the initial document authorizing the creation of a
minor subdivision of land and is recognized as the preliminary plan under Minnesota
state law. A Final Plat approval under the requirements of Section 60.500.040H will also
be required before land subdivision activity can proceed.
Applicability
a. This Section 60.500.060G applies to all activities that will create no more than four new
developable lots, including vertical as defined in Minnesota state law that will create no
more than four new lots, or that is otherwise defined as a Subdivision of Land that
creates no more than four new developable parcels by the state of Minnesota or City
ordinance, all of the proposed lots front on a platted or dedicated street right-of-way and
for which no major changes to the right-of-way are proposed; except for:
1) Those activities exempt from regulation by Minnesota Statute Chapter 462;
2) Those activities related to land or lots that are eligible for approval as a Lot Line
Readjustment pursuant to Section 60.500.060J;
3) Those divisions of land that are required to complete a Major Land Subdivision
Permit pursuant to Section 60.500.040G; and
4) Activities that are the subject of a Grading Permit pursuant to Section
60.500.060H.4.f, unless the activity will involve the construction of structures or
improvements that will continue to exist following the completion of the Grading
Permit.
b. If the Community Development Director determines that the Minor Land Subdivision
Permit process is being used repeatedly or on related parcels of land to avoid the Major
Land Subdivision Permit process in Section 60.500.040G, or that the use of the Minor
Land Subdivision Permit process by the same owner or by owners acting in concert and
that the impacts of the series of applications creates impacts on the land, surrounding
properties, or City services and infrastructure similar to those created by a Major Land
Subdivision, the Director may require that the applicant complete the Major Land
Subdivision Permit process.
c. A Minor Land Subdivision Permit shall be required prior to site development approval
when a development is proposed on more than one lot; and/or a development is
proposed across multiple lots. This includes but is not limited to primary structures,
accessory structures, off-street parking, bufferyards/landscaping, recreation areas,
exterior storage, and signage.
h. The proposed subdivision will not have adverse impacts on the safety or viability of
permitted uses on, or the efficient continued development of, adjacent properties.
Floodplain Development Permit
Purpose
The Floodplain Development Permit process is intended to ensure that all development in
the FPO – Floodplain Overlay complies with all applicable provisions in Section 60.200.040E
and with all other provisions of this UDC and City regulations designed to reduce the risk of
damage due to flooding.
Applicability
This Section 60.500.060H applies to all land in the FPO – Floodplain Overlay district, and
requires that a Floodplain Development Permit be obtained before conducting any of the
following activities on such land:
a. The erection, addition, modification, rehabilitation, or alteration of any building or
structure. Normal maintenance and repair requires a permit if, separately or in
conjunction with other planned work, it constitutes substantial improvement;
b. The use or change of use of a building, structure, or land;
c. The construction of a dam, on-site septic system, or fence, except for a farm fence;
d. The change or extension of a nonconforming use;
e. The repair of a structure that has been damaged by flood, fire, tornado, or any other
source;
f. The placement of fill, excavation of materials, or the storage of materials or equipment;
g. Relocation or alteration of a watercourse (including new or replacement culverts and
bridges), unless a public waters work permit has been applied for;
h. All new construction and substantial improvements;
i. All placement of manufactured homes; and
j. Any other type of development.
additional access is not required. This process may be used only once for each parcel of
land.
c. All parcels associated with the application must be within the same recorded subdivision.
If any parcels are located in a different subdivision, the application must follow the Minor
Land Subdivision process as described in Section 60.500.060G.
d. Following the approval of the lot line readjustment, a Lot Combination through the
County Recorder’s office is required.
Procedure for Lot Line Readjustment LOT LINE READJUSTMENT APPROVAL
Approval
a. Applications for a Lot Line
Readjustment Permit shall comply COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT
DIRECTOR DECISION
with all applicable requirements
of Section 60.500.030 Common
APPEAL TO ZONING
Procedures unless modified or BOARD OF APPEALS
supplemented by this Section
60.500.060J. indicates public hearing
b. The Community Development
Director shall approve, approve with conditions, or deny an application for a Lot Line
Readjustment based on the criteria in Subsection 4 below.
Criteria for Lot Line Readjustment Approval
The application may be approved or approved with conditions if the Community Development
Director determines that it complies with the following criteria:
a. Each of the resulting lots will meet the minimum dimensional requirements for the
zoning district in which it is located, as shown in Section 60.400.020 Dimensional
Standards,
b. No additional general utility easements, drainage easements, access easements or
street easements or rights-of way shall be required to provide access or adequate utility
services to any of the resulting lots.
c. No lot or parcel included in the application has been the subject of or included in a
previous Lot Line Readjustment application or decision. The re-subdivision of any lot or
parcel that was subdivided or modified through a Lot Line Readjustment (formerly known
as a Type I Land Subdivision) after January 1, 1992, shall be subject to review and
approval as a Minor Land Subdivision Permit, as described in Section 60.500.060G.
Easement Vacation
The City Engineer, after consultation with any other affected departments or agencies, shall
approve the vacation of any private easement to which the City is not a party if all of the
parties benefitted by the easement consent in writing to its vacation. The City Engineer may
require the applicant for an Easement Vacation to record evidence of the approved vacation.
In the case of easements held by the City, the City Engineer may approve the release of the
easement if the City Engineer determines, after consultation with any other affected
departments or agencies, that the easement is of no further use to the City or that a
replacement easement of equal or greater use to the City shall be recorded.
An approved Easement Vacation does not result in merger or combination of the lots or
parcels on which or along the boundaries of which the easements were located. Merger or
combination of platted lots requires the approval and recording of a Final Plat pursuant to
Section 60.500.040H.
Sign Permit
The City reviews any applications to erect or modify a sign through the Building Permit process.
See Chapter 39 of Rochester Municipal Code, Building Code.
Modification, the Director may require that the applicant instead apply for a Major
Modification pursuant to Section 60.500.070B.
Procedure for a Minor Modification Approval
a. Review of a request for a Minor MINOR MODIFICATION APPROVAL
Modification is not a separate
procedure under this UDC. COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT
Instead, a request for a Minor DIRECTOR DECISION
INCLUDED IN DECISION ON
Modification shall be included in RELATED APPLICATION
the application for other types of
permits or approvals under this
UDC. The request(s) shall be
submitted in writing, for consideration in conjunction with the primary application type.
The written request shall include citation of the standard(s) of this UDC from which
modification is sought.
b. The Community Development Director shall make a decision as to whether an application
for a Minor Modification meets the criteria in this Section 60.500.070A.
c. When the application that contains a request for Minor Modification is to be decided by
an appointed body or City Council pursuant to Table 500.01-1, Summary Table of Review
Procedures, the decision of the Community Development Director shall be incorporated
as part of the application, and the decision of the appointed body or City Council shall be
made on the application as a whole, and shall not reconsider the Minor Modification
decision separately.
d. The Community Development Director’s decision on a requested Minor Modification may
not be appealed separately from the decision on the application to which it is attached.
An individual or organization authorized to file an appeal of the Director’s decision may
list a violation of this Section 60.500.070A as grounds for appealing the decision on the
permit, approval, or authorization that includes the Minor Modification after a final
decision on that permit, approval, or authorization has been made pursuant to this UDC.
Permitted Minor Modifications
A request for a Minor Modification may be submitted only for the types of adjustments listed
in this Section 60.500.070A.4, and the Community Development Director may approve only
those Minor Modifications listed in this Section.
1) The modification will provide options for a more connected neighborhood layout or,
for an adjustment for a residential subdivision, the adjustment will result in a
neighborhood layout and level of multi-modal connectivity equal or better than
would have been required without the adjustment; or
2) The modification will result in equal or better screening and buffering of adjacent
properties and ground and roof mounted equipment than would have been
required without the adjustment; or
3) The modification will not result in a material increase in on-street parking or traffic
congestion on any local street in any Residential zone district within 200 feet of the
applicant’s site; and
e. Does not result in:
1) A change in Permitted or Conditional Uses, or the allowed mix of uses, or the Use-
Specific Standards in Section 60.300.030 applicable to any use in the zoning
district where the property is located.
2) An increase in the number of dwelling units otherwise able to be constructed on the
lot or parcel;
3) A deviation from building or fire codes;
4) A deviation from adopted engineering standards;
5) Requirements for public roadways, utilities, or other public infrastructure or
facilities;
6) A further change to a development standard that has already been modified
through an incentive as described in Section 60.400.120 or through any other
procedure described in this UDC; or
7) A change to any standard or criteria in Section 60.200.040C HPO – Heritage
Preservation Overlay, Section 60.200.040E FPO – Floodplain Overlay, or Section
60.200.040F SDO – Shoreland District Overlay, or any requirement of state or
federal law.
Variance
Purpose
The Variance procedure is intended to allow property owners with unusual lot or site
conditions to request the opportunity to vary standards and criteria in this UDC that cannot
be modified through the Minor Modification or Major Modification procedures, in order to
avoid practical difficulties that would otherwise be created by the strict adherence to the
provisions of this Code, as required in Chapter 462.357 (sub. 6) of the Laws of Minnesota.
Applicability
a. The City shall accept an application for a Variance if the Community Development
Director has determined that neither a Minor Modification nor a Major Modification, nor
any other form of flexibility and/or relief authorized in this UDC is sufficient to mitigate
practical difficulties that would be claimed by the applicant by the strict application of the
standards and criteria in this UDC.
b. The Community Development Director’s determination as to the applicability of the
Variance process may not be appealed separately from an appeal of the decision on the
Variance or other form of relief that the Director determines is applicable.
Procedure for Variance Approval
a. Applications for a Variance shall comply with all requirements of Section 60.500.030
Common Procedures applicable to decisions that require a public hearing before an
appointed body, unless modified or supplemented by this Section 60.500.070C.
b. Any approved Variance is only valid for the proposal outlined in the Variance application.
c. For any Variance application that does not involve the standards or criteria in Section
60.200.040E FPO – Floodplain Overlay, the Zoning Board of Appeals shall, within the
time limits stated in this UDC, approve, approve with conditions, or deny an application
for a Variance of any standard or criteria based on the criteria in Subsection 4 below.
d. Upon filing of an application for a variance to standards or criteria in Section
60.200.040E FPO – Floodplain Overlay, the Community Development Director shall
notify the applicant in writing that construction below the flood protection elevation
increases risks to life and property, and that the issuance of a Variance to construct a
structure below the flood protection elevation will result in increased premium rates for
flood insurance up to amounts as high as $25 for $100 of insurance coverage, and the
Director shall maintain a record of each such notification:
e. Following approval or approval with conditions of a Variance of the standards or criteria
in Section 60.200.040E FPO – Floodplain Overlay, the Community Development Director
shall:
1) Maintain a record of the Variance action, including the justification for its issuance,
and report such Variances issued in the annual report to the Administrator of the
National Flood Insurance Program, when requested by the Federal Emergency
Management Agency; and
2) Submit a copy of the decision and its justification for issuance to the Minnesota
Commissioner of Natural Resources within 10 days of such action.
f. A decision by the Zoning Board of Appeals to approve, approve with conditions, or deny a
Variance may only be appealed to District Court.
g. A Variance and any conditions and safeguards that are made a part of the terms under
which the Variance was granted are binding upon the applicant and any subsequent
purchaser, heir, or assign of the property, and any violation of a variance or its conditions
and safeguards shall be a violation of this UDC.
2) No Variance shall have the effect of allowing in any use prohibited in that district,
permit a lower degree of flood protection than the Regulatory Flood Protection
Elevation for the area, or permit standards lower than those required by State law.
3) No Variance shall result in additional threats to public safety, extraordinary public
expense, create nuisances, cause fraud on or victimization of the public, or conflict
with existing local laws or ordinances.
4) The failure to grant the Variance would result in practical difficulties to the
applicant, not mere inconvenience.
5) The Variance shall be the minimum necessary, considering the flood hazard, to
afford relief.
j. The Board may grant a Variance to the standards in this UDC if it finds that:
1) There has been substantial and detrimental reliance in good faith by an applicant
who has received a permit or certificate issued in error by the administrative official
charged with enforcement of this ordinance, and
2) The mistaken issuance of the certificate or permit is not the result of an action on
the part of the applicant, the property owner, or any other person or party who has
had control of the property, to provide misleading or incorrect information, or to
knowingly withhold information necessary for the administrative official to
accurately review the permit or certificate request.
k. In granting a Variance, the Board may impose such reasonable and appropriate
conditions and safeguards as may be necessary to accomplish the purposes of the
regulations that are to be modified and to reduce or minimize potentially injurious effects
of the Variance upon adjoining properties, the character of the neighborhood, and the
health, safety, or general welfare of the community, provided that any such conditions
are directly related to and roughly proportional to the impact of the Variance.
NONCONFORMITIES
Purpose
The purpose of this Section 60.500.080 is to regulate land uses, buildings, structures, lots, site
features, and signs that were legally established but that do not conform to the requirements of
this UDC as of its effective date or due to later amendments, or have otherwise been rendered
nonconforming due to circumstances that were not self-created. These regulations specify the
circumstances and conditions under which such nonconformities shall be permitted to continue
or expand.
General Authority to Continue
Nonconformities that in general do no harm to the surrounding area may be allowed to
continue and expand based on the regulations of this section, unless an additional limit on
the continuation or expansion of the use is stated in another Section of this UDC or unless
the nonconforming aspect of the property or its use or occupancy is discontinued for a
period of a year or more. In determining whether discontinuance has occurred, the City may
consider utility bills, sales or other tax receipts, evidence of listings for sale or lease, or other
factors indicative of active use, occupancy, and/or operation of the nonconforming aspect of
the property occurred during that period,
Bringing a Nonconformity into Compliance
The owner of a property containing a nonconformity may bring it into compliance with this UDC by
securing all permits and approvals that would have been required for the initial development of
the property. If such permits and approvals are obtained, the applicant may be required to
submit to the City corrected documentation of the property and improvements “as-built.”
Conditions on Nonconformities
The City may attach reasonable conditions on the expansion, reconstruction, replacement, or
improvement of a nonconformity pursuant to Section 60.500.030E.6 Conditions of Approval,
subject to any limitations imposed by Minnesota state law, including but not limited to those
changes to applicable setbacks authorized by Minnesota state law.
Nonconforming Use
Authority to Continue
a. Unless specified otherwise in this Section 60.500.080 or elsewhere in this UDC, the
nonconforming use of land or a structure shall be allowed to continue regardless of any
change in ownership or occupancy of the use, until that use is discontinued or another
provision of this UDC requires the termination of the use. The use may not be enlarged or
expanded to occupy a larger area than was occupied on the effective date of this UDC,
except as specified in Subsection 5 below.
b. Without limiting the generality of Subsection a, any use or occupation of land approved
prior to the Effective Date as a Conditional Use or as a Planned Unit Development shall
be permitted to continue as a lawful use or occupancy. The approved site plan and all
terms, covenants and conditions shall remain in effect and shall continue to control the
use or occupation of such land. Changes or modifications to the use, occupancy, site
design, or interpretations necessary to clarify detail not addressed in the approved plan,
shall be made in accordance with the standards and procedures of this UDC. Where a
Conditional Use or Planned Unit Development has been approved for a site but the
development has not been constructed, the approved plans remain in effect and may be
used to guide the development of the site unless a revised plan is submitted and
approved under this UDC.
Repair and Maintenance
Unless limited by Section 60.500.080F Nonconforming Structure, the structure in which a
nonconforming use is located may be maintained, repaired, restored, improved, or altered
subject to the same requirements for permits and approvals applicable to maintenance and
repair of conforming structures.
c. The continued excavation of a site for which all required permits and approvals have
been granted, after adoption of an ordinance making that use nonconforming, shall not
be considered an expansion of a nonconforming use.
Discontinuance of Nonconforming Use
a. For all properties other than those listed in Subsection b below, any nonconforming use
that is discontinued for a period of one year (or three years if the nonconforming use is
located in a building originally designed as a civic or institutional structure) shall lose its
legal nonconforming status, and any subsequent land use or occupancy shall conform to
all provisions of this UDC, unless the Community Development Director approves a
substitute use pursuant to Subsection 3 above or the Planning Commission approves the
re-establishment of the use after a public hearing based on a determination that there
will not be additional negative impacts to surrounding properties, based on the factors
listed in Subsection 3 above. If the Planning Commission makes such a decision, it can
also permit the re-establishment of the nonconforming use without the correction of
existing building or property nonconformities.
b. If the Director determines that a nonconforming use has been discontinued, the burden
shall be on the applicant to show that it has not been discontinued through the use of
sales tax, business tax, business licenses, property appearance factors, third party
testimony, or other factors.
Damage to Nonconforming Structure
A nonconforming use that does not have a primary structure, or that occupies a conforming
structure that has not been damaged as described in this Section, but that has been
damaged by fire or other natural cause may be repaired, restored, or repaced to the same
condition it occupied prior to the disaster or other damaging event, subject to the following
limitations:
a. If the use has been damaged to the extent of greater than 50 percent of its
estimated market value, as indicated in the records of the Olmsted County Assessor,
the owner must apply for any required permits or approvals necessary to continue
the use or to reconstructed accessory structures within six months of when the
property was damaged.
b. The repaired use may not have a ground floor footprint or a total gross floor area that
is larger, or a height that is taller than it was before the damaging event occurred
unless all nonconformities have been eliminated.
Nonconforming Use Created by Flood District Regulations
a. Where a nonconforming use is created by the standards or criteria in Section
60.200.040E FPO – Floodplain Overlay, and the use is located in a conforming structure,
no request for modification, expansion, or reconstruction of the nonconforming use may
increase the flood damage potential of the use or structure and, if located in a floodway,
may not increase the degree of obstruction to the flood flow, unless otherwise specified
in federal rules and regulations.
60.200.040E.13 shall specifically state the manner in which the nonconforming structure
differs from the flood protection standards and criteria in this UDC.
Nonconforming Lot
A nonconforming lot of record may be used for any land use permitted in the zoning district in
which the lot is located, provided that all other requirements of this UDC are met.
A conforming structure on a nonconforming lot may be enlarged or expanded provided it
meets all of the applicable UDC standards for the zoning district in which the property is
located.
Construction on Nonconforming Lots within SDO – Shoreland District Overlay
a. Lots of record in the office of the County Recorder on February 22, 1995, that are
located in the SDO – Shoreland District Overlay and that do not meet the minimum lot
area and width standards of the underlying zoning district may be allowed as buildable
lots, provided that
1) The use is permitted in the zoning district;
2) The lot has been in separate ownership from abutting lands at all times since it
became substandard;
3) The lot was created in compliance with official controls in effect at the time;
4) All structure and septic system setback distances are met;
5) A Type 1 sewage treatment system consistent with Minnesota Rules, Chapter 7080
can be installed or the lot is connected to a public sewer; and
6) The impervious surface coverage does not exceed 25 percent of the lot.
b. A Variance from setback requirements pursuant to Section 60.500.070C must be
obtained before any use, sewage treatment system, or building permit is issued for a lot.
In evaluating the Variance, the Board of Adjustment shall consider sewage treatment and
water supply capabilities or constraints of the lot and shall deny the variance if adequate
facilities cannot be provided.
c. In a group of two or more contiguous lots of record under a common ownership, an
individual lot must be considered as a separate parcel of land for the purpose of sale or
development if it meets the following requirements:
1) The lot must be at least 66 percent of the minimum dimensional standard for lot
width and lot size for the shoreland classification consistent with Minnesota Rules,
Chapter 6120;
2) The lot must be connected to a public sewer, if available, or must be suitable for
the installation of a Type 1 sewage treatment system consistent with Minnesota
Rules, Chapter 7080, and applicable City sewer treatment standards;
3) Impervious surface coverage must not exceed 25 percent of each lot; and
4) Development of the lot must be consistent with an adopted comprehensive plan.
d. A lot subject to Subsection c above that does not meet the requirements of Subsection c
must be combined with the one or more contiguous lots so they equal one or more
conforming lots to the maximum extent practicable.
e. Notwithstanding Subsection c, contiguous nonconforming lots of record in shoreland
areas under a common ownership must be able to be sold or purchased individually if
each lot contained a habitable residential dwelling at the time the lots came under
common ownership and the lots are suitable for, or served by, a sewage treatment
system consistent with the requirements of Minnesota Statutes 115.55 and Minnesota
Rules, Chapter 7080, or connected to a public sewer.
f. In evaluating all Variances, Zoning and Building Permit applications, or Conditional Use
Permit requests, the decision-making body shall require the property owner to address,
when appropriate, storm water runoff management, reducing impervious surfaces,
increasing setback, restoration of wetlands, vegetative buffers, sewage treatment and
water supply capabilities, and other conservation-designed actions.
g. A portion of a conforming lot may be separated from an existing parcel as long as the
remainder of the existing parcel meets the lot size and sewage treatment requirements
of the zoning district for a new lot and the newly created parcel is combined with an
adjacent parcel.
h. Deck additions may be allowed without a Variance to a structure not meeting the
required setback from the ordinary high water level if all of the following criteria and
standards are met:.
1) The structure existed on the date the structure setbacks were established;
2) A thorough evaluation of the property and structure reveals no reasonable location
for a deck meeting or exceeding the existing ordinary high water level setback of
the structure;
3) The deck encroachment toward the ordinary high water level does not exceed 15
percent of the existing setback of the structure from the ordinary high water level or
does not encroach closer than 30 feet, whichever is more restrictive; and
4) The deck is constructed primarily of wood, and is not roofed or screened.
Nonconforming Site Feature
For purposes of this Section 60.500.080I, nonconforming site features include any failure to
comply with the standards of Section 60.400.060 Landscaping, Bufferyards, and Fences;
Section 60.400.070 Site and Building Design; Section 60.400.080 Parking, Loading, and
Stacking; or Section 60.400.100 Exterior Lighting.
Authority to Continue
Unless specified otherwise in this Section 60.500.080 or elsewhere in this UDC, a lot or
parcel with a nonconforming site feature shall be allowed to continue to be occupied for any
use that is permitted in the zoning district where the structure is located, regardless of any
change in ownership or occupancy of the structure, until another provision of this Section
requires the remediation of the nonconforming site feature.
b. Any billboard or sign in an annexed area that conforms to the applicable billboard or sign
regulations in this UDC at the time of Annexation of Land shall be permitted to continue,
and shall be treated as a conforming sign.
c. Any billboards or signs in annexed areas that did not conform to the regulations of the
public entity previously responsible for administering the location of the billboard or sign
are not authorized to continue. Such billboards and signs are illegal and must be
removed immediately upon notice to the sign owner.
Repair and Maintenance
The maintenance and minor repair of a nonconforming billboard or sign is permitted.
Modification of Nonconforming Sign
a. No nonconforming billboard or sign may be moved in whole or in part to any other
location where it would remain nonconforming.
b. A new nonconforming billboard shall only be erected in compliance with the City’s Sign
Credit program.
1) Erection of a new billboard requires the removal of an equivalent amount of sign
area from an existing billboard. In the case of a billboard with two faces, only the
area removed from one face of the sign shall count towards the area permitted on
a new billboard.
2) Removal of sign area generates a sign credit, valid for two years from date of
issuance.
3) Expired sign credits shall not be restored.
4) A sign permit for the new billboard using the sign credit must be reviewed and
approved by the Community Development Director prior to the expiration of the sign
credits.
5) A sign credit may only be used in a location that meets all standards of this UDC,
including but not limited to Section 60.400.110 Signs.
6) Credits may be transferred between parties.
Removal of Nonconforming Signs by Public Entity
a. If a nonconforming billboard is removed as a result of condemnation initiated by the City,
the sign owner shall be entitled to financial compensation or a sign credit, but not both.
b. The City retains the right to determine whether the sign owner shall receive financial
compensation or a sign credit.
c. If a nonconforming billboard is removed by a public entity other than the City, the sign
owner may receive financial compensation from that public entity, but will not be entitled
to a sign credit.
Obtaining a permit or approval under this UDC through submittal of inaccurate or misleading
information, or through making inaccurate or misleading statements at a public hearing,
regarding the proposed development, the conditions of the land on which the proposed
development is located, or conditions on adjacent parcels.
Obstructing or removing any notice required to be posted or otherwise given under this UDC.
Failure to complete required improvements.
Notification
Whenever a violation of this UDC is known or suspected to exist or expected to be committed,
any person may notify the Community Development Director of the violation. All officers and
agencies of the City shall notify the Community Development Director of any information that
suggests that a violation exists or is expected to be committed.
Investigation of Violations
Upon receiving any information that suggests a violation, the Community Development
Director shall conduct an investigation to determine whether a violation exists or is
reasonably expected to be committed.
The Community Development Director is hereby empowered to cause any building, structure,
or tract of land to be inspected and examined.
Where necessary, the Community Development Director may call upon the Chief of Police for
assistance.
If the Community Development Director determines that it is necessary for the City to employ
the services of any qualified expert to advise in establishing whether or not a violation has
occurred, the expert’s fee shall be paid by the violator if said violation is established,
otherwise it shall be paid by the City.
Notice of Violation
The Community Development Director shall, upon a determination that a violation exists or is
reasonably expected to be committed, promptly give notice by regular mail, or by personal
service to the owners of record for tax purposes of the property involved.
The notice shall indicate the location and nature of the violation, the provision(s) or of the
UDC that have been or are expected to be violated, and whether immediate enforcement will
be sought or up to 30 days allowed to correct or remove the violation.
The Community Development Director may issue a citation for those offenses that are listed
on the local fine and bail schedule by the District Court. A defect in the notice of violation
with respect to any such matters shall not prevent the enforcement of this UDC.
Discontinuance of Work
Once the notice of violation has been served, no work shall proceed on any development covered
by such orders, except in a manner consistent with those orders and this UDC. It shall be a
separate misdemeanor violation for any person to continue any development in a manner
inconsistent with the orders or this UDC.
RULES OF MEASUREMENT
Rounding of Numeral Requirements
The application of UDC standards resulting in fractional requirements shall be treated in the
following way:
Off-Street Parking Spaces
The requirement for a fractional space shall be rounded up to the next whole number,
resulting in the provision of one full space.
Setbacks
a. No rounding of fractional requirements shall occur. When checking actual on-site
measurements, the Community Development Director shall recognize the inherent
difficulty in providing for an exact building location and shall permit minor deviations to
occur as long as the spirit and intent of the UDC is met.
b. Setbacks shall be measured from the wall of an accessory structure.
Density or Floor Area
Calculations resulting in a fractional unit may be rounded up to the next whole number.
Height
No rounding of fractional requirements shall occur. When checking actual on-site
measurements, the Community Development Director shall recognize the inherent difficulties
in establishing final grade lines during construction and shall permit minor deviations to
occur as long as the spirit and intent of the UDC is met.
Plant Materials
Calculations resulting in provision of a fractional plant unit shall be rounded up to the next
whole number.
Parking Space Calculation
The following shall be used in determining the number of off-street parking spaces required.
Floor Area
In the case of office, merchandising and business and personal service uses, “floor area”
shall mean the gross floor area used or intended to be used by tenants for their primary
business activity or for service to the public as customers, patrons, clients, or patients,
including areas occupied by offices, public areas, or the display of merchandise. It shall not
include areas used principally for non-public purposes, such as storage, the incidental repair,
processing, or packaging of merchandise, for show windows, for restrooms, areas devoted to
mechanical equipment, or for dressing rooms.
Places of Public Assembly
In places of public assembly where patrons occupy benches, pews, or other similar seating
facilities, each 20 inches of seating shall be counted as one seat for the purpose of
determining the requirements of off-street parking.
Employee(s)
Reference to “employees on the largest work shift” means the maximum number of
employees employed at the facility regardless of whether such person is a full time
employee. The largest work shift may be a particular day of the week, daily work shift, or
peak period such as the lunch or dinner period in the case of a restaurant.
Capacity
The maximum number of persons that may be accommodated by the use as defined by
building or fire code requirements.
DEFINITIONS
ABUT
To share a common lot line for a distance greater than a point.
ACCESS
A way or means of approach to provide physical vehicular entrance to a property.
ACCESS ROADWAY
A roadway, privately owned and maintained and established on an easement or common area,
providing joint right of access for more than four lots.
ACTIVE LIVING
A way of life that incorporates physical activity into daily routines.
ADULT BOOKSTORE
A business engaging in the barter, rental, or sale of items consisting of printed matter, pictures,
slides, records, audiotapes, videotapes or motion picture film, if such shop is not open to the public
generally but only to one or more classes of the public, excluding any minor by reason of age, or if a
substantial or significant portion of such items are distinguished or characterized by an emphasis on
the depiction or description of “specified sexual activities” or “specified anatomical areas”. The
phrase “substantial or significant portion of such items” as used in the definition of an adult
bookstore means at least 25 percent of the inventory, stock and trade, or publicly displayed
merchandise, or at least 25 percent of the floor area of the business (not including storerooms,
stock areas, bathrooms, basement or any portion of the business not open to the public).
ADULT CABARET
An establishment that provides dancing or other live entertainment, if such establishment excludes
minors by virtue of age (except any business licensed under Rochester Code of Ordinance Chapter
125A) or if such dancing or other live entertainment is distinguished or characterized by an
emphasis on the performance, dedication, or description of “specified sexual activities” or “specified
anatomical areas.”
ADULT ENTERTAINMENT
Adult bookstores, adult motion pictures theaters, adult mini-motion picture theaters, adult massage
parlors, adult saunas, adult companionship establishments, adult health clubs, adult cabarets, adult
novelty businesses, adult motion picture arcades, adult modeling studios, adult hotels or motels,
adult body painting studios, and other adult establishments.
ADULT ESTABLISHMENT
A business that is conducted exclusively for the patronage of adults and specifically excludes minors
from patronage either by law or by the operators of such business and offers its patrons services or
entertainment characterized by an emphasis on matter depicting, exposing, describing, discussing,
or relating to specified sexual activities or specified anatomical areas.
ADULT HOTEL
A hotel that specifically excludes minors from patronage and wherein material is presented that is
distinguished or characterized by an emphasis on matter depicting, describing, or relating to
specified sexual activities or specified anatomical areas.
description of “specified sexual activities” or “specified anatomical areas” for observation by patrons
therein.
ADULT SAUNA
A sauna as defined in Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 115, that excludes minors by reason of
age, or provides a steam bath or heat bathing room used for the purpose of bathing, relaxation, or
reducing, using steam or hot air as a cleaning, relaxing or reducing agent, if the service provided by
the sauna is distinguished or characterized by an emphasis on “specified sexual activities” or
“specified anatomical areas”.
AFFECTED PARTY
For purposes of this UDC, the phrase includes any applicant, the owner or occupant of the property
under consideration if different from the applicant, and any owners of adjacent properties who are
entitled to receive a notice of public hearing or a notice of action for the application involved. An
individual may qualify as an affected party upon showing that he owns, controls, leases, or otherwise
has an interest in property that will be substantially and directly affected by a proposal and that is
located within 350 feet of the boundary of the property involved in the proposal.
AGRICULTURE PRODUCTION
Establishments engaged in the production of crops, plants, or vines, including forestry, and the
incidental sale of produce raised on the premises to individuals, or establishments in existence on
January 1, 1992 that are engaged in the keeping, grazing, or feeding of livestock for sale, value
increase, or livestock increase. This use also includes establishments that provide support to the
agricultural community including but not limited to those engaged in elevators, soil preparation
services, crop services, farm management services, breeding services, experimental farms for
research or educational services, and small scale farm product processing such as cider mills,
dairies, poultry, or meat processing, and commercial stable operations, including riding stables, but
not including any use meeting the definition of Agricultural Retail.
AGRICULTURE RETAIL
Establishments and related land areas that are primarily engaged in providing services related to or
conducting the sale at retail of farm equipment sales and repair, farm produce sales and supply,
horticulture and floriculture products, including nurseries, greenhouses, and other places used to
raise flowers, shrubs, and plants for later retail or wholesale; lawn and garden services; ornamental
shrub and tree services. These enterprises typically produce their own stock, unlike a garden center
that imports from other establishments the products it sells at retail.
AIRPORT-RELATED DEFINITONS
When used in the context of regulating airports, the following terms shall have the definitions shown
below.
AIR TRANSPORTATION
Establishments engaged in domestic, emergency, or foreign transportation of passengers or
goods by air, including airports, flying fields, rotorcraft terminals, and any associated terminal
facilities.
AIRPORT
The Rochester International Airport located in the City, and High Forest Township, Olmsted
County, Minnesota.
AIRPORT ELEVATION
The established elevation of the highest point on the usable landing area where elevation is
established to be 1317 feet above mean sea level.
AIRPORT HAZARD
Any structure, tree, or use of land that obstructs the air space required for, or is otherwise
hazardous to, the flight of aircraft in landing or taking off at the airport; and any use of land that
is hazardous to persons or property because of its proximity to the airport.
APPROACH AREA
All land directly or vertically under the approach surfaces as specified in the APO district
regulations.
LANDING AREA
The area of the airport used for the landing, taking off, or taxiing of aircraft.
RUNWAY
Any existing or planned paved surface or turf covered area of the airport that is specifically
designated and used or planned to be used for the landing and/or taking off of aircraft.
UTILITY RUNWAY
A runway that is constructed for and intended to be used by propeller driven aircraft of 12,500
pounds maximum gross weight and less.
VISUAL RUNWAY
A runway intended solely for the operation of aircraft using visual approach procedures, with no
straight in instrument approach procedure and no instrument designation indicated on an
approved planning document.
AISLE
As used in regulations related to parking, a traveled way in a parking lot by which cars enter and
depart parking spaces.
ALCOHOLIC BEVERAGE
Any beverage containing more than one-half of one percent alcohol by volume.
ALLEY
A public or private street primarily designed to serve as secondary access to the site or rear of those
properties whose primary frontage is on some other street.
ANIMAL FEEDLOTS
A lot or building or combination of lots and buildings intended for the confined feeding, breeding,
raising, or holding of animals exceeding 10 animal units and specifically designated as a
confinement area where manure may accumulate, or where the concentration of animals is such
that a vegetative cover cannot be maintained within the enclosure. A pasture shall not be considered
an animal feedlot.
ANIMAL HUSBANDRY
The keeping of domestic animals, such as horses, dogs, cats, bees, not primarily for produce or value
increase but rather for show, sport, or as pets.
ANIMAL UNIT
A unit of measure used to compare differences in the production of animal manure that employs as
a standard the amount of manure produced on a regular basis by different types of animals. For
purposes of this UDC, the animal unit or animal unit calculation measure shall be the same unit of
measure currently used by the Minnesota Pollution Control Agency in Chapter 7020 of the Minnesota
Rules relating to animal feedlots and storage, transportation, and use of animal manure.
ARCADE
A covered passageway, typically found at street level and often comprised of a series of arches
supported by columns, which is accessible and open to the public.
ARCHERY RANGE
An area or facility designated or operated primarily for the use of an archer, bow and arrow, long
bow, recurve bow, compound bow, or crossbow.
ARTISAN MANUFACTURING
Application, teaching, making, or fabrication of crafts or products by an artist, artisan, or craftsperson
either by hand or with minimal automation and may include direct sales to consumers, in a facility
not exceeding 10,000 square feet in gross floor area. This definition includes uses such as small-
scale fabrication, manufacturing, and other industrial uses and processes typically not permitted in
non-industrial zoning districts such as welding and sculpting.
AUTOMOTIVE CENTER
An establishment that is engaged in both the retail sales of a limited or full range of vehicle parts
and fuels and the repair and maintenance of automobiles and light trucks. Self-service, automated,
or full service car washes as a primary use of property are included in this.
AUTOMOTIVE DEALERSHIP
An establishment engaged in the retail sale, leasing, repair and servicing of automobiles and light
trucks, where vehicles for sale are on display in a showroom or on a lot for the traveling public.
AWNING
A fixed or retractable shelter projecting from and supported by the exterior wall of a building
constructed of non-rigid materials on a supporting framework, often made of wood, cloth, vinyl, or
other flexible material.
BALCONY
A porch or other partially enclosed exterior platform designed for outdoor use attached to the upper
floors of a building.
BAR OR TAVERN
An establishment primarily engaged in the selling of drinks for consumption on the premises, where
entertainment and the incidental sale of prepared food for consumption on the premises are
permitted accessory uses. These establishments may charge a fee or admission charge for the
entertainment provided. Included in this category are bars, beer gardens, discotheques, night clubs,
taverns, hookah bars, and dance halls.
BASEMENT
Any area of a structure, including crawl spaces, having its floor or base subgrade (below ground
level) on all four sides, regardless of the depth of excavation below ground level.
BEDROOM
In a multifamily or attached dwelling, a private room planned and intended for sleeping, separated
from other rooms by a door, and accessible to a bathroom without crossing another bedroom or
other living area.
BIKEWAY
A Bikeway shall mean either of the following:
Bicycle Lane
A portion of the roadway designated for bicycles by striping, signage, and/or pavement markings
for preferential or exclusive use of bicycles. Bike lanes must be located on both sides of the
road to accommodate bicyclists traveling in the same direction as the adjacent vehicular lane.
Bicycle Path
A facility physically separated from the roadway and intended for bicycle use. A bicycle path is
designed for the use of two lane, two-way bicycle traffic. Paths may be located within open
space through a development, along an abandoned rail line or adjacent to an existing road.
BLANK WALL
A wall (including building façades and retaining walls) if it meets any of the following:
1. A wall or portion of a wall with a surface area of at least 400 square feet having both a length
and a width of at least 10 feet without a transparent window or door, building modulation at
least one foot in depth, or other architectural feature;
2. Any portion of a wall between three and 13 feet above ground level with a horizontal
dimension longer than 15 feet without a window, door, building modulation at least one foot
in depth, or other architectural feature including art work (such as mosaic, mural, sculpture,
or relief), or qualifying landscaping. Qualifying landscaping includes a landscape planting bed
at least five feet wide or a raised planter bed at least two feet high and three feet wide in
front of the wall with planting materials that are sufficient to obscure or screen at least 35
percent of the wall’s surface within three years.
BLOCK
A parcel or group of parcels forming a unit of land bounded on all sides by a street or other
transportation routes or by physical barriers such as water, or public open space.
BLUFF
A topographic feature such as a hill, cliff, or embankment having the following characteristics (an
area with an average slope of less than 18 percent over a distance for 50 feet or more shall not be
considered part of the bluff):
1. Part or all of the feature is located in a shoreland area;
2. The slope rises at least 25 feet above the ordinary high water level of the waterbody;
3. The grade or slope from the toe of the bluff to a point 25 feet or more above the ordinary
high water level averages 30 percent or greater; and
4. The slope must drain toward the waterbody.
BLUFF, TOP OF
The higher point of a 50-foot segment with an average slope exceeding 18 percent.
BOARD OF APPEALS
The Zoning Board of Appeals of the City of Rochester, Minnesota.
BOULEVARD
That portion of the right-of-way outside the vehicle travel lanes that may contain sidewalks,
landscaped area, infrastructure, or amenities.
BUFFERYARD
A unit of yard together with the plantings required thereon designed to mitigate nuisance between
adjacent land uses or between a land use and a public street.
BUILD-TO LINE
The line at which construction of a building, excluding porches, bay windows, covered porches,
decks, and patios, is to occur on a lot. A build-to line typically runs parallel to the front property line
and is established to create an even building façade line on a street.
BUILDABLE AREA
The area of a lot remaining after the minimum yard or setback requirements of this UDC have been
met.
BUILDING
Any structure used or intended for supporting or sheltering any occupancy. Where roofed structures
are separated from each other by party walls having no openings for passage, each portion so
separated shall be deemed a separate building.
BUILDING CODE
Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapter 50.
BUILDING FRONT
The wall of a building that faces the front lot line of a lot.
BUILDING LINE
A line parallel to the front lot line at a distance equal to the minimum depth of the front yard required
for the zoning district where the lot is located.
BUILDING PERIMETER
The horizontal distance measured along those walls from which, when viewed from above, lines
drawn perpendicular to the wall will intersect a lot line without intersecting another wall of the
building.
BUILDING, PRIMARY
A building in which is conducted, or that is intended to be conducted, the primary use of the lot on
which it is located.
BUILDING, TEMPORARY
See Structure, Temporary
shops, clothing rental, tattoo or piercing parlor, photographic studios, cleaning and garment services
(but not including power laundries or dry cleaning plants), coin operated laundries, advertising and
mailing, building maintenance, office equipment rental and leasing, photo finishing, business supply
services computer programming/data processing services, locksmiths, and repair of business or
household goods and equipment generally weighing less than 25 pounds.
BUSINESS CENTER
A building or group of buildings planned, constructed, and managed as a single entity, and generally
with common on-site parking for a group of commercial, office, or service establishments.
BUSINESS PARK
A development planned as a total entity for a group of commercial, light industrial, office or service
establishments with coordinated standards for lighting, sign, grading, landscaping, and storage and
with development-level controls on trip generation.
CALIPER
A nursery stock measurement in inches of tree trunk diameter used to standardize plant size. Trunk
caliper for trees up to four inches is to be measured six inches above the soil line and trees greater
than four inches in caliper are measured 12 inches above the soil line.
CAMPGROUND OR RV PARK
An establishment engaged in providing overnight or short-term sites for the placement of
recreational vehicles or temporary housing, with or without facilities such as water and electricity.
This does not include long-term storage or Recreational Vehicles.
CAPACITY
The maximum number of persons that may be accommodated by a development as determined by
building code or fire code requirements.
CARNIVAL OR FESTIVAL
A temporary festival typically offering amusement rides, variety shows, or other entertainment.
CARPORT
A shelter for one or more automotive vehicles that is open on at least two sides, formed by a roof
projecting from the side of a building or a detached structure of the same type.
CEMETERY
Land used or intended to be used for the burial of the dead, including animals, and dedicated for
cemetery purposes. Permitted uses include a columbarium, mausoleum, or crematorium.
CERTIFICATE OF APPROPRIATENESS
A permit issued by the Heritage Preservation Commission granting an applicant approval for the
alteration, change, demolition, relocation, excavation, or new construction of a structure within a
local historic or conservation district.
CHAIN-LINK FENCE
A fence of steel or aluminum posts and wires woven into a diamond pattern that may have a
galvanized, painted or vinyl coated exterior finish.
CHANGE OF USE
A use that differs from the previous use of a building or land in terms of major retail product mix,
services offered, production methods, type, or intensity of residential use.
CHILD
An individual who has not reached 18 years of age.
CITY
The incorporated City of Rochester, Olmsted County, state of Minnesota.
CITY ENGINEER
The individual designated as the city engineer by the Public Works Director.
CLINIC
An establishment engaged in the care, diagnosis, and treatment of sick, ailing, infirm and injured
persons, and those in need of medical, dental, vision, and/or surgical attention, but who are not
provided with board or room, nor kept overnight on the premises.
COLLEGE OR UNIVERSITY
An institution other than a trade school that provides full-time or part-time education beyond high
school.
COMMISSION
Unless the context clearly indicates otherwise, “Commission” means The Planning Commission of
the City of Rochester, Minnesota.
COMMISSIONER
Unless the context clearly indicates otherwise, “Commissioner” means the Commissioner of the
Department of Natural Resources of the City of Rochester, Minnesota.
COMMON DRIVEWAY
A driveway shared and used jointly to provide access to two or more residential or Non-Residential
properties.
COMMUNICATIONS TOWER
A tower structure and related equipment enabling the transmission of electronic signals via wired
and wireless means, but not including any use meeting the definition of a Commercial Wireless
Telecommunications Service.
COMMUNITY CENTER
A building or portion of a building used for nonprofit, cultural, educational, recreational, religious, or
social activities that is open to the public or a designated part of the public, usually owned and
operated by a public or nonprofit group or agency.
COMMUNITY GARDEN
The cultivation of food and/or horticultural crops, composting, aquaponics, aquaculture and/or
hydroponics including but not limited to gardens, container gardens, edible landscapes, residential
greenhouses, herb gardens, rooftop gardens, berry patches, vegetable gardens. All of which may
include the production and sale of food products from food grown on the premises. Community
Garden may be divided into separate plots for cultivation by one or more individuals or may be
farmed collectively by members of the group and may include common areas maintained and used
by group members.
COMPREHENSIVE PLAN
The adopted goals, policy statements, standards, programs, and maps for guiding the physical,
social, and economic development, both public and private, of the City and its environs, including.
any unit or part of such plan separately adopted, and as amended by City Council.
CONGREGATE HOUSING
A dwelling providing shelter and services that may include meals, housekeeping, personal care
assistance and minor medical services, but not intermediate, long term or extended nursing care for
residents. Congregate housing does not fall within the Fair Housing Amendments Act (FHAA), nor
does it meet the definition of any other group living use.
CONTIGUOUS
Next to, abutting, or touching and having a boundary, or portion thereof, tis coterminous.
CORNICE
A horizontal decorative projection located at the top of a building near the roof line, which may
include a roof overhang.
CORRECTIONAL FACILITY
A building along with associated lot area designed for the confinement of individuals for the purpose
of discipline or punishment or incarceration of convicted criminals.
COUNCIL
The City Council of the City of Rochester, Minnesota.
COUNTY
The County of Olmsted, Minnesota.
CRAWL SPACE
A low space below the first story of a building, where there has not been excavation deep enough for
a basement, but where there is space for installation of and service to pipes, ducts, and utilities.
CURB
A stone, asphalt, or concrete boundary marking the edge of a roadway or paved area.
DECIBEL (dB)
A unit of sound pressure level, abbreviated as dB.
DECK
A structure open to the sky that is attached to or abuts the wall of a dwelling and is afforded access
to the interior of the dwelling through one or more doors. Structures 30 inches or more above grade
are considered accessory structures, while structures lower to the ground are considered permitted
projections into required yards.
DECORAH EDGE
3. Where there are contiguous adjacent areas with the Cummingsville or higher (Stewartville or
Prosser) formations as the first-encountered bedrock. An area for which the first-encountered
bedrock is the Decorah Shale, Platteville Limestone, or Glenwood Shale, that is separated
from the Cummingsville or higher formations by a topographic saddle and is at a higher
elevation than the saddle, is excluded from the Decorah Edge. For purposes of the DEO
district, the term "saddle" means a ridge between two peaks or summits
DEDICATION
The transfer of property interests from private to public ownership for a public purpose.
DEMOLITION PERMIT
A building permit that authorizes the demolition or removal of an existing building or structure from a
site.
DEPENDENT
A child or individual with a mental or physical disability.
DEVELOPMENT
Any man-made change to improved or unimproved real estate, including a change in use or the
creation of a subdivision.
DEVELOPMENT SITE
A plot of land that is intended or suitable for a proposed servicing of unimproved land or the
improvement of previously developed land and for which there is the proposed construction of any
improvement, new buildings or renovation, or significant change of existing buildings to
accommodate a new land use or increased density of a land use and for which City approvals are
required.
DORMITORY
A multifamily dwelling designed primarily as housing for, or likely to be occupied by, undergraduate
or post-graduate students.
DRAINAGEWAY
A above-ground channel that provides for the collection and conveyance of stormwater runoff from a
watershed area of over 1,200 acres in size, that is not part of a designated floodplain. The area of
the drainageway shall be calculated as that area needed to convey the water of a 100 year rainfall
within the watershed.
DRIVE-IN FACILITY
An accessory use that by design, physical facilities, service, or by packaging procedures encourages
or permits customers to receive services or obtain goods while remaining in their motor vehicles, but
not including any use meeting the definition of Outdoor Entertainment or Recreation.
DRIVEWAY
A private minor vehicular access between a street or roadway and a designated off-street parking
area.
DWELLING, ATTACHED
A building containing three or more dwelling units arranged side by side, separated from each other
by a firewall and having separate direct means of egress and ingress to each unit from the outside.
DWELLING, DUPLEX
A building on a single lot containing two dwelling units.
DWELLING, FOURPLEX
A single building on a single lot containing four dwelling units under one roof, each of which is
occupied by one family.
DWELLING, LIVE/WORK
A dwelling unit containing an integrated living and working space in different areas of the unit, and in
which the dwelling areas are located above or behind the working space, in order to allow the ground
floor working space at the front of the building to serve patrons or customers.
DWELLING, MULTIFAMILY
A building containing five or more dwelling units on a single lot, including but not limited to
apartments, cooperative apartments, and condominiums. Regardless of how rental units are
equipped, any multifamily dwelling in which units are available for rental periods of one week or less
shall be considered a hotel or motel.
DWELLING UNIT
A single unit providing complete, independent living facilities for one or more persons, including
permanent provisions for living, sleeping, eating, cooking, and sanitation.
DWELLING, TRIPLEX
A single building on a single lot containing three primary dwelling units under one roof, each of which
is occupied by one family.
DWELLING, TWIN-HOME
A building containing one dwelling unit attached to one other building containing only one dwelling,
with each building on a separate lot.
EARTH BERMED
Buildings constructed so that there is earth covering on above grade portion of building walls and no
earth covering on the roof. The total amount of the earth covering is less than 50 percent of the walls
and roof surface area.
EARTH SHELTERED
Buildings constructed so that more than 50 percent of the exterior surface area of the building,
excluding garages and other accessory buildings, is covered with earth and the building code
standards promulgated pursuant to Minn. Stat. Ch. 16.85 are satisfied. Partially completed buildings
shall not be considered earth sheltered.
EASEMENT
A grant of one or more of the property rights by the property owner to and for use by the public, a
corporation, or another individual or entity.
EASEMENT, DRAINAGE
An easement required for the installation of stormwater sewers or surface drainage channels, or the
preservation or maintenance of a natural stream or watercourse.
EASEMENT, UTILITY
An easement required for the installation of overhead or underground utilities, including but not
limited to sanitary sewer, water, electric, gas, and audio or visual communication lines.
EMERGENCY SERVICE
An establishment engaged in providing police, fire, ambulance services or related emergency first aid
services.
ESTABLISHMENT
An economic unit, generally at a single physical location, where business is conducted, services
provided, or industrial operations performed.
EXCAVATION
The artificial removal of earth material.
EXCAVATION ACTIVITIES
Activities involving Substantial Land Alteration, Quarry, or Sand or Gravel Excavation.
CUTOFF
The point at which all light rays emitted by a lamp, light source, or luminaire are completely
eliminated (cutoff) at a specific angle above the ground.
CUTOFF ANGLE
The maximum angle formed by a line drawn in the direction of emitted light rays at the light
source and a line perpendicular to the ground from the light source.
CUTOFF-TYPE LUMINAIRE
A luminaire with elements such as shields, reflector, or refractor panels that direct and cut off
the light at a cutoff angle that is less than 90 degrees.
FOOT CANDLE
A unit of illumination produced on a surface, all points of which are one foot from a uniform
point source of one candle.
GLARE
The brightness of light source that causes eye discomfort.
LUMINAIRE
A complete lighting unit consisting of a light source and all necessary mechanical, electrical and
decorative parts.
EXTERIOR WOOD
The heartwood from species of wood having natural resistance to decay, including redwood, cedars,
and black locust; grades of lumber that contain sapwood from species of wood having a natural
resistance to decay, including redwood and cedars; or treated wood.
FAÇADE
The exterior walls of a building exposed to public view from a public street. The wall visible from a
public street or parking lot and used for the main public access or that has distinguishing
architectural features will be considered the primary façade. A wall that is visible from a public street
or parking lot serving the business center but not the main access to the building is considered the
secondary façade.
FAMILY
Family is defined as:
4. One or more individuals related by blood, marriage, or adoption, including foster children,
5. A group of not more than five persons, some or all of whom are not related by blood,
marriage, or adoption, occupying a single dwelling unit or manufactured home, or
6. Any group of people whose right to live together as a household is protected by the Federal
Fair Housing Amendments Act as amended and interpreted by the courts.
FENCE
An artificially constructed barrier of any material or combination of materials erected to enclose or
screen areas of land.
FILL
A deposit of earth material placed by artificial means.
FINANCIAL INSTITUTION
A facility that provides financial and banking services to individuals and businesses. These services
may include deposit banking and closely related functions such as making loans, investments, check
cashing, and fiduciary activities. Accessory uses may include automatic teller machines and offices.
FIREARM
A gun including but not limited to pistols, revolvers, rifles, muzzleloaders, and shotguns that
discharges shot or a projectile by means of an explosive, a gas, or compressed air.
FITNESS CENTER
An Indoor Entertainment or Recreation use consisting of a building or portion of a building designed
and equipped for the conduct of exercise in a place with facilities and equipment for people to
maintain or improve their physical fitness, operated for profit or not-for-profit, and that can be open
only to bona fide members and guests of the organization, or open to the public for a fee with limited
hours.
FLAG LOT
A lot that has only sufficient frontage on a street to comply with the required access width
requirements of this UDC, shaped in such a manner that the portion of the lot closest to the street
can only be used for access purposes and not as yard or buildable area, and whose width some
distance back from the right-of-way is sufficient to provide adequate space to meet yard or setback
requirements. Only that portion of the lot of adequate width to meet lot width requirements or allow
for provision of adequate yards or setback shall be counted as part of the lot area.
AO ZONE
An area of shallow flooding shown on the City’s Flood Insurance Rate Map (FIRM) with base
flood depths from one to three feet where a clearly defined channel does not exist, where the
path of flooding is unpredictable and undetermined, and where low velocity flow may be evident.
CRITICAL FACILITIES
Facilities necessary to a community’s public health and safety, those that store or produce
highly volatile, toxic or water-reactive materials, and those that house occupants that may be
insufficiently mobile to avoid loss of life or injury. Examples of critical facilities include hospitals,
correctional facilities, schools, daycare facilities, nursing homes, fire and police stations,
wastewater treatment facilities, public electric utilities, water plants, fuel storage facilities, and
waste handling and storage facilities.
FARM FENCE
An open type of fence of posts and horizontally run wire, further defined by Minnesota Statutes,
Section 344.02, Subd. 1(a-d), that is not considered to be a structure for purposes of floodplain
regulation. Fences that have the potential to obstruct flood flows, such as chain link fences and
rigid walls, are regulated as structures for purposes of floodplain regulation.
FLOOD FRINGE
That portion of the floodplain outside of the floodway. Flood fringe is synonymous with the term
"floodway fringe" used in the Flood Insurance Study.
FLOODPLAIN
The land adjacent to a body of water that has been or may be hereafter covered by flood water
including that land covered by the regional flood.
FLOOD PROOFING
Any combination of structural and nonstructural additions, changes or adjustments to structures
and properties that reduce or eliminate flood damage to real estate, water and sanitary
facilities, structures, and their contents.
FLOOD, REGIONAL
A flood that is representative of large floods known to have occurred generally in Minnesota and
reasonably characteristic of what can be expected to occur on an average frequency in the
magnitude of the 100 year recurrence interval. Regional flood is synonymous with the term
"base flood" used in the Flood Insurance Study.
FLOODWAY
The minimum channel of a watercourse and those portions of the floodplain adjoining the
channel, that are reasonably required to carry or store the regional flood discharge.
FREEBOARD
A factor of safety usually expressed in feet above a design flood level for flood protective or
control works. (Freeboard is intended to compensate for the many unknown factors that could
contribute to flood heights greater than the height calculated for a selected flood or floodway
condition such as wave action, bridge opening and floodway obstructions resulting from debris
or ice, and the hydrologic effects of urbanization of the watershed).
LOWEST FLOOR
The lowest floor of the lowest enclosed area (including basement). An unfinished or flood
resistant enclosure, used solely for parking of vehicles, building access, or storage in an area
other than a basement area, is not considered a building’s lowest floor; provided, that such
enclosure is not built so as to render the structure in violation of the applicable non-elevation
design requirements of 44 Code of Federal Regulations, Part 60.3.
OBSTRUCTION
Any dam, wall, wharf, embankment, levee, dike, pile, abutment, projection, excavation, channel
modification, culvert, building, wire, fence, stockpile, refuse, fill, structure, or matter in, along,
across, or projecting into any channel, watercourse, or regulatory floodplain that may impede,
retard, or change the direction of the flow of water, either in itself or by catching or collecting
debris carried by such water.
SUBSTANTIAL DAMAGE
For purposes of floodplain regulation, damage of any origin sustained by a structure where the
cost of restoring the structure to its before damaged condition would equal or exceed 50
percent of the market value of the structure before the damage occurred.
SUBSTANTIAL IMPROVEMENT
For purposes of floodplain regulation, within any consecutive 365-day period, any
reconstruction, rehabilitation (including normal maintenance and repair), repair after damage,
addition, or other improvement of a structure, the cost of which equals or exceeds 50 percent of
the market value of the structure before the “start of construction” of the improvement. This
term includes structures that have incurred “substantial damage,” regardless of the actual
repair work performed. The term does not include either:
1. Any project for improvement of a structure to correct existing violations of state or local
health, sanitary, or safety code specifications that have been identified by the local code
enforcement official and that are the minimum necessary to assure safe living
conditions; or
2. Any alteration of a “historic structure,” provided that the alteration will not preclude the
structure’s continued designation as a “historic structure.” For the purpose of the
floodplain regulations in this UDC, “historic structure” is as defined in 44 Code of
Federal Regulations, Part 59.1.
FUELING STATION
A facility where fuels like diesel, gasoline, ethanol, natural gas, electricity, and hydrogen; related
supplies for motorists; and convenience foods and goods are sold. All services included in
Automotive Center are excluded.
FUEL TANK
A safe container for flammable fluids.
FUNERAL HOME
An establishment providing services such as preparing the human or animal dead for burial,
cremating human remains, and arranging and managing funerals, and for which permitted accessory
uses include a crematorium.
FRONTAGE
The distance that a lot line coincides with the right-of-way line of a public street or the boundary of a
private street.
GARAGE
A detached accessory building or a portion of a primary building used for the parking and storage of
vehicles, merchandise, or equipment, and that is not a separate commercial establishment open to
the general public. When associated with a residential use in a residential district, it shall be limited
to use for parking and storage of vehicles, noncommercial trailers, and household equipment.
GARAGE SALE
The sale of used household belongings at a residential dwelling or residential neighborhood
including but not limited to “home sale,” “estate sale,” “attic sale,” and “basement sale” and any
other type of residential sale of tangible personal property.
GARDEN CENTER
A retail business for the display and sale of products either inside or outside of a building or
structure. The products for retail sale that may be displayed and stored in a greenhouse or outdoors
include those products related to gardening and landscaping including, but not limited to, outdoor
live plants; landscaping materials such as lawn ornaments, pavers, and landscape walls; bulk
materials such as mulch, topsoil, rock, and gravel; gardening supplies such as fertilizer, pesticides,
and small hand tools. Related retails sales may also be part of a garden center including cut flowers,
indoor live plants, Christmas trees and related retail products. Landscaping services may be a part of
the garden center. Greenhouses or retail buildings and offices may be part of a permanent garden
center.
GRADE
The lowest point of elevation of the finished surface of the ground, paving or sidewalk within the area
between the building and the property line, or between the building and a stabilization structure such
as a retaining wall, or, where the property line or structure is more than five feet from the building,
between the building and a line five feet from the building.
GRADING
Any excavation or fill combination of those activities.
GRADING PLAN
An integrated set of documents that addresses how a proposed development will comply with the
requirements of part 50.01 (2) of the Building Code.
GREENHOUSE
A building whose roof and sides are made largely of glass or other transparent or translucent
material and in which the temperature and humidity can be regulated for the cultivation of delicate
or out-of-season plants for subsequent sale, for personal enjoyment, or for the temporary storage or
display of plant material.
HABITABLE ROOM
A room used or intended to be used for sleeping, cooking, living, or eating purposes, excluding such
enclosed spaces as closets, pantries, bath or toilet facilities, service rooms, corridors, laundries,
unfinished attics, foyers, storage space, utility rooms or similar spaces.
HABITABLE UNIT
A habitable room, singularly or in combination with other rooms, that provides sleeping facilities
alone or in combination with required cooking, eating, or living facilities.
ALTER OR ALTERATION
A change to the exterior of an existing building, structure, site, or feature that materially
modifies its appearance or construction.
CERTIFICATE OF APPROPRIATENESS
A permit issued granting an applicant approval for the alteration, change, demolition, relocation,
excavation, or new construction of a designated property or within a designated historic district.
CONTRIBUTING PROPERTY
A building, site, structure, or object that adds to the historic architectural qualities or
archaeological values for which a property or landmark district is considered significant.
DEMOLITION
Any act or process that destroys in part or in whole a historic resource. This includes the removal
of any material constituting part of a structure that affects the exterior appearance of the
structure, other than for purposes of ordinary maintenance or repair, as well as inadequate
maintenance or any other action that reduces the stability or longevity of a structure or impairs
its historic or architectural integrity.
DEMOLITION BY NEGLECT
The long-term neglect of a historic structure that contributes to a level of dilapidation so severe
that rehabilitation of the structure no longer serves as a viable option and demolition must be
considered on account of the public health, safety, and welfare.
DESIGNATED PROPERTY
A property designated by the City Council as a landmark property, a landmark district, or
contributing to a landmark district.
DESIGNATION
The formal process described in Section 60.500.040F, Designation of Landmark Property or
Landmark District, to recognize a property as historically significant and eligible for benefits,
subject to the terms of this UDC.
EMERGENCY REPAIR
Work necessary to prevent destruction or dilapidation to real property or structural
appurtenances thereto immediately threatened or damaged by fire, flood, tornado, or other
disaster
HISTORIC INTEGRITY
The ability of a property to convey its significance relative to the aspects of location, setting,
design, materials, workmanship, and association.
HISTORIC RESOURCE
Properties including objects, buildings, structures, sites, landscapes, and districts subject to the
provisions of Section 60.200.040C HPO – Heritage Preservation Overlay or related procedures
in Chapter 60.500 Procedures and Administration.
HISTORIC SIGNIFICANCE
The documented importance of a property or feature for its contribution to or representation of
broad patterns of national, regional, or local history, architecture, engineering, archaeology, and
culture.
HISTORIC SITE
The location of a significant event, a prehistoric or historic occupation or activity or a building or
structure, whether standing, ruined, or vanished, where the location itself possesses historic,
cultural, or archaeological value regardless of the value of any existing structure.
INVENTORY
A list of properties identified by the Heritage Preservation Commission that may be evaluated for
historic significance and designation as a landmark at a future time and that has interim
protection if an application for a Demolition Permit is submitted.
LANDMARK
A district, site, building, structure, object, or other property of historic significance designated
locally pursuant to Section 60.500.040F.
LANDMARK OBJECT
A construction other than a building or structure that is small in scale and simply constructed or
primarily artistic in nature. It may be movable by nature or by design, but is associated with a
specific setting and environment.
PRESERVATION
Active maintenance and repair of existing historic materials and retention of a property's form as
it has evolved over time, which is one of four approaches to the Secretary of Interior Standards.
RECONSTRUCTION
The act or process of depicting, by means of new construction, the form, features, and detailing
of a non-surviving site, landscape, building, structure, or object for the purpose of replicating its
appearance at a specific period of time, which is one of four approaches to the Secretary of
Interior Standards.
REHABILITATION
Altering a property to meet continuing or changing uses while retaining the property's historic
character-defining features, which is one of four approaches to the Secretary of Interior
Standards.
RELOCATION
Moving a building or structure from its original historically significant or existing location to
another location.
REPAIR
The limited replacement in kind, or with compatible substitute material, of extensively
deteriorated or missing parts of features.
RESTORATION
Alteration of a property to depict the property at a particular period of time in its history, while
removing evidence of other periods, which is one of four approaches to the Secretary of Interior
Standards.
RESTORE
The act or process of accurately depicting the form, features, and character of a property as it
appeared at a particular period of time by means of the removal of features from other periods
in its history and reconstruction of missing features from the restoration period.
HOME OCCUPATION
Any gainful occupation or profession engaged in by the occupant of a dwelling unit at or from the
dwelling unit.
HOTEL OR MOTEL
A building or series of buildings operated as an establishment providing accommodations in
habitable units by prior arrangements, for compensation, without restriction on the time period
involved. Regardless of how rental units are equipped, any Multifamily Dwelling in which units are
available for rental periods of one week or less shall be considered a hotel or motel.
HOUSING CODE
Rochester Code of Ordinances Chapters 32 through 38.
INDUSTRY, HEAVY
An establishment involved in the manufacture, fabrication, processing, compounding, or assembling
of materials from raw material or previously processed material, and that have severe potential for
adversely affecting surrounding land uses due to potential environmental impacts related to noise,
smoke/particulate emissions, vibration, noxious gases, odors, glare/heat, fire/explosion hazards and
waste disposal including above ground storage of flammable, hazardous or poisonous gases,
liquids, or materials. In addition, these uses may generate large amounts of vehicle traffic, may
involve the use of large unenclosed production areas, or may require large, tall structures that are
unsightly. Heavy industrial uses typically involve primary production processes in the area of paper
products (pulp mills), food processing (slaughterhouse, meat packing plant), chemicals (manufacture
of inorganic chemicals, resins, plastics, paints, fertilizers, explosives, ink), petroleum products
(refineries, bulk storage), primary metals (blasting, smelting, rolling), machinery and equipment
manufacturer (vehicle assembly, engines, construction equipment), leather (storing, curing, tanning),
gravel based products (manufacture of bricks, concrete, abrasives), lumber products (saw mills),
solid waste disposal facility, and waste transfer facility.
INDUSTRY, LIGHT
An establishment involved in the processing, fabrication, assembly, or compounding of products
where the process involved is relatively clean and nuisance-free, usually completely enclosed, and
without adverse environmental effects, that can generally be made compatible with surrounding
areas through buffering and through separation required by yard and height limitations. Typically,
these uses result in the creation of finished products for sale on a wholesale basis to retailers or
directly on a retail basis, and include uses in the following areas: lumber products (millwork, cabinet-
making) textiles, printing and publishing services, bottling works, carpet and rug cleaning, furniture
manufacture, paper (final processing from purchased bulk stock), rubber and plastics (compounding
processed resins, molding plastics), gravel based products (pottery, cutting, finishing granite, firing
and decorating clay products), and ice manufacturing.
INSTITUTIONAL PROPERTY
Land used by a nonprofit, religious or educational organization, such as a place of worship, library,
public or private school, hospital, or airport. Government owned or operated building, structure or
land used for a public purpose shall not be considered institutional property.
INTERIM USE
A use approved by City Council for a specific period of time in anticipation of a different long-term
use of the property being proposed or approved during that time.
INTERSECTION
A place where two or more public or private streets cross at the same grade.
JUNKYARD
All or part of a lot, parcel or land, building, or structure used for the storage, processing, or
abandonment of wastepaper, rags, scrap metal, or other scrap of discarded goods, materials, or
machinery, or two or more unregistered, inoperable motor vehicles.
LANDFILL
A permanent facility either publicly or privately owned and operated for the purpose of disposing
solid waste.
LANDSCAPE AREA
Land set apart for the plantings of grass, shrubs, trees or similar living plants, or other ground
surface treatment such as decorative rock, bark, or stone.
LANDSCAPE PLAN
An integrated set of documents that may consist of both drawn and written materials describing
bufferyards, landscaping, and screening to be installed on a lot or parcel.
LOADING AREA
An off-street space or berth on the same lot with a building or contiguous to a group of buildings, for
the temporary parking of a commercial vehicle while loading or unloading merchandise or materials,
and that abuts or is connected by means of a driveway to a street or alley.
LOT
The smallest unit of land division defined by plat or by metes and bounds description, that is not
divided by a lot line, right-of-way, or other publicly owned land, and that does not include the right-of-
way of any street upon which the lot abuts, even if ownership to such right-of-way lies with the owner
of the lot.
LOT AREA
The area contained within the lot lines of a lot, excluding any right-of-way or private street.
LOT, CORNER
A lot abutting two or more streets at their intersection, or upon two parts of the same street forming
an interior angle less than 135 degrees.
LOT DEPTH
The average horizontal distance between the front lot line and the rear lot line of a lot.
LOT LINE
A line of record bounding a lot that divides one lot from another lot or from a public or private street
or any other public space. Where any portion of a lot extends onto a public right-of-way, the lot line
shall be deemed to be the boundary of said right-of-way.
LOT, THROUGH
A lot that fronts upon two parallel or approximately parallel streets.
LOT WIDTH
A horizontal distance measured between the side lot lines.
LOT OF RECORD
Any validly recorded lot that, at the time of its recording, complied with all applicable laws,
ordinances, and regulations.
LOT SIZE
The minimum size lot, in square feet, for certain types of residential development, measured on a
horizontal plane. See also Site Area.
LUMBER YARD
An establishment engaged in the retail sale of building supplies and household equipment that is
characterized by the presence of an outdoor storage area used for the keeping of building supplies
such as lumber or masonry products.
MANUFACTURED HOME
A building, fabricated in an off-site facility for installation or assembly at the building site,
transportable in one or more sections, that, in the traveling mode, is eight feet or more in width or 40
feet or more in length, or when erected is 320 or more square feet in size, and is built on a
permanent chassis and designed to be used as a dwelling for one family, with or without permanent
foundation, when connected to the required utilities, and includes the plumbing, heating, air
conditioning, and electrical system contained in the building, and that is certified as constructed in
compliance with the “manufactured home building code” as established under Minn. Stat. Ch. 327.
MEDICAL FACILITY
An establishment engaged in providing diagnostic services, extensive medical treatment (including
surgical services) and other hospital services, as well as continuous nursing service, including
general medical and surgical hospitals, specialty hospitals, medical laboratories, bio medical
research and development, outpatient care facilities, medical schools and associated dormitories,
medical appliance sales, and similar uses, but not including a Clinic or Veterinary and Animal
Services.
design criteria contained herein, or for the placement of other dwelling types consistent with the
standards of the underlying zoning district.
MOBILE HOME
A non-HUD compliant structure built prior to June 15, 1976, on a permanent chassis, capable of
being transported in one or more sections and designed to be used with or without a permanent
foundation as a dwelling when connected to on-site utilities, but not including manufactured homes
or recreational vehicles. Mobile homes are not permitted in the City.
MULTI-USE TRAIL
A path physically separated from motor vehicle traffic, located either within a street right-of-way or a
separate right-of-way or easement, and intended for use by some combination of bicyclists,
pedestrians, equestrians, and other non-motor vehicle traffic.
MUNTIN
A bar or rigid supporting strip between adjacent panes of glass.
NEIGHBORHOOD PARK
A public recreation facility designed to give residents of one or more neighborhoods the opportunity
for the enjoyment of open space, and that may also provide for the use of the residents’ playground
equipment, picnic areas, and areas suitable for use as ball fields, tennis, and basketball courts, and
skating rinks. Trail corridors providing access from residential areas to neighborhood park facilities
may be considered part of the neighborhood park.
NONCONFORMING APPEARANCE
Any conforming use located on a lot that is zoned Non-Residential, abuts a lot in a residential district,
in existence at the time this UDC was adopted, and that does not meet the appearance control
standards of this UDC.
NONCONFORMING PARKING
Any development that does not provide the number of off-street parking spaces that would be
required by this UDC for a new development of the same type. The existence of parking spaces
located outside of an approved driveway in the front or street side yard on a property in a residential
district that were not approved through a lot and site development approval procedure do not
constitute legal, nonconforming parking.
NONCONFORMING SIGN
Any sign established prior to the effective date of this UDC that is not in full compliance with the
UDC.
NONCONFORMING STRUCTURE
A structure that does not comply with the height, setback, density, or floor area ratio requirements of
the district where it is located including structures that do not comply with the flood proofing and
elevation regulations of the floodplain overlay districts.
NONCONFORMING USE
An activity using land or structures that would not be permitted to be established as a new use in the
zone where it is located by the regulations of this UDC.
NURSERY
Land or greenhouses used to raise flowers, shrubs and plants for later retail or wholesale sales.
NURSING HOME
An establishment primarily engaged in providing intermediate or long-term nursing and health
related care to individuals.
OCCUPANCY
The residing of an individual overnight in a habitable unit, or the installation, storage or use of
equipment, merchandise, or machinery in any institutional, commercial, or industrial building.
release. “Offender Transitional Housing” does not include housing declared by state law to be a
permitted single-family residential use. The term “short-term” shall mean a period of time not
exceeding one year. A dwelling or lodging facility owned by the offender or a member of the
offender’s immediate family shall not be considered Offender Transitional Housing.
OFFICE
A room or group of rooms used for managing the affairs of an establishment or for the non-retail,
non-production conduct of affairs of a service, professional institutional, or business nature including
medical offices or clinics, studios for those involved in art, sculpture, and music including
organizations operating on a membership basis for the promotion of the interests of the
membership, including trade associations, business associations, professional membership
organizations, labor unions, or civic or fraternal organizations, but not including place of worship,
hospitals, golf and country clubs, or credit unions.
OPEN SPACE
An area identified by easement or other mechanism that guarantees that the area will not be
intentionally disturbed and that provides, at a minimum, for access by a public agency or a qualified
land trust for purposes of monitoring the condition and maintaining the site.
OUTDOOR STORAGE
The keeping, in an unroofed area or structure open to view on its sides, of any goods, junk, material
or merchandise in the same place for more than 24 hours and including adjacent land area
improved and necessary to provide access to such goods.
PARAPET
An extension of the main walls of a building above the roof line.
PARK
Public parks operated by the City or by the City’s Board of Park Commissioners, including all park
buildings, trails, parkways, and related facilities. A Community Center use within a public park is
considered part of a Park.
PARKING BAY
A portion of a site improved for the off-street parking of vehicles, where individual parking spaces are
accessed directly from the street. Parking space shall not be from within the right-of-way.
PARKING LOT
A surface area whose purpose is to provide accessory or primary use parking spaces for motor
vehicles, this category also includes community lots that are established to meet the parking needs
in a residential area.
PARKING GARAGE
An above ground and/or belowground structure, or a part of a primary structure, designed for
parking automobiles and light trucks and van, in which at least one level of parking is located above
or below another level of parking in the same structure. This use does not include parking and
storage facilities for recreational vehicles, boats, and trucks seven feet in height or greater.
PARKING STRUCTURE
Any aboveground or belowground structure, either freestanding or constructed as part of a building
with a non-parking primary use, whose purpose is to provide accessory or primary use parking
spaces for motor vehicles. In the MX-T district a permitted Parking Lot or Garage associated with a
City designated park and ride may provide automobile maintenance services, such as oil changes
and car washes, as an accessory use.
PASTURE
An area where grass or other growing plants are used for grazing and where the concentration of
animals is such that a vegetative cover is maintained during the growing season, except in the
immediate vicinity of temporary supplemental feeding or watering devices.
PAVEMENT
A hard, smooth surface of a parking lot, driveway or drive aisle that is made from concrete, asphalt
or a paving brick, or similar durable permanent permeable pavement.
PEDESTRIAN
A person moving about by foot or using a wheelchair or other mobility aid other than a motor vehicle.
PEDESTRIAN-ORIENTED SPACE
An area located outside of the right-of-way between a building and a street or along a pedestrian
facility that promotes visual and pedestrian access onto the site and provides pedestrian-oriented
amenities and landscaping to enhance the patron’s or public’s use of the space for passive activities
such as resting, reading, and/or picnicking.
PERIMETER
The boundaries or borders of a lot, tract, or parcel of land, or the total combined length of all those
boundaries or borders
PHOTOVOLTAIC DEVICE
A system of components that generates electricity from incident sunlight by means of the
photovoltaic effect, whether or not the device is able to store the energy produced for later use.
PILASTER
A rectangular, non-bearing column attached to a building façade as an ornamental design feature
PLAT, FINAL
The final map on which an applicant's plan for the division of land for purposes of development is
presented to the City for approval and that, if approved, will be submitted to the County Recorder.
PLAT, PRELIMINARY
A draft map on which an applicant’s plan for the division of land for purposes of development is
presented to the City for review and comment regarding compliance with this UDC and other
standards and regulations adopted by the City, prior to submittal of a Final Plat for approval.
PLACE OF WORSHIP
A building or structure, or groups of buildings or structures, that by design and construction are
primarily intended for the conducting of organized religious services and associated accessory uses.
PLAYGROUND
All play areas designed primarily for children including, but not limited to, an outdoor area set aside
for recreation and play containing playground equipment, such as climbing toys, seesaws, and
swings.
PROPERTY OWNER
The fee owner of land, or the beneficial owner of land whose interest is primarily one of possession
and enjoyment in contemplation of ultimate ownership. The term includes but is not limited to
venders under a contract for deed.
PROTECTED LOT
See Section 60.400.020F.2.a, Protected Lots for the definition of Protected Lot.
PUBLIC UTILITY
Any corporation or government entity supplying natural gas, electric, transportation, water, sewer, or
communication service to the general public. For the purposes of this UDC, wireless
telecommunication utilities shall not be considered a Public Utility and are defined separately.
PUBLIC WATERS
Those waters defined by Minn. Stat. Ch. 103G.
QUARRY
A land disturbance or development activity that meets or exceeds any of the following thresholds and
exceeds practices allowed through a Grading Permit:
1. Activities principally designed to mine, extract, or remove bedrock materials for commercial
purposes;
2. An exposed bedrock slope steeper than 3:1 that is over 25 feet in height occurring at any
time during or following excavation;
3. The temporary or permanent exposure of rock face made as part of or following excavation in
excess of 25 feet in height. The measurement of height of the exposed rock face shall be the
vertical measurement from the lowest elevation of the excavation to the top of the exposed
face. Multiple faces shall be added together to determine height;
4. Removal from a site of more than 20,000 cubic yards of earth material per acre of land
being excavated or 100,000 cubic yards of earth for the entire site;
5. Activities that deposit soil, bedrock, or other earthen material on site;
6. An excavation activity using a crusher; or
7. A Substantial Land Alteration meeting any of the above characteristics.
RAILROAD TRANSPORTATION
Establishments engaged in domestic freight and passenger transportation by rail including railroad
yards, freight stations and switching yards.
REACH
A hydraulic engineering term to describe a longitudinal segment of a stream or river influenced by a
natural or man-made obstruction. In an urban area, the segment of a stream or river between two
consecutive bridge crossings is typically constitute a reach.
RECLAMATION PLAN
A plan, including a Final Site Development Plan and Report, required to be submitted by applicants
for Conditional Use Permit approval of excavation activities that describes how the site will be
reclaimed for subsequent use after conclusion of the excavation activity.
RECREATIONAL EQUIPMENT
Craft designed for use on water or snow, as well as motorized vehicles designed for use on surfaces
other than public roadways, and including trailers used to transport such craft or vehicles.
RECREATIONAL VEHICLE
A temporary structure, less than 40 feet in length, that can be towed, hauled, or driven and is
primarily designed as temporary housing accommodations for recreational, camping or travel use
including but not limited to travel trailers, truck campers, camping trailers and self-propelled motor
homes.
REFERENCE LINE
The reference line of any public or private street is whichever of the following two lines that is closer
to the existing right-of- way line:
1) a line within the right-of-way that is parallel to and five feet inside of the right-of- way line; or
2) the line created by the existing curb location parallel to the right-of way line.
REGULATED LOT
See Section 60.400.020F.2.b, Regulated Lots for the definition of Regulated Lot.
children, or one or more adults meeting the definition of “adult” in Minn. Stat §245A.02, Subd. 2
with 24 hour care, food, lodging, training, education, supervision, rehabilitation, or treatment, and
including all facilities providing lodging to persons whose right to live together as a household is
protected by the Federal Fair Housing Amendments Act as amended and interpreted by the courts.
RESIDENTIAL FLOOR
A story within a building in which over 50 percent of the floor area is devoted to dwelling units.
RETAIL ESTABLISHMENT
An establishment engaged in selling goods or merchandise to the general public for personal or
household consumption and rendering services incidental to the sale of such goods, including
furniture and appliance sales and business centers. These establishments are characterized by the
following: 1) They buy and receive as well as sell merchandise; 2) They may process some products,
but such processing is incidental or subordinate to the selling activities; and 3) They predominantly
sell to customers for their own personal or household use.
RETAIL, NEIGHBORHOOD
A retail establishment that is under 3,000 square feet gross floor area.
RETAIL, SMALL
A retail establishment that is under 10,000 square feet gross floor area.
RETAIL, MEDIUM
A retail establishment that is under 25,000 square feet gross floor area.
RETAIL, LARGE
A retail establishment that is over 25,000 square feet gross floor area.
RIGHT OF ACCESS
The legal authority providing for the right of ingress to or egress from a public street.
RIGHT-OF-WAY
A strip of land acquired by dedication, reservation, prescription, or condemnation occupied or
intended to be occupied by a road, crosswalk, utility line, railroad, electric transmission line,
streetscape improvements, street furniture, or other similar use.
RIGHT-OF-WAY LINE
The lines that form the boundaries of a right-of-way.
ROAD AUTHORITY
The unit of government having control of the right of access to a right-of-way.
ROADWAY
That portion of a street, common area or easement area improved for use by motor vehicles,
including travel lanes and parking lanes, but not including driveways.
SCHOOL
A public school as defined in Minn. Stat. Ch. 120.05, or a nonpublic school as defined in Minn. Stat.
Ch. 123.932.
SEASONAL SALES
A building or structure used for the retail sales of Christmas trees, holiday décor and seasonal gifts,
fresh fruits, vegetables, flowers, herbs, or plants. Such use may also involve the accessory sales of
other unprocessed foodstuffs, home processed food products such as jams, jellies, pickles, sauces
or baked goods, and homemade handicrafts. No commercially packaged handicrafts or commercially
processed or packaged foodstuffs shall be sold. Such uses also include “pick your own”
establishments where customers gather their own produce from the fields for purchase and off-site
consumption.
SEDIMENTATION
Sedimentation shall mean the settling out of soil particles that have been transported by water or
wind. (Sedimentation occurs when the velocity of water or wind in which soil particles are suspended
is slowed to a sufficient degree and for a sufficient period of time to allow the particles to settle out
of suspension or when the degree of slope is lessened to achieve the same result).
SEMIPUBLIC USE
The use of land by a private, nonprofit organization to provide a public service that is ordinarily open
to some persons outside the regular constituency of the organization.
SENSITIVE LANDS
Land that features significant and/or fragile environmental qualities like wetlands, threatened or
endangered species, wildlife habitat, unstable or potentially unstable slopes, expansive soils, stands
of mature trees, other significant natural features, as well as properties that are subject to periodic
inundation, subsidence of the earth’s surface, high water table, or have difficult topography,
SETBACK
The minimum separation in linear feet, measured on a horizontal plane, required between the wall of
a building and each of its lot lines at a given height.
SETBACK PLANE
A theoretical plane extending over the lot and inclined upward from the horizontal by a designated
number of degrees and intersecting with the ground at the lot line.
SHELTER, STORM
A structure or portion of a structure intended to provide protection to human life during periods of
danger to human life from nuclear fallout, blasts, air raids, storms, or other emergencies.
SHORELAND-RELATED DEFINITIONS
SHORELAND
Land located within the following distances from public waters: 1,000 feet from the ordinary
high water level of a pond, or flowage; and 300 feet from a river or stream, or the landward
extent of a floodplain designated by ordinance on a river or stream, whichever is greater. The
limits of shorelands may be reduced whenever the waters involved are bounded by topographic
divides that extend landward from the waters for lesser distances and when approved by the
Minnesota Commissioner of Natural Resources.
SHRUBS
Typically are multi-stemmed woody plants that at maturity are normally less than 15 feet in height.
Shrubs are typically low growing plants that can be used for creating hedges, screening, and for
windbreaks.
SIDEWALK
A hard-surface or raise pathway located within or outside the street right-of-way that is designated for
the exclusive use of pedestrian traffic.
SIGN-RELATED DEFINITIONS
When used in the context of regulating signs, the following terms shall have the definitions shown
below.
BACK LIGHTING
The sign message is raised off of the sign's background and illuminated by a light source
located behind the message that illuminates the background.
BANNER
A strip of cloth-like, vinyl, lightweight or other woven material on which a sign appears.
BILLBOARD
A sign that directs attention to any person, product, event, service, or other matter that is not
related to or on the premises where the sign is located.
CANOPY, SERVICE
A roof-like structure attached to or detached from the principal building that provides only
overhead protection to outside customer service areas.
CANOPY, SUN
An awning made of cloth or permanent construction, attached to the wall of a building, for the
purpose of shielding windows or doorways from the elements.
MARQUEE
A structure attached to and projecting from a wall of a building, located above an entrance.
MURAL
A painting or similar work of art on the side, ground, or ceiling of a building, wall, or structure.
INTERNAL LIGHTING
The sign is illuminated by a light source located inside of the sign structure including neon
lighting, illuminated channel letters, and lightboxes.
SIGN
Any object, device, display, structure, or part thereof, situated outdoors or indoors, that is
displayed to attract the attention of the public while on public streets, highways, or walkways by
any means, including words, letters figures, designs, symbols, fixtures, colors, illumination, or
projected images. Signs do not include merchandise or other objects visible in a window display,
and do not include signs located more than 18 inches inside the outer walls of a building and
not intended to be viewed by persons outside the building.
SIGN, FREESTANDING
A self-supporting sign resting on or supported by means of poles, standards of any other type of
base anchored to the ground.
SIGN, NOVELTY
A portable sign with a structure designed, in whole, to resemble an animal or other character
figure and that includes a changeable message sign, either as an integral part of the structure
or attached to the structure in some manner, and usually transported on a trailer.
SIGN, PORTABLE
Any sign not permanently attached to the ground or other permanent structure, or a sign
designed to be transported, including but not limited to: signs designed to be transported by
means of wheels; signs converted to A- or T-frames; menu and sandwich board signs; balloons
used as signs; movable flags (excluding banners); umbrellas; and signs attached to or painted
on vehicles parked and visible from the public right-of-way, unless the vehicle is used for normal
day-today operations of the occupant of the lot or property.
SIGN, PROJECTING
A sign, other than a wall sign, that attaches to and projects from a structure or building façade.
SIGN, ROOF
A sign mounted on the roof of a building or that depends upon a parapet wall for support.
SIGN, WALL
A sign mounted parallel to or an integral part of a building façade or other vertical building
surface. Signs in shop windows are included.
SIGN CREDIT
A benefit granting the holder of the credit the right to erect a new billboard that conforms with
all applicable laws upon the furnishing of proof to the Community Development Director that an
existing legal nonconforming billboard and its supporting structure have been removed.
SPOT LIGHTING
The sign is illuminated by spotlights directed specifically at the sign area.
SITE
Any lot or parcel or combination of lots or parcels assembled for the purpose of development.
SITE AREA
The minimum size of parcel or tract, in square feet, on which the development of a particular use
may occur, measured on a horizontal plane. See also Lot Size.
SLOPE
An incline from the horizontal expressed in an arithmetic ratio of horizontal magnitude to vertical
magnitude.
3:1
SOCIAL SERVICES
An establishment that provides social or welfare services to those in need, for no fee or
compensation, or at a fee recognized as being significantly less than charged by profit-making
organizations. Services may include but are not limited to information and referral services;
counselling; skill development; aid through the provision of food, clothing, daytime or overnight
sheltering; life skill and personal development programs; alcohol, drug, or substance abuse
counselling centers; and drop-in or activity space.
SOIL EROSION
The removal and/or loss of soil by the action or water, ice, gravity, or wind, including both the
detachment and transport of soil particles.
SPECIALIZED EDUCATION
An establishment engaged in furnishing specialized academic or technical courses, normally on a fee
basis, including but not limited to vocational or distance-learning schools; cosmetology schools;
computer, networking, and technology schools; and paralegal or medical assistant programs; along
with non-degree granting schools, establishments providing art or physical education instruction, or
any other instructional establishment that does not meet the definition of a College or University or
School.
2. Human male genitals in a discernibly turgid state, even if completely and opaquely covered.
SPOT ZONING
The classification of a single lot or several small lots to a district which is different than that assigned
to surrounding properties, for reasons inconsistent with the proposes set forth in this UDC, the
Minnesota state enabling legislation, or the decisions of courts in this state.
STAFF
The Community Development Director and all employees of the Community Development
Department of the City under the supervision of and subject to the authority of the Community
Development Director.
STANDARD RESTAURANT
An establishment whose primary business is the sale of food and/or beverage to customers in a
ready to consume state, and whose principal method of operation includes one or both of the
following characteristics:
8. Customers, are served their food and beverage by restaurant employees at the same table or
counter where the food and/or beverage are consumed; and/or
9. A cafeteria type operation where food and beverage generally are consumed within the
restaurant building.
STEEP SLOPE
Land where agricultural activity or development is either not recommended or described as poorly
suited due to slope steepness and the site's soil characteristics, as mapped and described in
available county soil surveys or other technical reports, unless appropriate design and construction
techniques and farming practices are used in accordance with the provisions of this UDC. Where
specific information is not available, steep slopes are lands having average slopes over 12 percent
over horizontal distances of 50 feet or more, that are not bluffs.
AVENUE
A roadway aligned in a north and south direction, conforming to the appropriate address grid
line, and generally designated by a number.
BOULEVARD
A roadway divided by a landscaped center island and generally designated by a name.
CIRCLE
A roadway containing a closed loop that is not interrupted by a through roadway and
generally designated by a name.
COURT
A roadway having a horseshoe shape and whose terminus point begins and ends at the
same roadway and generally designated by one name throughout its entire length.
DRIVE
A curvilinear roadway of more than 1,000 feet in length and generally designated by a name.
LANE
A roadway ending in a cul-de-sac that is not interrupted by a through roadway and generally
designated by a name.
PARKWAY
A special scenic route or park drive generally designated by a name.
PLACE
A short curvilinear or diagonal roadway less than 1,000 feet in length generally designated by
a name.
PRIVATE ROADWAY
A roadway constructed on private land and not maintained by a city, township, or Olmsted
County.
ROAD
A diagonal or curvilinear roadway more than 1,000 feet in length and generally designated by
a name.
STREET
A roadway aligned in an east-west direction, conforming to the appropriate address grid line,
and generally designated by a number.
STORAGE CONTAINER
A fully enclosed structure made of metal or other construction materials, that is not part of a primary
building and is intended to be used for storage purposes. Storage containers are individual units that
are periodically removed from a property by truck and are considered a structure without any
attached foundation or footings. A storage container may be a self-contained unit that includes
wheels and is licensed as a vehicle or a unit that must be trucked to a site and removed from the
trailer used for transport. This definition excludes warming sheds at city parks and schools,
prefabricated sheds typically used for household, garden, or hobby storage, dumpsters, or roll off
containers that are used for the collection of solid waste. Storage containers are also referred to as
cargo containers, temporary storage containers, portable storage containers, containerized storage
devices, semi-trailers, or truck-trailers.
STREET
A strip of land used or intended to be used for the passage or travel of motor vehicles, non-motorized
vehicles, and pedestrians, including roadway, boulevard, medians, islands, paths, sidewalks, and
related facilities.
STREET, PRIVATE
A street owned and maintained by one or more private property owners.
STREET, PUBLIC
A street established on a right-of-way that has been dedicated for public use.
STRUCTURE
A combination of materials to form construction for use, occupancy, or ornamentation, whether
installed on, above or below the surface of land or water.
STRUCTURE, TEMPORARY
A building or structure without foundation or footings that is designed to be transportable and that is
not designed for attachment to the ground, to another structure, or to any utility system on the same
premises for an undetermined length of time.
SUBDIVISION
The separation of an area, parcel, or tract of land into two or more parcels, tracts, lots, or into long
term leasehold interests where the creation of the leasehold interests necessitates the creation of
streets, roads, or alleys, for residential, commercial, industrial or any other use or any combination
thereof, except for those subdivisions exempted by Minn. Stat. Ch. 462.352 (sub. 12).
SWIMMING POOL
A private recreational pool, pond, lake, or open tank not located within a completely enclosed
building and capable of containing water to a depth at any point greater than 24 inches.
TELECOMMUNICATIONS-RELATED DEFINITIONS
When used in the context of regulating telecommunications, the following terms shall have the
definitions shown below.
CWTS, FREESTANDING
A CWTS that consists of a standalone support structure, antennas, and associated equipment.
The support structure may be a wooden pole, steel monopole, lattice tower, or similar structure.
FALL ZONE
A graphically represented, geographically identified boundary that encompasses the predicted
area of land identified by a registered engineer that will completely contain all the pieces of a
collapsed monopole tower as a result of a structural failure.
SMALL-CELL CWTS
A CWTS that is designed to act as a booster site that provides increased localized network
capacity. A small-cell CWTS has three or fewer antennas, no greater than four feet long each,
and does not exceed 35 feet in height for a freestanding small-cell CWTS, and includes
associated equipment cabinet(s).
TOWER
Any ground or roof mounted pole, spire, structure, or combination thereof taller than 15 feet,
including supporting lines, cables, wires, braces, and masts, intended primarily for the purpose
of mounting an antenna, meteorological device, wind energy conversion system, or similar
apparatus above grade.
TOWER-GUYED
A tower that is supported, in whole or in part, by guy wires and ground anchors used to mount
an antenna.
TOWER-LATTICE
A guyed or self-supporting three or four sided, open, steel frame tower used to mount an
antenna.
TOWER-MONOPOLE
A tower consisting of a single, enclosed pole, constructed without guy wires and ground anchors
used to mount an antenna.
TEMPORARY HOUSING
Any tent, recreational vehicle or other temporary structure used for human shelter that is designed to
be transportable and that is not attached to the ground, to another structure, or to any utility system
on the same premises for the purpose of occupancy for more than 30 consecutive days.
TEMPORARY USE
A use that does not conform to the regulations of the applicable zoning district established for a fixed
period of time with intent to discontinue such use upon the expiration of such time. A temporary use
shall not involve the construction or alteration of any permanent building or structure.
TENANT
For the purposes of public notice, any leaseholder, resident, or occupant at an address who is not
the owner of that property.
TENNIS COURT
An indoor or outdoor facility designed with courts specifically for the recreational use of tennis,
squash, handball, and/or other similar court games.
TRAFFIC ENGINEER
The traffic engineer for the applicable Road Authority of a public street.
TRANSPARENCY
The ability to see through with clarity. An opening in the building wall allowing light and views
between interior and exterior. Measured as glass area for buildings, glass or screen area for porches
and as open area for parking structures.
TRANSPORTATION SERVICES
An establishment furnishing services related to the arrangement of persons and goods movements,
such as freight forwarding, parking services, or the rental/leasing of automobiles or two axle trucks.
TURNOUT
An area at the end of a dead-end parking lot designed to allow for the backing of vehicles at the end
of the parking lot.
UNDISTURBED, AREA OF
An area of special site preservation to qualify for floor area or density bonus, in which the natural
ground cover and plant or woodland growth shall not be removed except through actions:
1. Necessary to limit the spread of disease and noxious weeds,
2. To trim or remove dead trees or parts of dead trees that are a hazard, or
3. To control the erosion of soil from the site.
UPZONING
A change in zoning allowing more intensive development. More intensive development is indicated
by an increase in density, a broadened range of authorized uses, an increased floor area ratio, a shift
from residential to commercial development, or a shift from commercial to industrial development.
URBAN AGRICULTURE
The cultivation of food and/or horticulture crops, aquaponics, aquaculture, and/or hydroponics. Such
use may include the production and sale of food products from food grown on the premises. Urban
Agriculture includes the raising of small animals like bees for the purpose of producing honey and
chickens for the purpose of producing eggs, but does not include slaughtering or selling meat or the
keeping of any large animals. All such activities must comply with all applicable provisions of the
Rochester Code of Ordinances.
USE, ACCESSORY
A use of land that is secondary and subordinate to the primary use of land.
USE, PRIMARY
The primary use of land or buildings as distinguished from subordinate or accessory uses.
UTILITY, MAJOR
A facility providing an important regional utility service, such as water, sewer, or drainage, that
normally entails construction of new buildings or structures, and that sometimes have employees on
the site on an ongoing basis including but not limited to water towers, natural gas regulating
stations, electric substations, water treatment plants, sewage treatment plants, above- or below-
ground reservoirs, regional stormwater detention ponds, electric power lines that transmit over 110
KV of power, and other large facilities that enable the provision of utility services to large geographic
area or a large number of people. Major Utility does not include Geothermal Energy System, Ground-
or Building-Mounted Solar Collector, or Ground- or Building- Mounted Wind Energy Conversion
System (WECS).
UTILITY, MINOR
Equipment necessary to support utility services to development within the immediate vicinity and
that involves only minor accessory structures, and that typically do not have employees located at
the site on an ongoing basis including but not limited to electric transformer stations and service
boxes, gas regulator stations, telephone service boxes, and well, water and sewer pumping stations,
and related underground and aboveground pipes and wires, but excluding electric power
transmission lines that transmit over 110 KV of power.
VERTICAL SUBDIVISIONS
The three-dimensional subdivision of space into separate ownership parcels within an existing
building or proposed building project by registered land survey.
VISIBILITY TRIANGLE
The triangular area formed by joining points measured 30 feet along the property line from the
intersection of two streets, or by joining points measured 10 feet back along a driveway and lot line
from the point of intersection of the driveway and lot line. As an alternative to Subsection a, the City
Engineer may, on a site-specific basis, apply American Association of State Highway and
Transportation Officials (AASHTO) standards based on a site-specific evaluation of intersection
visibility.
WALKWAY
A right-of-way for pedestrian or bicycle that does not meet the definition of a sidewalk, bikeway, or
multi-use trail.
WALL
The vertical exterior surface of a building.
WETLAND
An area that is inundated or saturated by surface or ground water at a frequency and duration
sufficient to support, and that under normal circumstances supports a prevalence of vegetation
typically adapted for life in saturated soil conditions. Wetlands generally include swamps, marshes,
bogs, and similar areas.
WHOLESALE FACILITY
An establishment engaged primarily in selling merchandise to retailers, or to industrial, commercial
institutional or professional business customers, or to other wholesalers, or on a mail order basis to
individuals or firms, or that serve as agents or brokers buying merchandise for, or selling
merchandise to, individuals and companies.
WIND TURBINE
A machine used to produce electricity by converting the kinetic energy of wind to electrical
energy. A wind turbine consists of a rotor, nacelle, tower and supporting cables, and foundation.
WOODLAND
An area of planted material covering one acre or more with a minimum dimension of 66 feet, having
a density of twenty trees or more per acre with a caliper of eight inches or more.
YARD
A ground level open space that lies between a primary or accessory building and the nearest lot line.
Such yard is unobstructed and open to the sky except as may be specifically provided for in this UDC.
YARD DEPTH
The shortest distance between a lot line and a wall of a building located on the lot.
YARD LINE
A line drawn parallel to a lot line at a distance therefrom equal to the depth of the minimum required
yard or setback that defines the required yard area.
YOUTH FACILITY
A public playground, public swimming pool, public library, or licensed day care facility.
ZONING CERTIFICATE
A document issued by the Community Development Director permitting a use of a building or on a
parcel of land to commence, based upon a finding that the development is consistent with the terms
of the zoning certificate authorizing the development.
ZONING MAP
The map or maps showing the boundaries of the zoning districts listed in this UDC. The zoning map is
considered a part of this UDC.